Geldart - Gas Fluidization Technology PDF
Geldart - Gas Fluidization Technology PDF
Geldart - Gas Fluidization Technology PDF
TECHNOLOGY
C LASSIF ..
AUTOR
C-r:.'gJ::: .
V .................... EX ..__
TOMBO BC/~.L~
Contents
1 Introduction
......
D. Geldart
2
11
D. Geldart
3
Characterization
D.
Geldart
of Fluidized Powders
R. Clift
5
No part of this book may be produced by any means, or transmitted,
or translated into a machine language without the written
permission of the publisher.
8
9
. . ..... .. . .... ..... ..... ..... . .. ... .. ... ... ... ..... .. . 97
Particle Entrainment
D. Geldart
and Carryover
. 123
Beds
155
~~~=:~s~:aration
197
219
I. S.M. Botterill
.10
11
Solids Mixing
7 ~i~~;,;~ztluidized
53
. 33
259
.
285
I.R. Grac~
12
T.M. Knowlton
, 341
13
415
Contributors
SIPEF SA, Kasteel Calesberg 2120, Schoten, Belgium
Department of Chemical Engineering, University of
Birmingham, PO Box 363, Birmingham B152TT, UK
PROFESSOR ROLAND
CUff,
Department of Chemical and Process
Engineering, University of Surrey, Guildford, Surrey GU2 5XH, UK
DR
DEREK
GELDART;
Postgraduate School of Powder Technology,
University of Bradford, Bradford BD7 1DP, West Yorkshire, UK
PROFESSOR JOHN R
GRACE,
Department of Chemical Engineering,
University of British Columbia, Vancouver, V6T 1W5, Canada
DR TED M. KNOWLTON, Institute of Gas Technology, 4201 W. 36th St.,
Chicago, Illinois 60632, USA
DR
DAVID
REAY,
Engineering Sciences Division, AERE Harwell,
Oxfordshire, OXll ORA, UK
DR LADISLAV SVAROVSKY, Postgraduate School of Powder Technology,
University of Bradford, Bradford BD7 1DP, West Yorkshire, UK
DR JOSEPH YERUSHALMI, PAMA Limited, 7 Kehilat Saloniki St., Tel-Aviv
69513, PO Box 24119, Israel
DR JAN BAEYENS,
DR J.S.M.
BOTIERILL,
Introduction
1.1
CHARACTERISTICS
OF FLUIDIZED SYSTEMS
6
5
1\
"'E
".E
'F
<>,Q.
-c
Cohesive
0
~
Aerotoble
0.5
Spoutoble
1\
Sand -like
1'\
"
I /
"'r--.
:\
\
Figure 1.2 Simplified diagram for classifying powders. according to their fluidization behaviour in air at ambient conditions (Geldart, 1973).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Shell
Powder
Blower
Gas distributor
Heat exchanger
for fluidizing gas
Figure 1.1 A conceptualized fluidized bed which could be used for a wide
Iiety of applications.
Group C
powder
Dimensionless
2 1/3
(314 CeRe I
particle diameter
1/3
=Ar
=d 9 (ppPgl/fL2
}113
researched account is that given by Squires (1982), who has been associated
with process invention and development involving fluid beds since 1946.
Squires provides a fascinating picture of how commercial and wartime
pressure, together with a compromise between daring innovation and the
need to reduce catalyst losses, steered th~ ~~~igQ.a\Va.yfromt.bebigh.velocity
(upflow) mode towarps low velocity (downflow) operation; since that time
more than 350 FCC units have been built and most are still in operation. In
the late 1940sDorr Oliver applied the technique successfully to the roasting
of sulphide ores and since that time virtually all new ore roasters have been
fluidized beds. Fluid bed dryers also made rapid progress and by the mid
1950sthe technique was well established.
However, in all these applications the degree of conversion required was
either not critical (as in FCC) or easily achievable (as in roasting and drying);
a major setback occurred when the large fluidized bed Fischer- Tropsch
synthesis plant at Brownsville in Texas fell far short of the conversions
achieved in the pilot plant. The aim was to use natural gas to manufacture
gasoline, but unlike the other processes, here bubble hydrodynamics were
critical and their .crucial role in scale-up was not properly appreciated.
Although eventually the plant came somewhere near its designed output,
with the discovery of huge quantities of oil in the Middle East, the economics
became so unfavourable that the plant was shut down in 1957.
The Sohio process for making acrylonitrile in a fluidized bed was
immensely successful; since 1960 virtually all new acrylo plants have been
fluidized beds and 50 large units are in operation throughout the world.
Undoubtedly the major success in the late 1970s and in this decade is the
Union Carbide polyethylene synthesis process. The alternative high pressure
liquid phase reactors were limited in scale of operation, whereas in the low
pressure gas phase process single fluid bed units can be built as large as
required; the better quality product and dramatic reduction in costs which are
features of this fluid bed process have ensured the demise of virtually all
competitors. Also in the 1970s and 1980s, fluidized bed combustion has
attracted much attention largely due to its relatively low temperature
operation (800 to 900C) and its ability to absorb S02 through the use of
limestone or dolomite. These features mean that NO" and 802 emissions in
the flue gases can be made acceptably low. Although such units operate at 1
to 2 mis, an atmospheric pressure fluidized bed boiler for commercial power
generation would constitute an extremely large pice of equipment. The more
compact pressurized fluidized bed combustors are therefore attractive but
commercially are still a long way off. A great many small atmospheric
pressure fluidized combustors are in use throughout the world - probably
more than 2,000 - on a variety of duties including burning plastic waste,
providing hot gases for drying grass, and raising steam for process use
(Highley and Kaye, 1983).
For those who wish to maintain an active interest in the field it is essential to
read the general technical press, scientific journals, and proceedings of
conferences which are partly or wholly concerned with fluidization. Most of
the well-known chemical engineering journals regularly publish papers on
fluidization,
e.g. Chemical Engineering Science, Chemical Engineering
oe
c
;'c
00
.10 J:
eu
0'"
oS
available (e.g. Elliott and Virr, 1972). The American Gas Association
regularly sponsors symposia which include papers on fluidized bed gasification (e.g. Elgin and Perks, 1974). The annual meeting of the American
Institution of Chemical Engineers (AIChE) held in November each year
usually contains four sessions on fluidization and fluid/particle systems but by
no means all appear subsequently in the Chemical Engineering Progress
symposium series. International symposia on chemical reaction engineering
are held frequently and published by the American Chemical Society and
always contain papers on fluidized systems.
The abstracting service provided by the International Energy Agency
includes sections relating to fluidization, as does the HTFS (Heat Transfer
and Fluid Flow Service, Harwell, United Kingdom), Chemical Abstracts, and
Engineering Index. It is fortunate that these services are now computerized,
making searches much less time-consuming.
The active researcher is often able to keep up with the field by personal
contact with others throughout the world; those involved in fluidization and
fluid/pahicle research in the academic world form a competitive but friendly
network, and companies frequently obtain access to recent and ongoing work
through short courses and consulting contracts.
1.4
Beer J.M., MassimilIa, L., and Sarafim, AF. (1980) Inst. Energy Symp. Ser., 1 (4), 4.
de Vries, R.J., van Swaaij, W.P.M., Mantovani, c., and Heijkoop, A. (1972). Proc.
Conf. Chern. React. Eng. Amsterdam, 70, 141.
Elgin, D.C., and Perks, H.R. (1974). Proc. 5th Synth. Pipeline Gas Symp., AGA Cat.
No. L51173, p.145.
Elliott, D.E., and Virr, M.J. (1972). Proc. 3rd. Int. Coni. Fluidized Bed Combustion,
Paper 4-1, US-EPA.
Geldart, D. (1967). Chern. Ind., 1474
Geldart, D. (1968). Chern.Ind., 41
Geldart, D. (1969). Chern. Ind., 311
Geldart, D. (19~3). Powder Technol., 1,285.
Geldart, D.(1982).Powder TechnoL., 31, 1.
Geldart, D. (1983). Powder Technol., 36, 149.
Grade, J.R. (1984). 'Gas fluidization' Course, Center for Prof. Advancement, New
Jersey.
Hetsroni, G. (Ed.) (1982) Handbook of Multiphase Systems, Chap. 8.5, Hemisphere,
Washington.
Highley, J., and Kaye, W.G. (1983). Chapter 3 in Fluidized Beds - Cornbustion and
Applications (Ed. J.R. Howard), Applied Science Publishers.
Jahnig, C.E., Campbell, D.L., and Martin, H.Z. (1980). In Fluidization (Eds J.R.
Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New York.
Kunii, D _, and Levenspiel, O. (1969). Fluidization Engineering, John Wiley, New
York.
Penick, I.E., Lee, W., and Mazink, J. (1982). Int. Symp. on Chern. React. Engng,
ISCRE - 7, Boston.
Reh, L. (1968). Chem-Ing-Techn., 40, 509.
Squires, A.M. (1982). Proc. Joint Meeting of Chern. Ind. & Eng. Soc. of China &
Am. Inst. Chern. Engrs, Beijing, Sept. 19-22, p.322.
Yates, J.G. (1983). Fundamentals of Fluidized-bed Chemical Processes, Butterworths.
Landor!.
The arrival time of a space probe travelling to Saturn can be predicted more
accurately than the behaviour of a fluidized bed chemical reactor! The
reasons for this frustrating situation lie not in the inadequacies of chemical
engineers or powder technologists but rather in the complexity of defining
(and measuring) unambiguously even such fundamental parameters as the
size and size distribution, shape, and density of particles. Given that these
parameters influence explicitly and implicitly the behaviour of fixed and
fluidized beds, it is hardly surprising that most correlations give predictions
no better than 25 per cent.
For a particle of any shape other than a sphere, there are many ways of
defining its size; Allen (1981) lists twelve. Only four definitions are of interest
for packed and fluidized beds:
dp
= sieve
dv
= volume
the particle;
dsv = surface/volume diameter: the diameter of a sphere having the same
external surface area/volume ratio as the particle;
11
sieving (the most common method used for powders larger than about 75
J.'m) or by using the Coulter counter (for particles smaller than about 75
J.'m). The Coulter counter gives the volume diameter, dy, so if the sphericity
is known dsy can be estimated (Eq. 2.2). Unfortunately there is nb simple
generally accepted method for measuring the sphericity of small irregular
particles, so although values have been published (Table 2.2) they should be
regarded as estimates only. The tables show that 1/1 is between 0.64 and 1 for
= (dvlds)2
Table 2.2
Sphericities of some
common solids
Because it is now well established that the most appropriate parameter for
correlating the flow of fluids through packed beds is Sy (the external surface
area of the powder per unit particle volume), the most relevant diameter is
dsy' The sphericity 1/1, dy, and dsy can be calculated exactly for geometrical
shapes such as cuboids, rings, and manufactured shapes (Table 2.1). Most
particles, however, are irregular and their size is generally measured by
Table 2.1
Shape
;>
.c:::==
1:1:2
1:2:2
1:1:4
1:4:4
0.93
0.92
0.78
0.70
Ellipsoid
1:2:4
0.79
diameter
2 x diameter
4 x diameter
If2 x diameter
V4 x diameter
0.87
0.83
0.73
0.83
0.69
Rectangular
parallelepiped
Rectangular
tetrahedron
Regular
octahedron
Height =
Height =
Height =
Height =
Height =
1:1:1
1:1:2
1:2:2
1:1:4
1:4:4
1:2:4
Crushed coal
Crushed sandstone
Round sand
Crushed glass
Mica flakes
Sillimanite
Common salt
0.75
0.8-0.9
0.92-0.98
0.65
0.28
0.75
0.84
'" = dsJdy
Spheroid
Cylinder
\fJ
0.81
0.77
0.77
0.68
0.64
0.68
0.67
0.83
::::::
1.13dp
d=
(2.3)
=
11 per
0.773
::::::0.87dp
(2.5)
Note that Eq. (2.5) is an approximation for particles which are non-spherical.
For spherical or near-spherical particles:
dv
::::::dsy ::::::dp
(2.6)
2.3
~ = lI~X/dp)
=253~m
where x is the weight fraction of particles in each size range. When sieving is
used, dJ, dz, ... are replaced by the averages of adjacent sieve apertures, dp;,
and the equation becomes:
1
= !'x/d ;
p
~.~
(J'
pm
Sieve
aperture,
Il-m
-600
-500
-420
-350
-300
-250
-210
-180
-150
+ 500
+ 420
+ 350
+ 300
+ 250
+ 210
+ 180
+ 150
+ 125
Size
dpi
Il-m
550
460
385
325
275
230
195
165
137
105
= 270 = 0.39
dp =
100
I7d
x p;
= 253 JLITI
Weight
percentagein
range Xi
Cumulativepercentage
undersize
0.5
11.6
11.25
14.45
100
99.5
87.9
76.65
62.2
41.4
20.8
13.85
12.5
11.9
3.15
27.55
15.05
3.15
The British Standard sieve is arranged in multiples of 4\12, and this is used as
a basis in Table 2.4 to give an idea of the relative spread as judged from the
number of sieves on which the middle 70 per cent. by weight of the powder is
found.
Table 2.4
Number of sieves
on which the middle
70% (approx.) of the
powder is found
Type of
distribution
1
2
0.03
0.17
3
4
5
based on relative
~.
Very narrow
Narrow
Fairly narrow
Fairly wide
0.33
0.41
0.48
6
7
9
11
0.6
0.7
> 0.8
>13
2.4
Very wide
The volume includes the voids inside the particle whether they are open or
closed pores. The particle density should not be confused with the bulk
density of the bed, PB, which includes the voids between the particles; Pp is
a 'hydrodynamic' density since it is based on the shape and volume which the
flowing gas 'sees'. For nonporous solids the particle density is equal to the
true, skeletal, or absolute density of the material, PABS, which is measured
by a specific gravity bottle or air pycnometer;
but for porous solids
Pp < PABS and cannot
be measured by the usual means. A mercury
porosimeter can be used to measure the particle density of coarse porous
solids but is not reliable for fine powders since the mercury may not penetrate
the voids between small particles.
In the petroleum industry the particle or piece density of the free-flowing
cracking catalyst is estimated indirectly by measuring the pore volume. When
a liquid with low viscosity and volatility, such as water, is added, the powder
should remain free-flowing until the liquid has filled all the open microscopic
pores. Any additional liquid then coats the external surface of each particle
causing immediate caking by surface tension (the 'caking end point'). This
method is not reliable for all porous powders and a simple alternative method
has been developed (Abrahamsen and Geldart, 1980). This is based on the
fact that the minimum packed bed voidage is virtually the same for particles
of similar size and particle shape. The bed voidage is defined as:
volume of bed - volume of particles
Extremely wide
volume of bed
PARTICLE DENSITY
Hydrodynamic envelope
bounding.particle volume ~
= Ii!
p
p
Pp
Pa
1 - -
(2.11)
Pp
Ppx
PaTx
k --Ppc
PaTe
(b) Particle size - the larger the particles, the lower the loosely packed
voidage (see Table 2.6); the dense packing voidage is not as dependent
on size.
Table 2.6
dp, ILm
Variation of packed bed voidage with particle size for narrow size
distributions (Partridge and Lyall, 1969)
2,890
551
284
207
101
89
72
55
0.386
0.385
0.390
0.411
0.424
0.434
0.441
0.454
230
140
82
72
0.563
0.590
0.602
550
460
390
330
0.422
0.432
0.440
0.437
Table 2.5
(c) Size distribution - the wider the size spread, the lower the voidage
(see Table 2.7).
Table 2.7
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0.45
0.50
0.55
0.60
0.65
0.70
0.75
0.80
0.85
0.90
0.95
1.00
0.507
Loose packing
Dense packing
0.85
0.80
0.75
0.80
0.75
0.70
0.67
0.72
0.68
0.64
0.61
0.58
0.55
0.53
0.51
0.49
0.47
0.45
0.43
0.41
0.432
0.469
Sand 1
Sand 2
0.63
0.59
0.55
0.51
0.48
0.450.42
0.40
0.38
0.36
0.34
0.32
(d) Particle and wall roughness - the rougher the surface, the higher the
voidage.
Through the work of Darcy and Poiseuille it has been known for more than
120years that the average velocity of fluid through a packed bed, or through a
pipe, is proportional to the pressure gradient:
t::.p
Ua-
KI-' (1 - e)2
=7
sv
-'
(2.15)
to the wall and the particles now start to move with an absolute velocity lis,
then the relative velocity (interstitial) between molecules and solids becomes:
U
USLIP.i
pgUdsv
= --
(2.16)
I-'
K is generally assumed to be 180 but there are indications that this may be
correct only for narrow cuts, voidages between 0.4 and 0.5, and Reynolds
numbers 0.1 to 1. Abrahamsen (1980) found that for fine powders of mean
size 30 to 80 !-,m,K had aV~263
(s 35 per cent.) for spherical
or near-spherical particles and 291 (s 26 per cent.) for other shapes. For
Reynolds numbers greater than about 1 the Ergun equation has proved
satisfacto ry:
Ap
= p~
P
/150 (1-e)2
~
I-'Ut
d;v
+ 1.75 l-e
pgtUf}
(2.17)
dsv
The term Pt/p is a correction factor for compressibility, where p is the average
absolute pressure in the bed. Subscript 1 denotes conditions at the inlet to the
bed. Under laminar flow conditions (Re < 1) the first term on the right-hand
side dominates:
Ap
!-'U
a -
d;v
Vs
where Ys is positive if the particles move in the same direction as the gas or is
negative if they move counter-current. The corresponding superficial slip
velocity is:
Where U is the superficial or empty tube velocity and the Reynolds number is
defined as:
Re
=- -
USLIP
= e ( ~ -
Ys)
MINIMUM FLUIDIZATION
VELOCITY Umf
When gas is passed upwards through a packed bed unrestrained at its upper
surface, the pressure drop increases with gas velocity according to Eq. (2.15)
or Eq. (2.17) until, on the microscopic scale, the drag on an individual
particle exceeds the force exerted by gravity or, on the macroscopic scale, the
pressure drop across the bed equals the weight of the bed per unit area. If the
bed has been compacted or is composed of interlocked, very angular or
cohesive particles, then an excess pressure is required to free them (points C
and C' in Fig. 2.3) and they adopt a higher voidage configuration causing a
Narrow range. well mixed bed
with increasing velocity
(2.18)
In fully turbulent flow (Re > 1000) the second term dominates and:
Ap
pgU2
a -dsv
(2.19)
Note that the surface/volume size dsv is used; if only sieve sizes are available,
depending on the particle shape, Eq. (2.5) or Eq. (2.6) should be used.
2.7
EF
(2.21)
Figure 2.3 Pressure drop across fixed and fluidized beds for group B
and D powders.
fall back to the theoretical pressure drop. With group Band D powders (see
Chapter 3) a further increase in velocity causes the formation of small bubbles
whose size increases with gas .velocity. The bed pressure drop begins to
fluctuate and if the bed is deep enough (H > 2D) the bubbles occupy a
substantial proportion of the cross-sectional area. These large bubbles are
called slugs and cause regular piston-like movements of the upper surface of
the bed. The average bed pressure drop then increases as shown in Fig.
2.4(b). If the gas velocity is now reduced, depending on the size distribution
of the powder, the pressure drop declines along curves 3,4, or 5 in Fig. 2.3. If
the powder has a narrow size range, curve 3 is followed; increasing the size
distribution (but maintaining the same mean size) results in curves 4 or 5
because the larger particles settle out progressively on the distributor. Points
D and E represent the minimum velocity required to fully support the solids
(though not necessarily in a well-mixed state) and are called the minimum
velocity of complete fluidization, Ucf' Umf is usually defined as the
intersection of the horizontal fluidized bed line EDF and the sloping packed
bed line OAB, but it is cl~ids
with a very wide size range these
could be drawn almost anywhere; the velocity corresponding to point E is of
practical interest but relatively little work has been done to predict it (see Sec.
2.11). For the present the best recourse is to make measurements and visual
observations.
The pressure drop across a fluidized bed is the only parameter which can be
accurately predicted:
Mg
tiPF
or tiPF
=-
tiPF
H
A
O.IM
A
N/m2
(2.22)
kg
m2
(2.23)
=(pp - pg) (1 -
Emf)g
(2.24)
Emf is the bed voidage at Umf and a close approximation to it can be obtained
by measuring the aerated or most packed bulk density PeLP' This is done by
pouring the powder through a vibrating sieve and allowing it to fall a fixed
height into a cylindrical cup of capacity 100 em3. The equipment is shown
later in Fig. 3.6 and for consistent results the powder should be poured
through in 20 to 30 s.
If Eqs. (2.24) and (2.17) are combined (with Pl/P = 1, AplH eliminated,
and U and E set equal to Umf and Emf, then:
~~\=\
~
Ij
::J
Remf
PgUrnpiv
p.
p.
= pplv
{ (1,135.7
'h}
+ 0.0408Ar) - 33.7
Equation (2.27) should be used for particles larger than 100 p.m (i.e. group B
and D solids) in conjunction with Eqs (2.3), (2.6) and (2.8). For particles
smaller than 100p.m, Baeyens' equation gives the best agreement with
experiments (Geldart and Abrahamsen, 1981):
small bubbles appear at the surface. These must not be confused with the
continuous channels or spouts which often appear. They resemble miniature
volcanoes which disappear when the side of the column is gently tapped.
Further increases in velocity produce, at first, a further slight increase in bed
height (see Fig. 2.6) followed by a reduction. Relatively large bubbles burst
through the bed surface periodically, causing the bed to collapse rapidly; it
then 'reinflates' slowly to collapse again as another swarm of bubbles bursts
through. Reduction of the gas velocity produces a retracing of the heightvelocity graph and finally the last bubble disappears giving once again a
quiescent bed. The average of the velocities at which the bubbles appear and
disappear is called the minimum bubbling velocity or bubble point and
generally coincides with the maximum bed height for deep beds; premature
bubbling can be caused by non-uniform distributors or protuberances in the
bed, but the maximum values of Umb have been correlated by Abrahamsen
and Geldart (1980) and found to depend on the gas and particle properties:
Umb = 2.07 exp (0.716F)
d pO.06
Po ;47
p.'
where F is the mass fraction of the powder less than 45 p.m. The numerical
constant is dimensional and SI units must be used. If F = 0.1 and the powder
is fluidized by air at ambient conditions:
Umb
= 100 d
(2.30)
Note that Eq. (2.29) implies that Umh is not dependent on particle density, a
finding confirmed independently by Simone and Harriott (1980). It must be
stressed that Eqs (2.29) and (2.30) are valid only for powders which are fine
enough (in the main, less than 100 p.m mean size) to have values of Umf less
than Umbo If the calculations show that Urnf (from Eq. 2.28) is larger than
Umb, then the powder will start to bubble at or very slightly above incipient
fluidization and Eq. (2.29) should not be used. This is discussed further in
Chapter 3.
2.9
(2.29)
PRESSURE,
This is still a relatively unknown area. Equation (2.29) indicates that Umb
increases with pressure: King and Harrison's (1982) data show agreement
with the power on density of 0.06; Godard and Richardson (1966) indicate
0.1; Guedes de Carvalho (1981) an even higher dependency.
Piepers et at. (1984) give data which show that the power depends on the
type of gas. Up to p = 15 bar, Urnb for a catalyst in H2 is affected little, in N2 as
p~.13, in argon as p~.18. The reason is not clear but adsorption of the gas in
the surface of the catalyst may have played a part and it may be that not all
fine powders behave in the same way.
Omitting any sintering effects, increasing temperature
reduces Umb
according to 1/JLO347.
In materials having a wide size range, particularly those having a large mean
size, segregation by size tends to occur at velocities close to Umf for the
mixture. Although a value of Umf can be defined for the mixture based on dp
its usefulness is limited. Knowlton (1974) defined a velocity, Uef, at which all
the particles are fully supported (even though there may be segregation) and
suggested that:
1968, and Crowther and Whitehead, 1978). Recently Wong (1983) has
shown that both nand v;/vt increases with decreasing particle size below
about 60 JLm;
is the intercept of the logE-log U plot at e = 1 and Vt is
the Stokes terminal velocity.
An alternative approach based on the Carmen-Kozeny equation was
used by Abrahamsen and Geldart (1980). Combining Eqs (2.15) and
(2.24) (with Emf = E and dp = dsv) gives:
v;
(p
-----p
As we shall see in Chapter 4, almost all gas fluidized beds operate in the
bubbling regime and consist of two phases - bubbles and the emulsion (or
dense) phase. Conditions in the dense phase (gas velocity Uo and the
corresponding
voidage ED) are the subject of much discussion and
speculation, largely because it is believed that (a) most of the chemical
conversion occurs there and (b) in fine powders the equilibrium size of the
bubbles may be controlled by the voidage, ED. The dense phase also figures
in modes of flow in standpipes or downcomers.
Uo and ED are extremely difficult to measure directly in bubbling beds
though they can be predicted for quiescent fluidization of fine powders.
(a) Voidage in non-bubbling (quiescent) beds. The earliest attempts to
measure and correlate the expansion of quiescent (or particulate)
fluidized beds in gas/solid systems were made by Davies and Richardson
(1966) who adapted the approach used by Richardson for liquid/solid
sedimentation and fluidization:
U
-=~
v[
In liquid fluidization n is a function of dpiD and the terminal velocity
Reynolds number, and varies between 4.65 and 2.4. The form of the
relationship appears to hold for gas/solid systems but experimental values
of n between 3.84 and 19.7 have been reported (Godard and Richardson,
Pg)g d~
JL
--
1-E
KfU
(2.33)
Plots of all their data using 48 gas/solid systems gave a general expression
to predict the non-bubbling expansion of a bed of fine powder, namely:
~
(pp - pg)g d~
1- E
JL
where Umfi and Xi refer to fraction of size dpi' This appears to give reasonable
agreement with experim~en
at high pressures.
= 210 (U _ Umf) +
~mf
1 - Emf
(pp - Pg)g d~
/k
Gas velocity
before cut off=O.027mA;
-
Bubble
escape stage
mb
65
..
E
~
Hindered
...,...- sedimentation
stage
0.64
J:
"t__I J J
60
0.62
H-
1r r
:t-
t__~r
bed height
55
mf
Solid
consolidation
stage \
50
l{,.f
30
2.54
Hmf
Uo
Umf
~.1
188
dg.568
ILO.066
p~.016
gO.ll8
(p
p~.089
gO.663
Umb
40
iLm
Ho
U(cm/s)
(s)
--=
I I
exp (0.09F)
pg)O.118
H?n?43
ILO.371
exp (0.508F)
(pp _ pg)O.663 hO.244
A bed of angular sand of mean sieve size 778 ILm. is fluidized by air. The
particle density is 2,540 kglm3; lL(air) = 18.4 x 10-6 kg/m s; Pg = 1.2 kglm3;
and 24.75 kg of the sand are charged to a bed 0.216 m in diameter. The bed
height at incipient fluidization is 0.447 m. Find:
(a) Emf,
(b) the pressure drop across the bubbling bed,
(c) the incipient fluidization velocity.
24.75
(1T/4)(0.216)2
Emf
1-
_
3
0.447 - 1,511 kglm
1,511
2540
0.405
H
HD
Hmf
M
2.475
----:4 = (1T/4)(0.216)2
!:J.PF =
= 1.13 x 778
= 879 x 10-6
Step 5. Archimedes'
Ar
10-6
!:J.p
!:J.PF
Re
number:
Remf
= -------------(18.4
=
fJ
10-6)3
10-6)2
Sp
59,981
Sy, SB
V,Vmf
26.15
Vcf
26.15 x 18.4 x
1.2
879
VD
10-6
10-6
Vmb
VB
Vp
VI'
2.14
A
Ar
dpi
dp
dsv
dy
D
F
cross-sectional
NOMENCLATURE
area of bed (= (1T/4) D2)
due to gravity
vi
Xi
2
E,Emf,Emb
J-Lmorm
J-L
J-Lmorm
PABS
PB
absolute
pressure
pressure
Reynolds
+ !:J.p/2)
Pp
N/m2
N/m2
m~0
m/s
m/s
m3
m3
sphericity of particle
Pg
kg
N/m2
N/m2
l/J
J-Lm or m
9.81 m/s
PBT
m
m
m
PBLP
J-Lmorm
31
m2/m3
m/s
m/s
kg/m s
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
J-Lm or m
liquid fludized systems are 'particulate' in the sense that as the superficial
velocity is increased the particles move further apart in a more or less uniform
way until they are carried out of the tube; most gas fluidized systems are
'aggregative' in that when gas additional to that required for minimum
fludization is supplied, it passes through the bed as bubbles, leaving the dense
phase at much the same voidage as it is at the minimum fluidization velocity
Urnf However, some liquid systems, like lead shot/water, can behave in a
bubbling mode, and some gas systems, e.g. a fine catalyst in a high pressure
gas, in a 'particulate' or non-bubbling mode; some of the criteria predict
correctly that these extremes of behaviour should occur, but they are not
capable of distinguishing the other differences of behaviour found in gas/solid
systems which are discussed below.
Group C
Powders which are in any way cohesive belong in this category. 'Normal'
fluidization of such powders is extremely difficult; the powder lifts as a plug in
small diameter tubes, or channels badly, i.e. the gas passes up interconnected
vertical and inclined cracks extending from the distributor to the bed surface
(Fig. 3.1b). The difficulty arises because the interparticle forces are greater
than those which the fluid can exert on the particle, and these are the result of
very small particle size, generally < 20 J.lom,
strong electrostatic charges, wet,
sticky particle surfaces, soft solids, or particles having a very irregular shape.
The pressure drop across the bed is, on the whole, lower than the theoretical
value (bed weight per unit cross-sectional area) and can be as little as half.
Particle mixing and, consequently, heat transfer between a surface and the
bed is much poorer than with powders of groups A or B. The hardness ofthe
particles has a strong influence, soft materials being more cohesive since they
deform readily and give a larger area for interparticle contacts.
Fluidization can usually be made possible or improved by the use of
mechanical stirrers or vibrators which break up the stable channels, or, in the
case of some powders, usually plastic materials, by the addition of a fumed
silica of sub-micrometre size. Porous particles tend to be non-conductive and
agglomeration may occur due to excessive electrostatic charging. Improvement can generally be effected by humidifying the incoming gas or by making
the equipment wall conducting, e.g. by coating glass with a very thin layer of
tin oxide. However, with non-porous particles humidifying the gas beyond 65
per cent. can increase cohesiveness due to deposition of a liquid film.
If powders in this group do become fluidized or aerated, e.g. by being
transported pneumatically or on an air slide, they may remain aerated for
many minutes after transfer into storage hoppers.
3.2.2
Group A
ease with which they become aerated also makes them liable to flood on
discharge from hoppers (Geldart and Williams, 1985).
Gross circulation of the powder (akin to convection currents in liquids)
occurs even when few bubbles are present, producing rapid mixing and
making the surface resemble a boiling liquid. Bubbles in a two-dimensional
bed appear to split and recoalesce very frequently, resulting in a restricted
bubble size. The bubble size is affected by the mean particle size, the mass
fraction less than 45 JLm, pressure, and temperature. Considerable backmixing of gas in the dense phase occurs, and gas exchange between bubbles
and the dense phase is high, probably due to splitting and recoalescence.
All bubbles rise more rapidly than the interstitial gas velocity, but in freely
bubbling beds the velocity of small bubbles 4 cm) appears to be about 30
to 40 cm/s regardless of bubble size, suggesting that it is the gross circulation
currents which control the rise velocity.
When the superficial gas velocity is sufficiently high and the bed diameter
sufficiently small to cause the formation of slugging conditions, the slugs
produced are axisymmetric; at superficial gas velocities between 0.5 and 1.5
m/s bubble and slug flow breaks down as entrainment becomes enormous and
a transition to transport occurs. Further' increase in velocity and the
recirculation of elutriated solids results in fast fluidization (see Chapter 7).
3.2.3 Group B
Sand typifies powders in this group, which contains most solids in the mean
size'and density ranges:
60 JLm < dp < 500 JLm when
Pp
Pp
250 JLm
l---'-
Time
= 4 g1cm3
= 1 g1cm3
Most obvious
characteristic
"- Typical
Property "solids
1. Bed expansion
Cohesive, difficult
to fluidize
Bubble~fTee range of
fluidization
Starts bubbling
at
Umf
Crushed limestone
coffee beans
FlOUT,
cement
Low when bed
channels. can be
high when fluidized
Initially fast.
exponential
No bubbles.
Channels. and
cracks
Splitting!
recoalcscence
predominate;
4. Solidsmixint
Very low
Moderate
5.
Gas backmixing"
Very low
Moderate
6.
Slug properties
Low
Low
Horizontal voids,
solids slugs.
wall slugs
properties
1 to 7'of:
Mean particle
size within
group
beds
Cohesiveness
increascs as
dp decreases
Particle
size
distributionh
Increasing
pressure,
temperature,
viscosity.
Probably
improves
density of
gas
At equal U- Um,.
b At equal dp
3.3.1
Consider particles of density difference 1,000 kglm3 and mean particle size
100 /Lill.Entering the graph from the left, the minimum fluidization velocity
line is encountered first with a Umf of 0.4 cmls and ,then the minimum
bubbling line at 1 cm/s, giving a value of Umb/Umf =2.5, indicating a bubblefree region and group A powder. By contrast, 100 /Lmalumina (pp = 4,000
kglm3) has a theoretical Umb of 1 cm/s and a Umf of 1.5 cmfs. If will therefore
bubble at minimum fluidization and fall into group B.
Thus for a powder to belong to group A or C:
U
> 1
Umf
(3.1)
Substituting from Eqs (2.28) and (2.29), a powder will be in groups A or C if:
2,300
p~.126
--~-----~.8
fJ-0.523
gO.934
exp (0.716F)
(pp _
pg)O.934
>1
(3.2)
C
(Cohesive)
100
500
dp
1000
mXI0
Figure 3.4 Diagram for classifying powders into groups having broadly similar fluidization
characteristics in air at atmospheric temperature and pressure (after Geldart, 1973)
<>
He
Ar
<>- Air
Freon 12
2 x C02
If the physical properties of air at ambient conditions are substituted into Eq.
(3.2), Fis put equal to 0.1 and Pg is assumed to be negligible compared with
Pp, then:
pg.934 ~.8
<1
(3.3)
Equation (3.3) is shown in Fig. 3.4 as line XX. Powders with size/density
combinations to the left of the line belong in groups A or C when fluidized by
air at ambient conditions.
The ratio of the incipient bubbling and fluidization velocities - the
velocity ratio - is a useful guide in characterising the fluidization behaviour
of fine powders. From Eq. (3.2) we see that UmJUmf increases as particle size
and density decrease and from Fig. 3.5 that the bed expansion ratio in
bubbling and non-bubbling beds increases with an increase in the velocity
ratio. However, this trend does not continue indefinitely for if the powder
~IE
I-Ie
II
1.5
II
3
Umb
Umf
becomes too fine (typically, less than about 20 ~m) cohesivity assumes
greater importance and the 'quality of fluidization' rapidly deteriorates.
If the physical properties of the powder are maintained constant and no
other effects such as particle sintering come into play, Eq. (3.2) predicts that
UmJUmf
(and hence the fluidization properties) should improve if the
temperature andlor pressure increase, or if the gas composition changes in
such a way that ~O.523 p~.126 increases. Conversely, if the gas is changed from
air to hydrogen a ambient conditions the powder may change from smooth
group A behaviour
group B with its large bubbles or slugs. The reasons for
this are not clear but ay involve gas adsorption on to particles.
The physical proper ies of the gas usually remain constant in a fluidized
process but those of th powder may not. If fines are produced by attrition
and are not lost from the system, F will increase and dp decrease. This will
increase UmJUmf and at first improve the fluidization, but if it continues,
eventually it may change the powder into the excessively cohesive group C,
and result in poor fluidization; this kind of behaviour has been observed
industrially as well as in the laboratory.
Conversely, loss of fines through inefficient cyclones would reduce F and
increase dp; UmblUmf could decline to a value near or less than 1 and move the
powder into group B, causing large bubbles or sluggingand loss of conversion
in a chemical reactor. This has also been observed experimentally.
3.3.2
FH
There are two criteria which can be used to determine the BID boundary. The
first is based on the mode of gas by-passing, discussed in Chapter 11. In small
particle systems all but the smallest bubbles travel much faster than the
interstitial gas, and gas tends to stay in the bubble' except during coalescence
and splitting (see Fig. 3.7a).
Gas motion
relative to
bubble
U<-b
Emf
Q\
.!;;
~
~o.
Q:J
~
~u
.. 0
a
"0
.0
c:
5Q.l
~.~
00.
0.
c:
d:
en
"
',.
I
.'
...L:..::
-,'
.- - ..... ~...
'
eo
::::::
i:.
'
f....
:-...
-0
"
"
. '."
Emf
Umf
"'E
Umf
>--
'".
__
~~.
'"'"
In large particle systems, all but the largest bubbles travel slower than the
interstitial gas and gas short-circuits the bed by entering the bottom of a
bubble and leaving the top. It is clear that when considering groups Band D
we are really looking at a continuum because the form of by-passing which
occurs depends not only on Umf but also on the velocities of bubbles and
hence their sizes. The bubble size depends on the excess gas velocity U-Umf
and the height above the distributor; so within a large, deep fluidized bed
near the distributor there would be small bubbles travelling more slowlythan
Urn/Emf and higher up the bed, large bubbles travelling more quickly.
In spite of this complexity the situation can be simplified considerably by
choosing a bubble size and calculating the density/particle size combinations
of powders in which bubbles smaller than this would rise faster than Umf/Emfl
i.e. in the throughflow mode (Fig. 3.7b).
the particles increase, and as the liquid viscosity decreases (Jackson, 1971).
All these parameters are in the correct qualitative relationship to one another
in Eqs (3.1) and (3.2), which were developed for gas fluidized systems.
Replacing subscript g by L to denote liquid fluidization,
For large particles, 0.5 > Emf> 0.4, say 0.45. Bubbles in commercial
fluidized beds usually have sizes in the range 0.1 to 0.25 m due to limitations
imposed bY~beddepth, gas velocity, or internal tubes. For bubbles smaller
than 0.25 m, Ub < 1.1 mls and a powder will be in group D if:
Umf> 0.5 m/s (approx.)
than 0.1 m,
Ub
(3.7)
If:
Umf> 0.3 mls (approx.)
(3.8)
The minimum fluidization velocity Umf can be found from Eq. (2.27) and this
has been done for air at ambient conditions to give the size/density
combinations which must satisfy Eqs (3.7) and (3.8), that is lines ZZ and YY
respectively in Fig. 3.4. By and large, the effect of increasing temperature
and/or pressure is to reduce Umf and this would cause YY and ZZ to move to
the right; i.e. the system would become more B-like.
There is another criterion for distinguishing between groups Band D; this
is entirely empirical, being based on experimental measurements of the
spoutability of powders. Whether or not a powder can be spouted depends
not only on the size and density of the particles - nozzle diameter bed
depth, ~nd bed.di~meter a~lplaya part. Baeyens and Geldart (1973)ad~pted
the arbitrary cntenon that If a bed of the powder 0.3 m deep can be spouted it
belongs to group D; this gave the numerical inequality that if:
Umb
--=
Umf
Since there are rarely any particles less than 45 fLm in a liquid fluidized
system F = 0 and the exponential term in the numerator becomes equal to
unity.
In a series of photographs, Harrison, Davidson, and de Kock (1961) show
the appearance of liquid fluidized beds of various solids. Lead shot was
fluidized by various concentrations of glycerol solutions in order to vary the
liquid viscosity, and paraffin was used to fluidize particles having approximately the same size but different densities.
In Table 3.2 the basic data relating to the experiments of Harrison,
Davidson and de Kock (1961) are listed, together with values of Umb/Umf
calculated from Eq. (3.10) and the qualitative appearance of the beds as
judged from the photographs reproduced in Davidson and Harrison (1963). It
can be seen that at values of UmJUmf less than about 2 the beds exhibited
slightly or appreciably disturbed fluidization, which may be construed as
equivalent to bubbling in gas fluidized beds; at higher values of Umb/Umf the
beds appeared to be quiescent. This qualitative agreement is encouraging and
. warrants further investigation. For the present the inequality below may be
used with caution to identify liquid fluidized systems likely to exhibit nonquiescent behaviour at voidages up to 0.75. Thus 'bubbling' will occur if
3.4
APPLICATION
TO LIQUID FLUIDIZATION
It has long been known that in some liquid fluidized systems instabilities
which resemble bubbles can be seen, for example 770 fLm lead shot in water
(see Davidson and Harrison, 1963). The instabilities develop and grow more
rapidly as the bed expands (i.e. as U/Umf increases), as the density and size of
The concept of four broad groups of powders each of which has distinctive
fluidization characteristics is now widely accepted. Their representation on a
'phase' diagram (Fig. 3.4) when air is the gaseous medium is useful but shows
only part of the picture. As we move away from groups D and B towards
groups A and C, parameters other than particle density and mean size assume
increasing importance, and a multi-dimensional diagram is required. There
remains much to be understood, but two lessons emerge from the ideas
presented above.
Weight (%)
of
glycerol
Appearance of
bed of Yoidages
of:
PI
kglm3
10-3
36.3 x
16.6 x 10-3
3.58 X 10-3
X 10-3
1
1,190
1,170
1,110
1,000
75
66
39
0
Pp
UmJUmf
0.6
0.75
(Eq. 3.10)
Q
Q
Q
Q
SB
SB
B
B
6.57
4.36
1.94
0.98
11,320 kglm3, dp
-30
+20
-45
+30
1,500
2,900
7,430
11,320
(Eq. 3.10)
Q
Q
Q
Q
SB
SB
B
19.8
5.9
2.03
1.32
Liquid : PI = 780
JLI =
kglm3
2 X 10-3 Ns/m2
-63
+53
-75
+63
-90
+75
1
particle + lIskeletal
porosity density
1
_
3
0 .4+ 1/3 - 1.364 gm/cm
0.1
UmJUmf
0.75
-53
+45
0.65
Cold model tests using air show the powder to have ideal fluidization
properties.
Conditions in the full-scale plant are such that the gas density and viscosity
will be 1 kg/m3 and 1.3 x 10-5 N s/m2, respectively.
Over a period of several months the conversion efficiency decreases and a
sample of powder from the bed is found to have a particle porosity of 0.1
cm3/gm and only 5 per cent by weight less than 45 p.m.
770 JLm
Appearance of
bed at Yoidages
of:
kg/m3
0.4 cm3/gm
= 3000
3
lf3
= 2.31
gm/cm
2,300
= 3.09
mb
U
Umf
U
~
Umf
2.51
/-L
/-Ll
1.115
The powde /gas system is clearly in group A under both cold model and initial
reactor co ditions, which would give ideal fluidization behaviour. Under the
final reac or conditions the powder is close to group B with consequent
reduction in bed expansion and catalyst fluidity.
PsT
PsLP
kg/ms
kg/ms
kg/m3
kg/m3
Step 3. Es 'mate the maximum stable bubble sizes for initial and final reactor
using Eq. (4.13)
(a) Initial conditions. Calculate terminal velocity for particles:
2.7 dp, that is 2.7 x 58 /-Lm = 157 /-Lm and Pp = 1,364 kg/m3
From Eq. (6.12), CDRe2 = 408; from Fig. 6.7, Ret = 9.6; therefore;
lit = 0.795 m/s
From Eq. (4.12): (deq)max =
2 v~
0.127 m
(deq)max = 0.467 m
(c) Comments
The much lower UmJUmf value for the final reaction conditions is a clear
predictor of deteriorating fluidization conditions, and the larger maximum stable bubble size confirms this. Coupled with a lower particle
(internal) porosity it is not surprising that the conversion efficiency
suffered.
9.81 m/s2
m/s
m/s
rn/s
m/s
Baeyens, J., and Geldart, D. (1973). In Fluidization and Its Applications, Toulouse, p.
263.
Hydrodynamics of Bubbling
Fluidized Beds
The behaviour of most gas fluidized beds is dominated by the rising gas voids,
conveniently termed 'bubbles', which characterize these systems. In analysing
the behaviour of bubbling fluidized beds, it is essential to distinguish between
the bubble phase (or 'lean phase'), i.e. the gas voids containing virtually no
bed particles, and the particulate phase (also known as 'dense phase' or
'emulsion phase') consisting of particles fluidized by interstitial gas. A
bubbling bed can conveniently be defined as a bed in which the bubble phase
is dispersed and the particulate phase is continuous. The flow regimes
observed at high velocity, discussed in Chapter 7, correspond to beds in which
the volume occupied by the lean phase is so high that the particulate phase no
longer forms a continuous medium between discrete bubbles.
Therising bubbles cause motion of the particulate phase which is the main
source of solids mixing in bubbling beds, discussed in Chapter 5. This particle
motion in turn causes the temperature uniformity and high bed/surface heat
transfer coefficients characte'ristic of fluidized beds and reviewed in Chapter
9. Since the gas in a bubble is not in direct contact with the bed particles, it
cannot take part in any reaction between gas and solids. Thus interchange of
gas between bubbles and interstitial gas in the particulate phase can
determine the performance of a fluidized bed reactor. The influence of
bubble characteristics on fluid bed reactors is explained in Chapter 11. Thus
an understanding of the behaviour of the bubble phase in fluidized beds is
essential for understanding the applications of these devices. Section 4.2 of
the present chapter considers the behaviour of individual bubbles and of
53
slugs, i.e. bubbles so large that their shape and rise velocity are determined by
the dimensions of the column containing the fluidized bed rather than by their
own volume.
The gas which fluidizes the bed and forms bubbles must normally be
distributed uniformly over the cross-section of the bed; this is achieved by
introducing it through a gas distributor. Design requirements for gas
distributors are d'
sed in Section 4.3, and the flow patterns observed in the
vicinity of the distributo
re reviewed in Section 4.4. Finally, the behaviour
of continuously slugging an freely bubbling beds is discussed in Sections 4.5
and 4.6, concentrating on prediction of the most important characteristics:
bubble size and flowrate, and bed expansion.
In many respects, bubbles in gas fluidized beds are analogous to gas
bubbles in viscous liquids (see, for example, Davidson, Harrison, and Guedes
de Carvalho, 1977). This analogy has been of immense value in interpreting
the behaviour of bubbling fluidized beds, since bubbles are more readily
observable hi transparent liquidS, and the analogy is used throughout this
chapter. There is, however, an important difference between liquids and
fluidized beds. A gas bubble in a liquid is bounded by a distinct interface;
material can be transferred across this interface by diffusion but not by bulk
flow. On the other hand, the surface of a bubble in a fluidized bed is a
boundary between a particle-lean region and a region of high solids
concentration which is permeable to gas. Therefore bulk flow can occur
between a bubble and the surrounding particulate phase, so that material can
be transferred across the boundary by convection as well as by diffusion.
These processes of interphase transfer are considered in detail in Chapter 11..
where Vb is the bubble volume. A bubble in a viscous liquid shows the form of
Fig. 4.1 if it is sufficiently large for surface tension forces to be negligible
(Clift, Grace, and Weber, 1978), i.e. if
Eo
PI d~q g > 40
(T
where PI and (T are the liquid density and interfacial tension, and the
dimensionless group Eo is known as the Eotvos number. Since fluidized beds
lack a phenomenon equivalent to inteliacial tension, (T is effectively zero.
Thus bubbles in fluidized beds satisfy Eq. (4.2), and the analogy is
reasonable.
The shape of such a bubble can conveniently be described by the 'wake
angle' between the nose and the lower rim, Ow in Fig. 4.1. Grace (1970)
showed that Ow is a function of the bubble Reynolds number:
50
JLI
(Eo>
(4.4)
Reb
4.2.1
= (-2---3-CO-S-o:-+-c-o-s3-Ow-
Figure 4.1 shows an idealized bubble, the general shape being well known
from photographic studies of bubbles in liquids (see, for example, Clift,
Grace and Weber, 1978) and X-ray studies of bubbles in fluidized beds (see,
for example, Rowe, 1971). The upper surface of the bubble is approximately
spherical, and its radius of curvature will be denoted by r. The base is
typically slightly indented. Since r is not readily determinable, it is usually
more convenient to express the bubble size as its 'volume-equivalent
diameter', i.e. the diameter of the sphere whose volume is equal to that of the
bubble:
tw.
"Note that the wake fraction is sometimes defined as the wake volume Vw divided by the bubble
volume Vb, in which case it is given the symbol ~w' The relationship between the two is ~w =
/.J(1 - /w).
Bubble
volume
Vb
Wake
Angle
8w
gO
Wake
volume
Vw
Shape
Parameters
y~-----
Wake Fraction
Reb
Figure 4.2
number.
more rounded and the wake fraction decreases, from 0.4 for 50 /-Lm cracking
catalyst to 0.28 to 0.3 in group B ballotini. More recently, Rowe and Yacono
(1976), working with freely bubbling beds of groups A and B reported that
~article size had no detectable effect on average bubble shape.' However, it is
lIkely that the changes of shape resulting from bubble interaction and
coales.cence (see Section 4.6) masked any effect of particle characteristics.
Cranfield and Geldart (1974) report that bubbles in group D beds lack a
58
GAS FLUIDIZATION
TECHNOLOGY
deeply indented base (that is ()w approaches 180); in terms of Fig. 4.2, this
confirms that group D materials display very high effective.viscosity, so that
Reb is low. Although theory is lacking, irregular particles are likely to show
higher effective vi~osity and therefore lower Reb and wake fraction. Results
quoted by Ro~1)971) show exactly this effect: the wake fraction in beds of
irregular particles is typically 0.2 compared to 0.28 to 0.3 in beds of spherical
material. Increasing bubble size in a medium of fixed viscosity increases Reb
and should therefore increase the wake fraction. Rowe and Everett (1972)
observed such an effect, and Rowe and Widmer (1973) showed that the
results were well correlated by:
Vb
w
V = 1- V
=
,ph
,ph
where the braced term is a weak function of Reb, as shown in Fig. 4.2. For
Reb > 100 this term is constant at 0.71, and the resulting expression:
exp (- 0.057db)
4.2.2.
below the range for which Eq. (4.7) is strictly valid in liquids. Even so, Eq.
(4.7) has been widely used for fluidized beds, and inaccuracies are no doubt
masked by the erratic velocity variations typically observed (Rowe and
Yacono, 1976). In terms of the volume-equivalent diameter, Eq. (4.7) can be
written:
has been widely used to predict the rise velocity of isolated bubbles in
fluidized beds (Davidson and Harrison, 1963). However, observed rise
velocities are generally smaller than predicted by Eq. (4.9), values of
ut/V(gdeq) from 0.5 to 0.66 being typical for groups A and B (see'Davidson,
Harrison, and Guedes de Carvalho, 1977). From Fig. 4.2, these values
correspond to Reb < 60, broadly consistent with the range inferred from the
bubble shape.
For groups A and B, it is possible to estimate bubble rise velocities from the
shape, as expressed by the wake fraction V wIV'Ph, and this approach is at least
self-consistent. From Eq. (4.8), it follows that:
V2 (
Ub
= -3
)116
1
1- V IV
w
sph
V(gdeq)
For rounded group B particles, Eq. (4.6) can be used to estimate VWlVsph' For
angular group B particles, the wake fraction is typically 0.2, so that
ut/V(gdeq) should be roughly 0.5. The shapes of bubbles in group A particles
suggest that Reb is about 10, so that ub/V(gdeq) should befrom 0.5 to 0.6.
For group D particles, Cranfield and Geldart's (1974) results give:
Davies and Taylor (1950) showed that the rise velocity Ub of a spherical cap
bubble is related to its radius of curvature by:
Ub
2/3 V(gr)
(4.7)
Experimental results show that Eq. (4.7) is reliable for bubbles in liquids if
Reb is greater than about 40; below this value, departures from the spherical
cap shape have a significant effect on Ub(Clift, Grace and Weber, 1978).
Bubbles in fluidized beds typically have Reynolds numbers of order 10or less,
Since db and deq are virtually the same in group D beds, Eqs (4.9) and (4.11)
are equivalent. This is unexpected, since observed bubble shapes suggest that
group D prticles should be treated as low Reb systems (see Section 4.2.1). In
the present state of the technology, all that can be concluded is that treating
the dense phase as a Newtonian medium does not explain all features of
bubble behaviour and that Eqs (4.9) and (4.11) can be used in group D beds.
that Eq. (4.12) predicts the correct order of magnitude for the maximum
bubble size. Matsen (1973) found that Eq. (4.12) underpredicts the maximum
bubble size, typically by a factor of 4, the difference being larger for very fine
particles. Geldart (1977) suggests that a better fit with experimental data for
group A powders is obtained if the terminal velocity in Eq. (4.12) is
calculated for particles of size:
d;
= 2.7d
(4.13)
where dp is the mean size of the powder (Eq. 2.8). Figure 4.4 shows (deq)max,
for particles of density 2,500 kg/m-', fluidized by air at 1 and 15 bar, and 300
and 1,000 K, calculated from Eq. (4.12) with Vt estimated from the
correlations given by Clift, Grace and Weber (1978) (see Fig. 6.7) and using
Eq. (4.13). For group D and large group B particles, the maximum stable
bubble size is so large that in practice it would not impose a limitation on the
size of bubbles present in a bubbling bed. For both group A and group B
particles, increasing temperature and, especially, increasing pressure reduces
the maximum bubble size, thus tending to make fluidization 'smoother'. This
is consistent with observations (see Chapter 3).
.
;;1000K
//300K
(4.12)
1mm
10!J.m
100!J.m
1000 !J.m
dp
Figure 4.4 Maximum stable bubble size as a function
of mean size of powder, and gas pressure or temperature (calculated using Eqs 4.12 and 4.13).
4.2.4
Wall Effects:
Slugs
Provided that deq is less than about 0.125 times the bed diameter D, the shape
and rise velocity ot a bubble are unaffected by the walls. For deqID greater
than 0.125, waJlAffects reduce the rise velocity and cause the bubble to be
more rounfte, so that the wake fraction is reduced (Clift, Grace, and Weber,
1978). For deqID between 0.125 and 0.6, the rise velocity can be estimated
roughly (Wallis, 1969) by:
Ub
)
l.13Uboo exp- (dD
eq
(4.14)
where Uboois the rise velocity in the absence of wall effects. For deqlD greater
than 0.6, the bubble velocity becomes completely controlled by the bed
diameter, and the bubble is then termed a 'slug'. Figure 4.5(a) shows
schematically the shape of an ideal slug. The rise velocity of such a slug is
given (see Clift, Grace, and Weber, 1978) by:
Usi = 0.35 Y(gD)
(4.15)
Slugs sometimes adhere to the wall of the tube, as shown schematically in Fig.
4.5(b); in this case the rise velocity is approximately Y2 times the value from
Eq. (4.15).
Figure 4.5(c) shows a rather different type of slug, more accurately termed
a 'plug' , or solids slug, which completely fills the column so that particles rain
through the void rather than moving around it. For groups A and B, this
phenomenon normally occurs only in tubes of small diameter. For coarse,
very angular, or cohesive particles, 'plug' flow occurs in beds of much larger
diameter and is suppressed by roughening the walls (Geldart, Hurt, and
Wadia, 1978).
Clearly slugs can only exist if the diameter of the largest bubble is greater
than q.6D. The question of whether a continuously fluidized bed contains
bubbles or slugs is considered in Section 4.6.
:
:
4.0
77.3
H20: 7.8
S02 : 10.9
The bed is operated at velocities many times minimum fluidization, so that it
will be assumed to be fully mixed with the off-gas composition also
representa~ive of the gas~s within the be~. The bed particles, primarily ZnO,
have denSity 5,300 kglm . The calculatlOns are carried through for 30 p,m
particles (group A) and 100 p,m particles (group B) . ..The latter is typical for
the surface-volume mean diameter of bed particles in such an operation. Two
possible beds are considered (Fig. 4.6):
(a) A production plant of large diameter.
(b) A pilot plant 0.2 m diameter.
Solution
(a) Maximum stable bubble size. The properties
as:
Figure 4.5 (a) Axisymmetric slugs, (b) asymmetric slugs, (c) solids, square-nosed or
'plug' slugs.
100 p,rn
Group B
270 p,rn
174.6
5
3.18
2.06
rn
2.46 rn
Notes
Equation (4.12) predicts reasonable values for (deq)max for both group A and
group B particles. n practice it is unlikely that the bubbles would reach 2.06
m in diamet . the group B particles because the normal operating bed
depth would be insufficient. Frontal diameter in each case is calculated
assuming that the wake fraction is 0.4; this value is reasonable for the group A
particles, and is probably reasonable also for group B given that the particles
are not smooth and spherical (see Section 4.2.1).
b) Isolated bubble rise velocity. Bubble rise velocity is calculated from Eq.
(4.10). Assuming that the wake fraction, VwIVsph, is constant at 0.4, Eq.
(4.10) gives:
Uboo
= 0.51 V(gdeq)
= 1.61 V deq m/s with deq in m
For a bed of diameter 0.2m, wall effects become significant for deq >
2.5 cm (see Section 4.2.4); they are therefore slightly significant for
bubbles in the 30 /-Lm particles. In a bed of 100 /-Lm particles, wall effects
must be considered. Curve (b) in Fig. 4.6 shows values calculated from
Eq. (4.14) for 2.5 cm < deq < 12 cm and from Eq. (4.15) for deq > 12cm.
Clearly the two equations do not match at deql D = 0.6. The discontinuity
occurs because Eq. (4.14) was developed for bubbles with high Reh, for
which Uboo is given by Eq. (4.9). Bubbles in fluidized beds are more
'rounded' (that is 8w is larger), so that for given deq they rise more slowly,
have smaller dh, and are less sensitive to wall effects. Equation (4.15) is
well tested for fluidized beds, and may therefore be applied with more
confidence. Best estimates are therefore obtained by replacing Eq. (4.14)
by an interpolation of the form shown by the broken curve in Fig. 4.6.
{m/sl
ensures that the plate is at a temperature close to that of the incoming gases,
although the bed itself may be at a much higher temperature. In the type of
distributor usually known as a 'tuyere', shown in Fig. 4.7(b), the riser has a
single hole whos .is is vertical. Alternatively, the riser may be capped and
the cap .
with radial holes, usually four, sixor eight in number, as shown
in Fig. 4.7(c). With this type of distributor, sometimes termed 'multi-hole
tuyere', the gas enters the bed horizontally. The operating advantage is that
weeping and dumping of solids through the distributor are much reduced if
the radial passages are sufficiently long. A similar advantage is achieved by
the type of distributor shown in Fig. 4.7(d), known as a 'quonset' ('Quonset'
being the American term for what is known in the British Commonwealth as a
'Nissen huf). Here the riser is capped by a horizontal length of pipe cut on a
plane through its axis to form a half-cylinder whose open side is level with the
top of the refractory. The risers may also be capped by bubble caps similar to
the devices used in distillation (see Kunii and Levenspiel, 1969).
Design Criteria
APB
0.01
+ 0.2 { 1- exp
(~:)}
so that a pressure drop ratio of 0.21 is required for large diameter beds. If the
bed solids contain tars or other 'sticky' components, it is advisable to increase
this value to at least 0.3.
Since the value of APB is fixed by the weight of solids per unit bed area (see
Chapter 2), selection of an appropriate value for Apo/ApB fixes the required
I::.po, The number of orifices, nozzles, etc., to achieve this pressure drop
must now be selected. We consider first the simplest case of a perforated plate
distributor. If the superficial gas velocity in the windbox is Uw and the
fractional open area of the distributor (i.e. the fraction of the total area open
to gas flow) is fon then the average gas velocity through the orifices is:
Uor
Uw
= -;:lor
It should be noted that Uw differs from the superficial gas velocity in the bed if
the entering gas is at a different temperature from the bed, or if the processes
occurring in the bed cause a change in molar f1owrate, or if the distributor
pressure drop is a significant fraction of the absolute operating pressure.
The pressure drop through the distributor then follows from Bernoulli's
equation:
A
Pgw
Po = -2-
I(c:--)2 Uor
2}
Uw
where Pgw is the density of gas in the windbox and Cd is the orifice discharge
coefficient, which accounts for the fact that the gas does not pass uniformly
through the whole orifice area so that the true average velocity is greater than
Uor' Normally for ~ 1 so that Uor ~ Uw and Eqs (4.17) and (4.18) can be
simplified to give:
for
Uw
Cd
jf.\2Apo
Pgw
Ideally, dor should be as small as is feasible: reducing dor decreases the size of
bubbles formed at the distributor, and therefore improves gas/solid contacting in the bed (see Chapter 11). It is also advisable to check that all
orifices will be equally 'active' in passing gas into the bed, by a criterion
developed by Fakhimi and Harrison (1970) which can be written:
Uw
( -U
)2
>1+
(2)
m/)
2pp g(]-E
------
1--
Lj
(Cdfor)2
--
Pgw
7T
mfw
Umfw
where Pp is the particle density, Emf is the void fraction in the bed at
minimum fluidization, Lj is the length of the jet above the orifice (see Section
4.4.1), and Umfw is the minimum fluidization velocity corresponding to gas at
windbox conditions. If Eq. (4.23) is not satisfied, the orifice diameter should
be reduced to reduce Lj
With distributors of the tuyere type, the form and dimensions of each
tuyere are normally fixed in advance by other considerations. The number of
holes or orifices is then selected to give the required Apo. For an initial
estimate, Eq. (4.18) can be used, rearranged as:
Uort
2Apo
Cd ( --
+ Uw
)112
Pgw
_ j(2APo)
(4.19)
-Cd
--
Pgw
The discharge coefficient depends on the shape of the orifice and is also a
weak function offor (Perry and Chilton, 1973). There is also a possibility that
the gas passing through an orifice into a fluidized bed experiences less
pressure drop than in the absence of particles (see Qureshi and Creasy, 1979).
For square-edged circular orifices with diameter dor much larger than the
plate thickness t, Cd can be taken as 0.6. For t/dor > 0.09, Cd can be estimated
by a correlation given by Qureshi and Creasy:
Cd
= 0.82 (
d:
0.13
where Uort is the first estimate for the mean gas velocity issuing from each
hole into the bed and Cd is estimated for the exit holes; i.e. the upper orifice
for a tuyere (Fig. 4.7b) and the radial holes for a multi-hole tuyere (Fig. 4.7c).
If the exit area per hole is aon the number of holes required per unit bed area
is:
(4.20)
Fixing for by Eq. (4.19) fixes the ratio of centre-to-centre hole spacings to dor
For orifices on equilateral triangle pitch:
s
dor
7T
2forv'3
)tn
0.9523
v'for
7T
4for
) 1/2
0.8862
v'for
-2-
(2
2)
UR - Uw
U~
+ Pgw 4 =
Pgw
(3U4~_ U2~)
where UR is the mean gas velocity in the riser, The first term on the left of Eq.
(4.28) results from application of the Bernoulli equation, while the second
represents the mechanical energy loss resulting from formation of a vena
contracta at the shar' contraction.
Pressure drop due t wall friction in the riser is usually negligible. The
upper orifice of a tuye
is treated as a contraction, sharp or rounded
depending on the profile.
ntry to the outlet holes of a multi-hole tuyere is
treated as a 'tee' followed by a contraction, while a 'quonset' is equivalent to a
'tee' with flow entering the branch. The pressure drop ti.PO,I is evaluated as
the sum of the contributions from each change in gas velocity or direction.
The final estimate N for the number of holes per unit area is obtained using
the fact that the pressure drop is proportional to U~r:
N=NIJ(~;~l )
pressure drop across the distributor and bed as 1.54 x 104 N/m2 and estimates
the distributor pressure drop as approximately 0.53 x 104 N/m2. Hence:
Bed pressure drop = 1.54 x 104
= 1.01 X 104
Distributor
0.53
N/m2
UOr=-N
104
0.159 m/s
Uw
aor
Solution
(4.31)
where Uin is the mean gas velocity in the duct entering the windbox. Normally
this requirement imposes no further restriction on ti.po.
(a) Single-hole tuyeres Figure 4.8(a) shows the cast steel tuyeres used in the
installation described by Avedesian (1974). The pressure drop across each
tuyere is made up of three components:
(i) Contraction loss of entering the 'riser' tube of 22 mm Ld. If the gas
velocity in the 'riser' is UR metres per second then the contraction loss is
estimated from Eq. (4.28) as:
Pgw
3U~ U;')
( -4- - -2-
1.0125 UR
0.01706 N/m
UR
13.44 UR
X (~)
This example considers possible distributor designs for the zinc sulphide
roaster introduced in Example 4.1. Since the solids may have a tendency to
'stickiness',
the distributor will be designed following the criterion of
Agarwal, Davis, and King (1962) (see Section 4.3.2) to give ti.po as the
greater of 0.3ti.PB and 3.4 x 103 N/m2 Avedesian (i974) gives the total
(2~)2
0.0744
which is sufficiently low that the appropriate form of Eq. (4.28) can be
applied (Perry and Chilton, 1973). The contribution to the pressure drop
is then estimated as:
contribution.
= 183.2 U~
- 0.01706 N/m2
7T
4:" X
(0.022)2 UR
~mm
~mm
so that N = 96.8 holes/m2. Since there is only one hole per tuyere 968
tuyeres/rn2 are needed.
Area associated with one tuyere = 1.03 x 10-2 m2
i.e. if the tuyeres are arranged on square pitch, the centre to centre spacing is
V(1.03 X 10-2) = 0.102 m. This is precisely the value reported by Avedesian
(1974).
(b) Multi-hole tuyeres Figure 4.8(b) shows a possible alternative design
utilizing a similar 'riser', but with four radial holes each of 3 mm internal
diameter. The total hole area is the same as for the single-hole tuyere in case
(a). The pressure drop components considered in case (a) are still present,
with an additional term arising from the deflection of the gas entering the
holes. Treating the configuration as a 'tee', the extra pressure drop is
estimated (Perry and Chilton, 1973) as Pgw U~12 = 7.95 x 10-2 Uit N/m2.
Hence the total pressure drop is 183.3U~ - 0.01706 N/m2 This is
essentially indistinguishable from the value for case (a), because the pressure
drop is dominated by the velocity in the exit holes which is the same in the two
cases. Thus the spacing for these multi-hole tuyeres should be the same as for
the single-hole tuyeres.
In each case, the gas enters the bed at pressure 1.154 - 0.034 = 1.12bar at
density 1.35 x 1.2111.154 = 1.31 kg/m3. Correcting to these conditions, the
gas velocity entering the bed, Uan is 13.44 UR x 1.154/1.12 = 59.8 mls.
4.4.1
= 15 {(
Pg
Pp -
)
Pg
U;T }
0.187
gdOT
where Lj is the jet length and Pg and Pp are the densities of the gas and
particles. While Eq. (4.32) appears to be the most reliable correlation for
temperatures
close to ambient, the scant available evidence (Ghadiri and
Clift, 1980) suggests that only the correlation due to Merry (1975) gives
reasonable predictions for elevated temperatures:
Lj
dOT
5.2 (
pgdOT
ppdp
)0.3
11.3 (
U;T
gdOT
)0.2 .- If
where dp is the mean bed particle diameter. Equations (4.32) and (4.33) were
developed for particles in groups A and B, but there is insufficient evidence to
assess their validity for group D. For horizontal jets, another correlation due
to Merry (1971) may be used:
_i
L
dOT
5.25 [ ptlp
ppdOT
UOT
(1 - Emf)
Pgw
ppdpg
f2]0.2
4.5
where Pg and Pgw are the gas densities in the bed and windbox. The
appropriate density for use in Eqs (4.32) and (4.33) is not clear; it is probably
more realistic to use Pgw where this differs from Pg.
4.4.2
Bubble Formation
Davidson and Schiiler (see Davidson and Harrison, 1963) have given an
analysis of bubble formation at a single upward-facing orifice in a fluidized
bed, in which the particulate phase is treated as an incompressible fluid of
zero viscosity. The initial bubble volume Vo is predicted to be a function of
the volumetric gas flow rate through the orifice QOT> but not of the orifice
diameter:
The coefficient in Eq. (4.35) is appropriate for an orifice in a flat plate; for a
protruding tuyere it should be replaced by 1.14. The frequency of bubble
formation follows as:
Qor
tb.o=-V-
The treatment of Davidson and Schiiler assumes that all gas entering the bed
forms bubbles; in fact the bubble flowrate is usually less than QOT> so that Vo is
overestimated. The error becomes particularly significant for Qor less than
about 20 cm3/s; in this case, more complicated semiempirical equations given
by Clift, Grace, and Weber, (1978) should be applied. Equations (4.35) and
(4.36) are consistent with the observation that bubble frequency is only
weakly sensitive to QOT but at high Qor the predicted frequency tends to be
too low. Bubble frequencies around 20 S-l (Rowe, MacGillivray, and
Cheesman, 1979) have been reported for high Qor' Therefore, if Eq. (4.36)
predicts tb.u less than about 10 S-l, it is probably more realistic to assume that
tb.o is 10 S-l and estimate Vo as Qo/tb.o'
Semiempirical correlations to predict the size of bubbles formed at a
distributor containing a number of gas injection points are summarized in
Table 4.1. In these expressions, Ao (U - Umf) is the gas flow in excess of that
required for minimum fluidization passing through each orifice (since Ao =
1IN), and is thus analogous to Qor in Eq. (4.35) (see Section 4.5.2). The form
of the expressions derives directly from Eq. (4.35), which can be written in
terms of the volume - equivalent diameter, deqo, as:
and the result given by Morl and Wen (1975) is essentially Eq. (4.37) in c.g.s.
units. Geldart (1972) and Darton et al. (1977) give slightly larger values, but
the differences are small and there is no clear reason for preferring anyone
correlation. The results all refer to particles in groups A and B; their accuracy
for group D is untested.
Table 4.1 Correlations for bubble size in fludized beds In the followingexpressions,
z indicates distance above distributor, D the bed diameter, and Ao the distributor area
per orifice for multiple orifice or tuyere type distributors. The forms given here for the
correlations of Geldart (1972) and Mori and Wen (1975) require dimensions in
centimetres and velocities in centimetres per second. Any consistent set of units can be
used in the correlations of Darton et al. (1977) and Rowe (1976). The parameter deqm
in the Mori and Wen correlation represents the diameter which would be attained if all
the fluidizing gas above that required for minimum fluidization were to form a train of
bubbles rising on the bed axis. The parameter Za in Rowe's correlation is a
characteristic of the distributor, effectively zero for a porous plate.
Expression
Author
Darton
el
al. (1977)
dcq
= 0.54(U-U
mf)"4(Z
[ = 0.411
{A,,{U-Umr)}".4
in centimetre units I
dh
Ii..,
= dcq.m
- (dcq.m - li..,.o)e-O.3zJD
de"."
= 0.347
{A,,(U-Umf)}"4
perforated plates
= 3.76 x 1O-'(U-Umr)2
porous plates
= 5
2d
or
d
Pg or
d
( V~r) -IJ
)0.3
0.2
gdor
Pp p
= 0.095 m
It is typical that the estimate from Merry's correlation is smaller than that
from Yang and Keairns'. To ensure that excessive erosion of surfaces such
as heat exchange tubes is avoided, such surfaces would be located no less
that 0.15 m above the ends o~._
For the second distributor of Example 4.2, the gas enters
the bed horizontally through nozzles of diameter dor = 3 X 10-3 m. From
Merry's correlation, Eq. (4.34):
Lj _- 5.25dor [ -- pgdp
1.43 {A,,(U-Umrllo.4g-0.2
0.027z( U- Umr)lI .
L.
Multi-hole tuyere.
= 0)
+ 4v'A,,)""g-"2
ppdor
= 7.8 x 10-3 m
for
for
where Emf has been assumed to be 0.4 and Pg is 0.32 kg/m3 (see
Example 4.1). If this estimate, that the horizontal jets persist for less than
1 cm from the holes, is reliable, then no especial precautions need to be
taken in the orientation of the holes. lithe jet penetration is comparable
to the tuyere spacing, then the holes should be directed so that a jet
cannot reach neighbouring tuyeres and cause excessive erosion.
(b) Initial Bubble Size
For each of the distributors in Example 4.2, the gas enters the bed with
velocity Vor = 59.8 mls and density Pgw = 1.31 kg/m3. The bed particles,
described in Example 4.1, have density Pp = 5,300 kg/m3 and diameter dp =
10-4 m.
Single-hole tuyere. For the first distributor considered in Example 4.2, the
gas enters the bed vertically through holes of diameter dor = 6 X 10-3 m.
Two estimates for the jet length are then:
(i) Yang and Keairns (Eq. 4.32);
Lj == 15dor
= 0.15 m
I(
rPc.r
Pgw
Pp
Pgw
gdor
0.187
Gas entering the bed reaches the bed temperature rapidly. Avedesian (1974)
reports that the superficial velocity in the bed, corresponding to conditions
for whi~h the distributor has been designed, is V = 0.78 mis, while the
minimum fluidizing velocity Vmf is approximately 0.005 mls.
For the single-hole tuyeres, the bed area per hole is Ao = 1.03 X 10-2 m2
(see'Example 4.2). Hence the excess gas flow per hole is:
Qar
=
=
Ao (V - Vmf)
3
8.0 x 10- m /s
The Davidson and Schiiler result (Eq. 4.37) then givesthe initial bubble size as
deq,o = 1.38 x (8.0 x 10-3).4 (9.81)-0.2
0.127 m
Since the spaces between tuyeres are filled with castable refractory to the
level of the nozzles, the form appropriate to orifices in a flat plate has been
used.
This result may be compared with the expression in Table 4.1. In c.g.s.
units:
{A (U - Umf) }Oo4 = (S.O X 103)04 = 36.4
o
deq,o
db.o
(deqo
= 15.0 cm = 0.15 m
= 13.1 cm = 0.131 m
= 0.61/3 X 0.131 = 0.110 m)
deq,o =
12.6 cm
0.126 m
Thus the estimates for deq,o are comparable and all are larger than the tuyere
spacing (0.102 m; see Example 4,2). It thus seems unlikely that the tuyeres act
independently. However, in the current state of the art, little further can be
said.
For multi-hole tuyeres, the area and gas flow per injection point is one
quarter ()f the value for the single-hole tuyeres. Assuming that the same
relationships can be used (questionable for horizontal gas entry), we obtain
the following estimates for deq,o:
Davidson and Schuler:
deq,o
= 0.073 m
Darton et al:
Geldart:
Mori and Wen:
deq,o
= 0.086 m
= 0.075 m (deq,o = 0.063 m)
= 0.073 m
db,o
deq,o
(Eq. 4.37)
Again, the values for deq,o are sufficiently large to suggest that the tuyeres are
not generating bubbles independently.
4.5.1
of the depth of the bed. For group B particles, the maximum stable diameter
is larger and typically only attained in the upper levels of deep beds;
generally, the average bubble size then increases steadily with distance from
the distributor. Measurements of bubble size reported by Werther (1975) give
an excellent illustration of this difference between groups A and B. Group D
particles show a behaviour which is again differert (Cranfield and Geldart,
1974): bubbles rise as horizontally associated swaml~; and grow by absorption
of neighbouring bubbles rather than conventional coalescence,
In addition to controlling the vertical profile of bubble size, coalescence
also sets up horizontal non-uniformity in the bubble distribution in beds of
groups A and B. This effect is shown schematically in Fig. 4.9(a), with typical
. coalescence processes shown in Fig. 4.9(b). Bubbles generally coalesce by
overtaking a bubble in front, shown by (i) in Fig. 4.9(b), and may move
sideways into the track of such a bubble before coalescing, shown by (ii) in
Fig. 4.9(b). Thus coalescence can cause lateral motion of bubbles. Bubbles
formed close to the wall of the bed can only move inwards as a result of this
process, since the bubbles surrounding them are only on the side away from
the wall, whereas bubbles nearer to the axis have equal probability of
migrating in any horizontal direction. As a result of this preferential
movement of bubbles away from the wall, an 'active' zone of enhanced
bubble flowrate forms a small distance in from the wall. The higher
concentration of bubbles leads to more frequent coalescence and hence larger
bubbles in this zone. Since the region between the wall and the annular
'active' zone is lean in bubbles, coalescence continues to cause preferential
migration towards the bed axis. Thus the 'active' zone intensifies and moves
closer to the axis with increasing height above the distributor. At heights of
the order of the bed diameter, virtually the whole of the bubble flow occurs
close the ~ axis. This effect was first observed and explained by Grace and
Harrison (1968), but has since been confirmed by many independent studies.
Large beds essentially divide into cells, to form several bubble tracks rather
than a single axial track (Whitehead, 1971). Quantitative prediction of the
development of bubble profiles is possible (Farrokhalaee and Clift, 1980), but
generally requires extensive computer calculations. Qualitative recognition of
this effect helps to interpret the behaviour of freely bubbling beds. An
important consequence of the non-uniformity in bubble flow is gross solids
circulation (see Chapter 5). Generally, solids move up in regions of high
bubble activity and downwards elsewhere; the resulting circulation pattern
(observed, for example, by Masson, 1978) is shown schematically in Fig.
4.9(a). In the upper levels of the bed, particle motion is commonly described
as 'gulf-streaming', up on the axis (or bubble tracks) and downwards near the
walls. At lower levels, the particle motion is down near the axis. Although
coalescence sets up this kind of circulation even if gas enters the bed
uniformly across the distributor, the effect is amplified by the motion of the
dense phase, which reduces bubble formation near the axis and enhances it
near the walls (Werther, 1975; Farrokhalaee and Clift, 1980).
Because of the importance of the walls in initiating the flow pattern shown
in Fig. 4.9(a), the details of the bubble flow pattern depend on the scale of the
equipment as well as on the characteristics of the particles and distributor.
The resulting difficulty in predicting the behaviour of a large bed from tests
on a smaller pilot unit lies behind the problem of scale-up of fluidized bed
reactors discussed in Chapter 11. Moreover, since coalescence effects differ
quantitatively in two and three dimensions, one may not simply assume that a
bubble size distribution measured in a two dimensional bed is the same as that
existing in a three-dimensional bed of the same particles (see Chapter 13).
-..-._
4.5.2
Bubble Flowrate
A=
1 t t t t
(i)
(iilO
U - Urnf
4.5.3
Correlations abound in the literature for the mean bubble size across
horizontal sections in freely bubbling beds. Some of the more recent and
more successful are summarized in Table 4.1. That due to Geldart (1972) is
based primarily on data for relatively small beds, and generally gives values
for frontal diameter (db) which are too high for large-scale beds; its value lies
primarily in estimating the bubble diameter formed at the distributor (dbo)'
The remaining three correlations generally give comparable estimates, which
is perhaps not surprising since they are derived by similar semiempirical
arguments and are based on much the same data. The value of deqm in the
correlation of Mori and Wen (1975) represents the maximum bubble size
attainable by coalescence, and is distinct from the maximum stable size
(deq)max discussed in Section 4.2.3. The correlation of Rowe (1976) contains a
parameter Zo characterizing the distributor: essentially, Zo is the height above
a porous distributor at which bubbles would have attained the size formed at
the distributor actually used. Rowe gives some typical values for zo, but no
general results from which it can be estimated. It is therefore necessary to
estimate dbo from, for example, the correlation of Geldart (1972) and then
estimate 2 as:
0
Zo =
4.0 g
(U -
umff
lIt3
f
where Ub is the rise velocity of an isolated bubble of the same size (see Section
4.2). Equation (4.41) is developed by analogy with slug flow, and the
applicability to freely bubbling beds is questionabr, (see Section 4.6 and
Turner, 1966). In fact, UA > Ub, primarily as a consequ ce of the increase in
bubble velocity caused by coalescence, and there is some vidence (Farrokhalaee and Clift, 1980) that Eq. (4.41) accounts apprOXI ately for the
average effect of coalescence in a freely bubbling bed. Thus Eq. (4.41) can be
applied to a bed overall, although instantaneous bubble velocities vary widely
about this result and the mean velocity for a given bubble diameter varies
with position in the bed, being highest in the 'active' zones where coalescence
is frequent.
4.5.4 Bed Expansion
Consider a section such as AA' in Fig. 4.9(a), across which the visible bubble
flowrate is Qb and the average bubble velocity is Uk The average fraction of
the bed area occupied by bubbles is then:
Qb
Eb
= --
AUA
Werther (1975) has given a correlation for beds with porous distributors
which could perhaps be adapted to other types of distributors in the same
way.
There is no strong reason for preferring anyone of the correlations by
Darton et al., Mori and Wen, and Rowe; probably the safest approach is to
use all three and average their results. The correlations should be used up to
the heigbt at which either the bubbles attain their maximum stable diameter,
(deq)max, or become large enough to be treated as slugs (deq = O.6D). In the
former case, the bubble size should be assumed constant at higher levels; in
the latter case, the upper levels of the bed should be treated as slugging.
These results were derived for groups A and B. For group D particles,
Cranfield and Geldart (1974) give a correlation for estimating the frontal
diameters of bubbles:
in c.g.s. units, where Umb is the minimum gas velocity at which bubbles form.
Since bubbles do not originate at the distributor in group D particles, Eq.
(4.40) contains no term describing the distributor and should only be used for
h > 5 em.
AHo
= A- foH (1 -
dz
Eb)
=A
1-
Qb)
AUA
dz
(4.43)
from Eq. (4.42). Following assumption (a) of the two-phase theory (see
Section 4.5.2), if the particulate phase remains at the void fraction
corresponding to minimum fluidization, then AHo is equal to the total bed
volume at minimum fluidization, AHmf Equation (4.43) then becomes:
H-Hmf=
Qb
-A
UA
dz
which gives the expansion of the bed above its depth at minimum fluidization.
This general result can be simplified if Qt!A is approximated by the two-phase
theory (Eq. 4.38) and UA is estimated from Eq. (4.41):
H - Hrnf
(U - Urnf) dz
------
(U - Urnf)
+ Ub
0.168m
suggesting that the initial bubble size is equal to that present 0.168 m above a
porous distributor. The correlation of Mori and Wen also requires:
deq.m= 0.374 (7T x 6382
= 590 cm = 5.9 m
X'
77.5)4cm
This is much larger than the maximum stable bubble size, estimated as:
(deq)max= 2.06 m
Equation (4.47), derived by Davidson and Harrison (1963) for the case where
Ub is constant in the bed, is equivalent to a result for slug flow given in Section
4.6. In addition to design calculations of bed expansion, it is also frequently
used to infer mean values of Ub and hence deq or db from measurements of bed
expansion.
In the following example, bubble properties and mean bed density are
estimated for the fluidized bed roaster considered in Examples 4.1 to 4.3. The
bed in question, as described by Avedesian (1974), has diameter D = 6.38 m
and expanded depth 1 metre. The distributor is of the single-hole tuyere type,
designed in Example 4.2 (a), with one such tuyere per 1.03 x 10-3 m2 of bed
area. The superficial velocity at bed conditions is taken as 0.78 m1s (see
Example 4.3b), so that
(b)
Using the values of deq given in column 5 in Table 4.2, the isolated rise
velocity is estimated as in Example 4.1. The average rise velocity at any level
is then calculated from Eq. (4.41), and the average local bubble fraction is
then estimated from Eq. (4.42), in the simplified form derived from the twophase theory:
1. Darton et al.
z
0
2. Geldart
deq
deq
db
3. Mori and
Wen
deq
5. Average
4. Rowe
deq
db
deq
0.129
0.256
0.210
uA
0.578
0.738
1.35
0.573
1.51
0.512
0.474
0.25
0.150
0.220
0.131
0.534
0.110
0.450
0.126
0.193
0.5
0.75
1.0
0.285
0.347
0.406
0.937 0.790
1.340 1.130
1.740 1.470
0.260
0.367
0.310
0.285
0.86
0.326
0.467
0.559
0.393
0.471
0.355
0.422
0.96
1.046
0.391
(O.13)h (0.110)
ub
0.218
1.635
1.734
1.82
11
Eb
0'5
/J,4
(m/s)
1'5
Eb
~~ :::::-....
0.447
0.425
:::,.....
::::::,...
13
a The initial bubble size is taken to apply at the level of the distributor,
although it could be
argued that these values apply at the ends of the distributor jets (see Example 4.3a).
b Values for use in the Rowe correlation deduced from Geldart's correlation.
Resulting values are given in Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.10. The local average
bubble velocity increases, and the average local bubble fraction decreases
with height above the distributor.
Bed expansion is estimated by applying Eq. (4.45) to estimate Hmf In
terms of b, Eq. (4.45) is written:
0'4
0'5
0.573 - 0.212z
(z s 0.4)
0.53 - 0.105z
(z ~ 0.4)
(0.573 - 0.212z) dz
= 0.53H
- 0.052H2
...-';"---J
.--//
= f~.4
/~
/~~.
~::.--
From the values in Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.10, E'b can conveniently be
approximated by a piecewise linear form shown by the broken lines in Fig.
4.10:
H - Hmf
/~
03
H-Hmf=f::E'bdz
4-
deq
(m)
J:
0'1
z(m)
1-0
05
Figure 4.10 Bubble sizes, rise velocities, and volume fractions as a function
of level in bed.
The corresponding
4 (0.53 - 0.105z)dz
E'b
+ 0.008
H - Hmf
H
0.486
E'mf)
g Hmf
=
=
where the void fraction in the particulate phase, Emf, is assumed to be 0.5.
This estimate is of the right order, but is rather larger than the value of 1.01 x
104 N/m2 estimated by Avedesian (see Example 4.2). Several factors could
contribute to the discrepancy:
(i) The nominal expanded depth of 1.0 m corresponds to the distance from
the distributor to the solids overflow chute. Because of 'splashing' of
particles by erupting bubbles, the mean bed surface will be some
distance below the overflow chute.
(ii) The mean bubble size in the bed is determined from equations based on
data relating to ambient air. If the bubbles are actually smaller, as seems
likely at high temperature, then Ub and UA will be lower, Eb will be
higher, and the bed pressure drop will be lower than the estimated value.
(iii) Equation (4.41), used to estimate bubble rise velocity in a freely
bubbling bed, is known to be an approximation (see Section 4.5.3) and is
not well tested for operation at high gas velocity, as in the present
example.
with c.g.s. units used. The second term on the right is omitted if Hrnf >
60Do.175, and Eq. (4.48) then becomes identical with a result derived for deep
beds by Stewart (see Hovmand and Davidson, 1971).
(a) The maximum stable bubble size, (deq)max, is greater than 0.6D, where D
is the tube diameter.
(b) The gas velocity is sufficiently high.
(c) The bed is sufficiently deep.
Condition (a) depends on the properties of gas and particles (see Section
4.2.3). Conditions (b) and (c) are combined in a criterion for slug flow
developed by Baeyens and Geldart (1974). The minimum gas superficial
velocity for slugging, Urns, is related to the velocity Urnf and bed depth Hrnf at
minimum fluidization by:
Urns
Urnf
+ 1.6
10-3 (60Do.175
Hmf)2
+ 0.07
V(gD)
(4.48)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
_--.J
L_
ttt
Figure 4.11
A-
I
I
I
I
Thus the present example serves to illustrate the limitations as well as the
application of currently available results.
-1
I"""-
(U - Urnf) +
(U - Umf)
Usl
+ 0.35
V(gD)
(4.50)
(4.51)
using the expression for Usl for an ideal slug from Eq. (4.15). Equation (4.50)
has been carried over by analogy to freely bubbling beds (see Davidson and
Harrison, 1963) and is the origin of Eq. (4.41). The derivation of Eq. (4.50)
shows one of the reasons why the theoretical basis of Eq. (4.41) is uncertain:
in a freely bubbling bed, it is not normally possible to define a section like
AA' which passes through no bubbles and across which the particulate phase
velocity is constant.
Matsen, Hovmand, and Davidson (1969) showed that the maximum height
of a slugging bed, Hmax, is related to its depth at minimum fluidization, Hmf,
by:
0.514 m
51.4 cm
=
=
=
Hmax
Hmf
U - Urnf
Hmf
Us!
which is analogous to Eq. (4.47) for freely bubbling beds. In order to design
the depth of vessel needed for a bed in which slug flow is anticipated, the
overall maximum bed depth is required. Equation (4.52) should therefore be
used with the minimum value for UsI, i.e. the value for an ideal slug (Eq.
4.15), giving
U - Urnf
0.35 V(gD)
0.78 mls
= 78 cm/s
0.103 mls
Since the operating velocity is so much larger than Um" it is likely that slug
flow will obtain throughout most of the depth of the bed. From Section 4.2.4,
flow may be considered slugging if: .
deq
> 0.6D
0.31 m
when deq
X ZO.8
0.12 m
HYDRODYNAMICS
Hrnax
= Hrnf
=
( 1+
U - Urnf)
Us/
0.775 )
0.514 ( 1 + 0.490
where the rise velocity of a single slug, us/, is taken as 0.490 mis, the value
calculated in Example 4.1. From the above:
Hrnax
1.33 m
H
Hd
Hmf
Hmax
Lj
N
Qb
Qor
r
Reb
ReI
s
cross-sectional
A
Ao
Cd
Co
db
db,o
deq
Eo
fb.o
for
fw
UA
Ub
Usl
UsA
U
Uin
Urnb, Urnf
Urnfw
Urns
Uor
UR
Uw
OF BUBBLING FLUIDIZED
93
BEDS
acceleration of gravity
height of fluidized bed
height of dense phase in a bubbling bed
height of bed at minimum fluidization velocity
maximum bed height
length of jet
number of orifices per unit cross-sectional area
visible bubble f10wrate
volumetric gas f10wrate per hole
bubble radius
bubble Reynolds number (Eq. 4.3)
9.81 mls
m
m
m
m
m
m-2
m3/s
m3/s
m
m
m
m/s
m/s
m/s
m/s
m/s
m/s
mls
mls
m/s
mls
mls
mls
Vsph
Vw
z
bubble volume
initial bubble volume
volume of bubble and wake
volume of wake
distance above distributor
mls
m3
m3
m3
m3
mls
Zo
parameter
[3w
VI
Vb
Vo
in correlation
of Rowe (1976)
94
tlPB, tlPD
Eb
Emf
8w
IL
ILl
Pg
Pgw
PI
Pp
u
GAS FLUIDIZATION
TECHNOLOGY
N/m
N s/m2
N s/m2
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
N/m
Doganoglu, Y., Jog, V.,Thambimuthu, K.V., and Clift, R. (1978). Trans. lnstn
Chern. Engrs, 56,239.
Donsi, G., Massimilla, L., and Colantuoni, L. (1980). 3rd Eng. Found. Conf. on
FI';ti~ization(Eds J ..M. Matsen and J.R. Grace), Plenum Press, p.297.
Fakhlml, S., and Hamso~, D. (1970). Cherneca '70, Instn Chern. Engrs, p.29.
Farrokhalaee, T., and ClIft R. (1980). 3rd Eng. Found. Conf. on Fluidization (Eds
J.M. Matsen and J.R. Grace), Plenum Press.
Geldart, D. (1972). Powder Technol., 6,201.
Geldart, D. (1977). 'Gas Fluidization', Short Course. University of Bradford, p.114.
Geldart, D., Hurt, J.M., and Wadia, P.W. (1978). A.I.Ch.E. Svmp. Ser., 74 (176)
60.
.,.
Ghadiri, M., and Clift, R. (1980). Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., 19,440.
Grace, J.R. (1970). Can. J. Chern. Eng., 48,30.
Grace, J.R., and Clift, R. (1974). Chem. Eng. Sci., 29,327.
Grace, J.R., and Harrison, D. (1968). Instn Chem. Engrs Syrnp. Ser., 30, 105.
Hanway, J.E. (1970). Chern. Eng. Prog. Syrnp. Ser., 66 (105),253.
Hetzler, R., and Williams, M.C. (1969). Ind. Eng. Chern. Fund., 8, 668.
Hovma~d, S., and Davi?son, J.F. (1971). Chapter 5 in Fluidization (Eds J.F.
DaVIdson and D. Hamson), Academic Press.
Kunii, D., and Levenspiel, O. (1969). Fluidization Engineering, John Wiley and Sons
Inc.
Agarwal, J.C., Davis, W.L., and King, D.T. (1962). Chern. Eng. Prog., 58 (Nov.), 85.
Avedesian, M.M. (1974). Paper 5d, 24th Annual Conference of C.S.Ch.E.
Baeyens, J., and Geldart, D. (1974). Chern. Eng. Sci., 29, 255.
Clift, R., and Grace, J.R. (1972). Chern. Eng. Sci., 27,2309.
Clift, R., Grace, J.R., and Weber, M.E. (1974). Ind. Eng. Chern. Fund., 13,45.
Clift, R., Grace, J.R., and Weber, M.E. (1978). Bubbles, Drops and Particles,
Academic Press.
Cranfield, R.R., and Geldart, D. (1974) Chern. Eng. Sci., 29,935.
Darton, R.C., LaNauze, R.D., Davidson, LF., and Harrison, D. (1977). Trans. Instn
Chern. Engrs, 55,274.
Davidson, J.F., and Harrison, D. (1963). Fluidised Particles, Cambridge University
Press.
Davidson, J.F., Harrison, D., Darton, R.C., and LaNauze, R.D. (1977). Chapter 10
in Chemical Reactor Theory, A Review (Eds L. Lapidus and N.R. Amundson),
Prentice Hall.
Davidson, J.F., Harrison, D., and Guedes de Carvalho, J.R.F. (1977). Ann. Rev.
Fluid Mech., 9, 55.
Davies, R.M., and Taylor, G.!. (1950). Proc. Roy. Soc., Ser A, 200,375. ,k
Solids Mixing
5.1
1NTRODUITlON
In category 1 the main problem, generally, is to ensure that the overall solids
transport or circulation flux is high enough to eliminate temperature
gradients; in categories 2,3, and 4 an additional concern is whether the local
composition of the powder - however defined - is everywhere equal to the
overall average. The amount of solids circulation and degree of local mixing
or segregation is primarily determined by the gas velocity, but particle shape,
97
size, density, stickiness, and size distribution all playa part. Bed and column
geometry can also be important.
Experimental Methods
--~
"-
//
It is well known that vertical,mixing in fluidized beds is many times faster than
lateral mixing. Indeed it seems likely that solids move in a net horizontal
direction largely by being (a) carried up to the surface where they are
dispersed sideways by bursting bubbles and (b) carried down to, and across,
the distributor by bubble-free flows of dense phase material.
Much of the early work on mixing mechanisms was done by Rowe and
Partridge (1962, 1965). Layers of coloured and colourless particles were
disturbed by injected bubbles and photographed in two-dimensional beds:
These studies showed that in an idealized case, particles are carried upwards
in the wake of the bubble (defined as the solids occupying the bottom of the
completed sphere) and in the drift (defined as the region behind the
completed sphere) (see Figs 5.1 and 5.2). Particles appear to be pulled into
the wake or drift, carried up the bed for a distance, and then shed. Thus,
particles travel upwards where there are bubbles and, by continuity,
downwards where there are not.
_~,:t
...
.. ~r
..
;. ~ ',!
~L
"
"o.,'t'"
:'~"'\
""-:f":
Mfl~dl ~jltil
l.~
Colourless solid
(b) Coloured solid
(0)
5.3
VARIABLES
Bubble-lean
regions
00
00
00
00
(d) The solids flow is not easily changed from its 'natural' circulation
pattern, though gross deliberate 'mal-distribution' at the distributor
can be effective in shallow beds (Fig. 5.4c).
(e) The presence of tubes or baffles modifies the flow patterns shown:
with vertical tubes radial mixing is reduced slightly; with horizontal
tubes, depending on the fraction of the cross-section occupied, vertical
mixing can be inhibited to the point where the bed effectively becomes
staged.
(f) Flow patterns can be time-dependent and cyclic, with changes
occurring over several minutes.
(g) In group A powders bubble sizes and velocities are limited by the
properties of the powder and gas (see Chapter 4, Section 4.2.3). Also,
because the dense phase has a low effective viscosity, circulation
velocities are similar to or higher than the isolated bubble velocities,
and the absolute bubble velocities, UA, turn out to be relatively
independent of bubble size.
'"
I
t
I
~L1J
~
t
I
o t
.~ )1
t:J.
Figure 5.4 Solids circulation patterns in beds having different aspect ratios and distributors at
approximately equal velocities (after Whitehead and Dent, 1982).
t
~
5.4.1
The Parameters
is evident from the foregoing that the mixing rate (J) ought to be defined in
terms of the volumetric flowrate of bubbles through the bed, the amount of
terial each bubble drags up with it, the velocity at which the solids rise, and
the fraction of the bed consisting of bubbles. Thus:
Qb
UA
Eb
Parameter f3
Rowe and Partridge (1962) showed that the amount of solids travelling in the
the bubble wake Vw, expressed as a fraction of the bubble volume Vh,
decreases with increasing particle size. Baeyens and Geldart (1973) studied
the fraction of the solids in the drift f3d, defined as volume of the drift divided
by bubble volume, and found that this also decreases with increasing particle
size. Their data are shown in Table 5.1 and expressed, somewhat speculatively, as functions of the Archimedes number in Fig. 5.6. For most group B
powders /3d is larger than f3w which averages about 0.35. For group D and
Parameter Qb
The quantity of gas appearing as bubbles should be, according to the twophase theory, equal to (U - Umf)A (see Section 4.5.2). It is in general less
than this, and Eq. (4.38) can be rewritten:
Powder
Catalyst
Angular sand
Rounded
sand
47
252
470
106
195
Qb
A=
f3w
{3d
0.43
1.00
0.42
0.28
0.70
0.52
0.50
0.25
0.82
0.65
0.26
0.20
0.32
0.30
1.00
~-
c---
....
0.5
0.4
03
group A solids, f3w may be, respectively, 0.1 and 1. Thus, a bubble of a given
volume produces a much greater degree of particle movement in, for
example, a bed of cracking catalyst than in a bed of coal ash.
Y(U - Urnf)
02
0.1
103
102
Refs.
-----Parameter
Geldart. D. (l96B)
Werlher.J.
(1975)
.., Geldart.
D. (1970)
Werther.J.
X Geldarl.
D. and
Everell.
D. (1969)
Chavarie. C. (1973)
Baeyens.J.
and
Cranlield,R.R.
Geldart.
(1972)
D. (1981)
D.J. (1970)
Eb
om
1
H - Hrnf
H
Alternatively, it can be predicted approximately from Eqs (4.46) and (5.2):
Parameter
UA
Eb
QJA
Y(U - Urnf)
= --;;;:: =
UA
Y(U - Urnf)
U - Urnf
+ Ub
(5.4)
downwards elsewhere, a mass balance in any horizontal plane cutting the bed
gives:
=(
~~a~:~O:o~~sbed)
x(~~~~~:rd~
move down
particle
velocity
1 -
substituting
Eb -
for
V
Eb
p -
(f3w
+ f3d)
Eb
~:~t~~e~:
.) x (~JI~~rds)
sohdsmove up
velOCIty
velocity range covered. Local values of the particle velocity may be several
times smaller or larger than the average (Nguyen, Whitehead, and Potter,
1978).
(5.5)
5.4.3
vp
UA f3w Eb
+ 0.38
UA f3d Eb
(5.6)
---------
1-
f3w
Eb -
+ 0.38 f3d
}
)
Y (U - Urnf
Eb (f3w + f3d)
( ~~~Iation) =(~~~~ity)
rate
of dense
phase
The term within the first bracket is largely dependent on the particle
properties
and decreases with increasing particle size. Experimentally
measured values of vp (Baeyens and Geldart, 1973) are shown in Fig. 5.8 and
seen to be straight lines; separate measurements of f3 and Y, and values of
Eb calculated
from Eq. (5.4), gave good agreement with the slopes over the
x(
x (~:o~s)
sectIOnal
area
(5.1S)
(em/s)
~~~c~~~
~~ere) x(~e;~rdS)
solIdsmove
solids
upwards
velocity
Pp (1 -
Circulation Flux
Emf) (UAf3wEb
+ 0.38
UAf3dEb)
Eb:
Pp (1 -
Emf)
(U - Urnf) Y (f3w
+ 0.38f3d)
(5.10)
This can be compared with the empirical equation of Talmor and Benenati
(1963) obtained in a 0.1 m diameter bed with ion exchange resin particles of
67 to 660 JLm:
J (kg/m2s) = 785 (U - Urnf)e-6,630dp
\
10
The two equations agree reasonably well for group B particles but Eq. (5.11)
increasingly underestimates J for larger group D materials. In Fig 5.9
experimental values from the literature are compared with predicted values
(Eq. 5.10) and reasonable agreement is obtained.
At equal values of excess gas velocity, U - Urnf, the circulation flux
decreases as particle size increases; however, the circulation fluxes in beds of
large particles can be made large by increasing U - Urnf
12
5.4.4
Figure 5.8 Particle velocities at bed wall as a function of excess gas flow
(Baeyens and Geldart, 1973).
(5.11)
Hrnf
t
(f3w
+ 0.38f3d) Y (U - Urnf)
Whitehead, and Potter (1978) injected CO2 gas near the bed surface and
measured the concentration at 49 positions below the injection point. They
used two sands having Urnf values of 2.5 and 10.7 cm/s and found that the CO2
concentration profiles reflected strongly the downflow patterns of the solids
at various superficial fluidizing velocities (see Section 5.3 (a)). They maintain
that for non-absorbing particles, backmixing commences when the ratio
U/Urnf is about 3, and this reflects the fact that, for a given value of U - Urnf,
both solids mixing and gas backmixing decreases as particle size increases.
However, in view of the wide range of values for Y, f3w, and f3d as particle
size changes, it would be surprising if the critical ratio at which backmixing
commences remained at 3 for all solids.
On the basis of Eq. (5.7) and the criterion that gas backmixing becomes
significant when vp > Urnfi, there are grounds for believing that for group A
and group D solids, the critical values of U/Urnf may be smaller and larger,
respectively.
Gas backmixing is influenced considerably by the degree to which the gas is
absorbed on the particles (Nguyen and Potter, 1974), and Bohle and van
Swaaij (1978) showed that the mean residence of a strongly adsorbing
gas (freon-12) injected into the bed can be a factor of ten longer than that for
a weakly absorbing gas (helium). Thus the critical velocity ratio at which gas
backmixing commences decreases as gas adsorption on the particle increases.
102
J pred
(kg/m2s)
Whitehead
Cranfield
- Geldart
t.
Werther
(1976)
et al
(1979)
of experimental
(1978)
For a bed to which solids are continuously added and from which reacted
products are removed (e.g. fluidized bed limestone calcination), the turnover
time should be short compared with the solids residence time: i.e. good
dispersion requires that the feed material should experience as many
circulations as possible before discharge. Little research has been done on this
but a ratio of residence time/turnover time of 5 to 10 seems reasonable.
If the bed is fully mixed, tracer will appear immediately in the offtake at a
concentration Co = m/M and the concentration in the exit, C, will then fall
according to:
This is a function of the downwards velocity of the dense phase, vp' If vp
exceeds the interstitital gas velocity, UrnriEmt. then gas will be carried
downwards with the solids. Working in a 1.22 m square bed, Nguyen,
-=
Co
e -tit
110
"->
.,
__ m kg tracer
-----
Co
1,,->0
M kg solids in bed
"
-'"
F kg/s
'0
c:
c:
.=..
.~
'"
g'"
'0
Iii ..0
~
c:
E'E
'"
c:
A bed may be 'well fluidized' in the sense that all the particles are fully
supported by the gas may still be segregated in the sense that the local
composition does not correspond with the overall average. Defluidization can
be regarded as a special case of segregation in that some or all of the bed,
usually that near the distributor, may be immobile. Segregation is likely to
occur when there is a substantial difference in drag/unit weight between
different particles. Particles having high drag/unit weight migrate to the
surface while those with low drag/unit weight migrate to the distributor.
When fluidized, the upper part of the bed will attain a fairly uniform
composition, while the component that tends to sink forms a concentrated
bottom layer. If the particles differ only in size, the larger particles settle to
the bottom. Nienow and Rowe, who have done a considerable amount of
work on segregation caused by density differences (e.g. Nienow, Rowe, and
Cheung, 1978) have used the words flotsam and jetsam to describe the solids
which occupy, respectively, the top and bottom of the bed. In non-technical
English flotsam means 'floating wreckage' and jetsam, goods thrown out to
lighten a ship and later washed ashore! A quantitative measure of segregation
is required and two parameter are often used:
solids feed
'E
0
'C
Q)
~
Q)
Ol
~
~
Q)
(em Is)
18
Symbol
Weir height
25
""
35
= 15 em
Rate of solids
flow
Mean
residenCe
Mean
particle
time 7 R
size
8kg/min
2.6 min
XB
= 1.6 mm
Figure S.10 External age distribution of traeer solids in a fluid bed with
constant solids feed - tracer added instantaneously at tflR = 0 (Cranfield,
f= 1 - e-t1tp.
in a completely
~
-
x 100
+ XT
(b) The mixing index M 1 is defined as x/x, where x is the concentration of'the
material under scrutiny at some level in the bed and x is its average
concentration.
(5~
A significant percentage of solids (18.2 per cent.) spends less than 20 p~r cent.
of the average residence time tR in a fully mixed bed. This problem can be
solved in shallow beds ( < 0.15 m) by installing vertical baffles or making the
bed in the form of a long channel (see Chapter 10). Baffles are sometimes
used in deeper beds but become progressively less effective in preventing
short-circuiting of solids as bed depth increases. There is a need for further
work on baffled deep beds.
5.7
-XT)
1978)
XB
Cs is defined as:
Researchers
often use the words segregation and defluidization interchangeably and this makes for difficulties in interpretation of published data.
5.7.1
Methods of Investigation
5.7.2
Segregation is much more likely to occur when the powder contains particles
of different densities than when the size range is very broad; Decamps,
Dumont, and Goossens (1971), Bena et at. (1968), and several other groups
of workers have investigated segregation by density difference. In the papers
of Nienow, Rowe, and coworkers (Rowe, Nienow, and Agbim, 1972;
Nienow, Rowe, and Cheung, 1978) various combinations of heavy and light
particles were fluidized. Rather complex empirical correlations were developed and have proved quite useful:
UTa
UrnfS
(UrnfB)
UrnfS
(d )o.7
2.2
Yx
dL
PL
Figure 5.11 Pressure drop curve for wide size distribution powder initially
well mixed (Boland, 1971).
top
bed
(5.17)
where UrnfB and UmfS are the bigger and smaller mlmmum fluidization
velocities of the two sets of particles; PH and PL are the particle densitities
of the denser and less dense particle; dH and dL are the sizes of denser and less
dense particle; x is the mass fraction of the denser particles in the whole bed;
Hand D are the height and diameter of the bed; UTa is the critical velocity at
which mixing takes over from segregation. In general, UTa> Uet.
Having calculated UTO it is then inserted into Eqs (5.18) and (5.19) to
calculate the mixing index M1:
.
U - UTO
z=----e
U - UmfS
UfU
TO
t[L:x=x
height
HlDY4
(1 _ e-
I
I
bottom
1.
mass fraction
reference
5.7.3
size
PERFECT MIX
COMPLETE
HORIZONTAL
SEGREGATION
Providing the operating gas velocity is larger than Ucf, the velocity of
complete fluidization, there will not be a fixed bed (defluidized) region at the
distributor. However, that is not to say that the bed will be well mixed; it may
be segregated with more coarse at the bottom and more fines at the top.
Boland (1971), working with particles up to about 550 /Lm, developed a
bubbling bed model to predict the value of U - Umf required to avoid
x~oP = (dp)Q
d
Xf
)b
( U -U U
rnf
rnf
by the softening of the particle with increasing temperature. The result is that
particles may agglomerate to such a size that the gas velocity is insufficient to
support them. This type of defluidization can occur very rapidly (Gluckman,
Yerushalmi, and Squires, 1976). The bed is well-fluidized one moment and
within 5 seconds is dead. As the bed defluidizes and the particles become
loosely stuck together, the fluidizing gas blows a hole through the bed in
order to escape and the pressure drop decreases rapidly.
The tendency to agglomerate depends on (a) the stickiness of the particles,
which is a function of temperature, (b) the available surface area - the
smaller the particles the greater the surface area - and (c) particle
momentum, which is a function of particle size and gas velocity_
In general:
.
Agglomeratmg tendency
(a) x (b)
=
(c)
At the present time it is not possible to predict from first principles the
quantitative relationship between the variables, and experiments are essential
to determine the conditions required for stable operation.
Defluidization can be influenced by the design of the gas distributor and it
is essential to ensure that there are no dead areas at the plate. This might be
taken to imply that a porous plate is best, and it is true that all the solids will
be aerated; however, the small bubbles produced do not have sufficient
energy to provide the vigorous movement required to remix large particles
which may have started to segregate there.
On the other hand, if drilled plates having large holes are used, the large
distance between them (for a given pitch/diameter ratio) allows solids to settle
out. Baeyens (1973) made a study of particle movement caused by bubbles
and suggested that for particle movement over the entire plate:
p <
deq,o
(5.22)
where A is a function of the particle mobility and deq,o is the initial bubble
size produced at the distributor. Geldart (1977) used this approach to derive
Eq. (5.23), which gives the minimum gas velocity required to avoid dead
areas between holes:
(5.20)
(gpf5
K A2.5
where K = 1.73 for holes on square pitch and 2.17 for triangular pitch. For
conservative design, A :=:: 1 for group B solids and 1.5 for group A. Wen,
Krishnan, and Kalyanraman, (1980) used thermistors to detect particle
movement at distributor plates and propose that
30
tf.!.205
P
where the units are centimetres per second and centimetres, respectively,
with dp in micrometres. Dead zones are easier to eliminate using tuyeres with
multiple horizontal holes or conical top bubble caps (sometimes called
'Chinese hats').
Example 5.1
A fluid bed catalytic reactor of 3.5 m diameter is used for a fast, exothermic
reaction releasing 125 kcal/mol of product. Assuming a production of 2,000
kmol/h of product, and 90 per cent. conversion immediately above the
distributor:
(a) What solid flux is required to carry the heat produced to the heat
exchanger surfaces located within the bulk of the bed (average
temperature difference between the bed and surface is 100C)?
(b) What gas flowrate will produce such a flux?
Properties of catalyst:dp : 80 JLm
Cps: 0.2 kcal/kgOC
Urnf: 0.3 cmls
3
Pg : 1 kg/m
Pp
Emf:
JL
1,500 kg/m3
0.5
4 X 10-5 kg/ms
Solution
Example 5.2
3,500 kg/h. The CaC03 concentration in the offtake must be less than 5 per
cent.
(a) What velocity is required to avoid segregation of the limestone feed
within the bed which will be 95 per cent. lime (pp = 1,600 kg/m3)?
(b) Calculate the turnover time of the limestone at the selected velocity.
mixing (M1 = 0.9) the gas velocity should be 4.2 mls. Operation at 1.6 m/s
would give pronounced segregation (M1 = 0.1).
(b) For the limestone, Ar = 37,082. From Figs 5.6 and 5.7 and Eq. (5.13),
operation at U = 4.2 mls gives a turnover time:
-------------
(0.1
+ 0.38 x 0.1)
0.8
x 0.15 x (4.2 - 0.8)
l1.4s
Solution
(a) Assume that the lime produced and the limestone feed have the same
particle size: dcao = 2 mm, PCaO = 1,600 kg/m3. If the offtake contains a
maximum of 5 per cent. of CaC03, the fraction of limestone in the wellmixed bed is less than 0.05 (= x).
For combustion gases at 850C : Pg = 0.28 kg/m3, J.L = 4 X 10-5
kg/ms. Umf can be calculated from the Wen-Yu equation (which slightly
over-estimates at temperature), Eq. (2.27). Therefore:
Calculate UTQ from Eq. (5.17) and use Eqs (5.19) and (5.18) to determine
the mixing index MI for various gas velocities. These are shown on Fig.
5.13. Because conversion takes place continuously, thus gradually
reducing the density of the limestone, there will be relatively little pure
limestone in the bed. However, for conservative design, assume the
residual CaC03 is present as limestone particles. From Fig. 5.13, for good
(a) The maximum polymer size can be calculated fromEq. (5.23) taking into
account:
(i) maximum superficial velocity available from the blower (120e) = 1
mls;
~.9
08
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
------
2
U(m/s)
dp,max =
0.1
Example 5.3
SOLIDS
UTO
42,512:
Umf)opt ~
vp
0.58 mls
0.75 mls
At U = 1 mls and Umf = 0.5 mis, both equations indicate that mixing
conditions are adequate.
XB,XT
Xf,
A
C
Cs
deqs
deqo
dor
dp
dH, dL
df
D
f
g
H
J
My
p
Qb
t
tT
tR
UA
Ub
U
Ucf
UmfB, UmfS
Umfi
particle diameter
of, respectively, denser and less dense
in binary mixture
diameter of segregating fines
y
(3w,(3D
m
m
m
m
m
E],
fJH,fJL
1,
Pp
takeover velocity
average downwards particle velocity
volume
average mass fraction of the denser particles in a
binary mixture
mass fraction of material of interest in,
respectively, the bottom and top halves of the bed
mass fraction of fines, respectively, as bed
average or in the top halves of the bed
mls
mls
m3
kglm3
kglm3
m
m
bed diameter
fraction of solids spending less than time t in the
bed
gravitational constant
9.8 m/s2
m
kglm2s
bed height
mixing flux
mixing index
pitch of holes in distributor
visible bubble flowrate
m2
Xf,Top
121
MIXING
time
time required to turn over the bed once
average particle residence time
rise velocity of bubbles relative to the wall
rise velocity of a single isolated bubble
superficial gas velocity
velocity at which all particles are fully supported
(Eq. 2.31)
bigger and smaller minimum fluidization velocities
of two sets of particles
interstitial gas velocity at minimum fluidization
s
s
s
mls
mls
mls
mls
mls
mls
The terms carryover, entrainment, and elutriation are often used interchangeably to describe the ejection of particles from the surface of a bubbling
fluidized bed and their removal from the unit in the gas stream. Elutriation
123
also describes the technique used to determine the size of subsieve particles or
to prepare narrow cuts from a material having a wide size distribution. This
involves passing air or water at a known velocity upwards through a powder
sample anti! no more is carried out. The material collected is weighed and its
size calculated using Stokes' law.
The terminology and processes occurring in entrainment are best illustrated
through a series of experiments. Imagine a tall vertical column into which
solid particles can be introduced (Fig. 6.1). First drop in a single particle.
Providing it remains more than about 10 particle diameters away from the
wall, its velocity will increase rapidly until it reaches a steady falling rate
which is called its terminal velocity. Ways of calculating this are given later.
If now a few grams of powder are dropped into the tube with no gas flow
the solids may fall as one or more pseudo-particles having effective sizes
larger than those of individual particles, but lower densities. Particles tend to
be shielded by those beneath them and therefore draw nearer to each other.
Very small particles having intrinsically cohesive properties, or particles
which are sticky or damp, also tend to cluster together, and have a higher
terminal velocity than would be expected from their individual sizes.
Small particles
large particles
move upwards
move downwards
Partjcle in this
position mow:s
upwards
Static
gas
Ymax
2Yt
Yavg
Yt
Velocity prOfile
(turbulent flow)
Now pass air up the tube at a superfiCIal velOCItyequal to the partIcle s "
terminal velocity and drop the particle in again. The way it behaves now
depends on several factors. If the gas flow is laminar with respect to the
column there will be the well-known parabolic velocity distribution across the
tube, the maximum velocity at the centre being twice the mean superficial
velocity, and zero gas velocity at the wall. Depending on its radial position the
particle may move upwards or downwards (Fig. 6.1b). If the gas flow is
turbulent not only does the velocity vary across the tube but there are also
random velocity fluctuations with respect to time, and the particle motion is
more unpredictable. Thus, allowing a particle to fall through a stati<::gas and
moving the gas upwards past the particle at the same relative velocity are by
no means identical.
Now pass gas up the tube at .a velocity considerably higher than the
terminal velocity of the mean particle size, and feed in a continuous stream of
particles (Fig. 6.2). They will be picked up '(entrained) by the gas and
transported upwards in dilute phase pneumatic transport. If the size
distribution is so wide that some particles have terminal velocities higher than
the gas velocity then a fractionation (elutriation) of solids occurs with the finer
particles carried upwards and the coarser falling to the bottom of the tube. If
the gas velocity is much higher than the terminal velocity of even the largest
particle and the solids feed rate is gradually increased, the concentration of
solids in the gas increases, together with the pressure drop along the tube,
until a solids/gas loading is reached at which the solids start to fill up the lower
section of.the tube and dilute pha~e flow is no longer possible in the upper
section. The gas/solid suspension then collapses into dense phase or slugging
flow depending on the powder and the tube diameter. The loading at which
300
200
this occurs is known as the saturation carrying capacity of the gas and the
critical .gas velocity is the choking velocity.
Now reduce the gas velocity, allow a fluidized bed to form and cut off the
solids feed. Bubbles bursting at the surface of the bed will project particles
into the freeboard, i.e. the space between the bed surface and the gas offtake
(Fig. 6.3). Depending on their terminal velocities and the gas velocity, solids
100
80
60
40
20
~
"E
:t:
Dilute
phase
transport
e 10
8
6
.- ...
.. . .',
"
..
".",
Disengagement
zone
-TDH (F)
f +
..----
IHold-UP or
density
01
Splash zone
TDH (e)
Bed
are carried up the tube to various heights. The larger particles fall back and
the smallest are carried out of the offtake tube; consequent~, the solids
loading (expressed as kilogram solids per second divided by c~
of gas per second of kilograms of solids per second divided by kilograms of
gas per second; i.e. as kg/m3 or kg/kg) will decline with height. The region
within which the solids loading falls is called the transport disengagement
height )TDH). Some confusion is caused by the application of the term TDH
to two related but different circumstances:
(a) Particles having a terminal velocity larger than the gas ~elocity are flung
upwards and then fall back. These particles are coarses and above the
height they reach are found only fines - particles with terminal velocities
smaller than the gas velocity.
(b) The concentration (or hold-up) of fines decreases with height and, it is
said, eventually reaches a constant value above a certain height.
0-2
0-4
1246810
U-Umb (ftls)
The height which the coarses reach is sometimes called the splash height but
we shall call it TDH(C). The height above which the fines hold-up changes
little or not at all will be called TDH(F). Published correlations for the TDH
are given in Table 6.1.
It is clear that the definition of a particle as coarse or fine will depend upon
its terminal velocity and the superficial gas velocity, so we shall consider next
how best to calculate terminal velocities.
6.3
PARTICLE
TERMINAL
VELOCITY
The terminal (or free-fall) velocity of a particle, VI' figures in most of the
correlations for carryover and is also of considerable importance in
sedimentation, gas and liquid cyclone design, and many other areas of
chemical engineering. It has therefore been a subject of study by numerous
workers, and as there are several excellent comprehensive texts available
(e.g. Clift, Grace, and Weber, 1978; Allen, 1981), the treatment here will be
kept fairly brief.
6.3.1
Spherical Particles
TDH (C)
Soroko et ai. (1969):
TDH (C) = 1,200 Hs Re~55Ar-l.I
for 15 < Rep < 300; 19.5 < Ar < 6.5 X 105; Hs < 0.5 m ; dp = 0.7 - 2.5 mm
where Rep = PgUdpl IL ; Hs = settled bed height
. TDH (F)
Gravitational
accelerating
(6.2)
As in flow through pipes and packed beds, the 'friction factor' Co turns out to
be a function of the Reynolds number which in this case is defined as:
Pf v dv
Re=--
(6.3)
JL
For a sphere Ap
(Eo-. K~';)
/.-.rJ
TDH(F)j = -:-loge
0 01K~
a,
E
p3.5 gO.s
where Ado = 3.07 x 10-9 g 2.5 (U -
force
(6.1)
d2
COT
7T
Pf v2
(6.4)
,00
IJ.
eq.s
umff5
and measured values 3.5 < tli > 6.5 m-1: use average
tli,
= 4 m-1
tnIis equation is based on beds smaller than O.6m diameter and it is unwise to use it for large
beds.
7T
"6 (pp
- Pf)g - F
7Tdv Pp
dv
di
When a particle reaches its free-fall or terminal velocity the accelerating force
is zero, v = Vt, and Eq. (6.5) becomes:
7T
= "6 d~ (pp
4
Co=-
Gravitational
force
- Pf)g
(pp - Pf)dv
2
PfVt
g
(6.7)
Table 6.2
Standard
Re
Susbtituting
Vt,ST
from equations in
CoRe2
Co
2,400
1,204
484
244
124
51.5
27.1
14.76
7.03
4.26
2.71
1.57
1.09
0.77
0.555
0.471
0.421
0.387
0.405
0.442
0.474
0.5
0.497
0.376
0.11
0.01
0.02
0.05
0.1
0.2
0.5
1
2
5
10
20
50
100
200
500
1,000
2,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
50,000
100,000
200,000
500,000
106
2.4
4.8
1.21
2.44
4.96
12.87
27.1
59
1.76
4.26
1.08
'3.93
1.09
3.08
1.39
4.71
1.68
9.67
4.05
1.77
1.18
5
1.99
9.4
CoiRe
1
x 10x 10-1
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
102
102
103
103
104
104
105
105
106
106
107
108
109
109
1010
1010
2.4
6.02
9.68
2.44
6.2
1.03
27.1
7.38
1.41
4.26
1.35
3.14
1.09
3.85
1.11
4.71
2.1
7.74
4.05
2.21
9.48
5
2.48
7.52
x10S
X
x
x
x
x
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
104
103
loJ
lOZ
102
10-1
10-1
10-2
10-2
10-3
10-3
10-4
10-4
10-5
10-5
10-5
10-6
10-6
10-6
10-7
gives:
v t,ST
Spherical/rounded
sand particles (pp = 2,600 kg/m3) smaller than 33
JA-mfalling in air are in the Stokes region; if the expression is used for
larger and/or denser particles then the terminal velocity will be
overestimated. Combining Eqs (6.4) and (6.8) gives:
CD=-
10
Laminllr flow
(Stokesl -~gion
regIOn
I
Tronsition
Turbulent
(Newtonl
,.
region
0,
Ie!
10'
10
Re
10'
10'
10
10'
P"t ~/"
Figure 6.6 Standard drag curve for spheres versus particle Reynolds number.
(b) Turbulent flow (Ret > 1,000). Spherical sand particles larger than 1,500
JA-min air are in the turbulent regime (sometimes called the Newton
region) and CD = 0.43; substitution in Eq. (6.7) and rearrangement leads
to:
Vt,N
=JI:
(pp ~~~dv
(6.11)
Note that the fluid viscosity does not appear in the equation at all and
that Vt is much less dependent on particle size than it is in the laminar
regime (Eq. 6.9). On the other hand, the time and distance taken to
attain Vt.N become considerable
(Table 6.3). The procedure for
calculating the acceleration time will be found in Heywood (1962).
Table 6.3 Time and distance for spheres (pp = 2,600 kglm3) to reach 99
per cent, of their terminal velocities falling in air at ambient conditions
d.
Vt
m/s
24
Time taken
to reach 0.99
Vt
Ret
which is analogous to the expression for the friction factor for laminar
flow in pipes (j = 16/Re), Particles with terminal Reynolds number> 0.2
reach their terminal velocity very rapidly (see Table 6.3).
10'
30
}Lm
0.07
3 mm 14
3cm 44
0.033
3.5
11.9
1.85 x 10-3
35
453
Particle diameters
61
11,670
15,100
(c) Transitional flow (0.2 < ReI < 1,000). In many applications of fluidized
beds the particles of interest have terminal velocities within the transition
regime and a rapid method of calculation is necessary. It can be seen
from Eq. (6.7) and Fig. 6.5 that VIis a function of Co which is itself a
function of ReI> and ReI contains VI' There are several empirical and
semitheoretical expressions relating CD and Re in the transition region,
the best known being that of Schillar and Nauman (1933). it depends on
successive approximations and is therefore tedious. Moreover, it is not at
all suitable for calculating the size of a particle which has a given
terminal velocity. A more convenient procedure is based on Eq. (6.7).
Multiplying both sides by p d~/ p,2 gives:
vt
- Pt)g
d;
=~
'0
,I
,{
1\-\
\
C'
\<2-
\
\
II
\~
CD
Pp - Pf
p,g
f'\
\
\
'\
'\
\\
(6.13)
Non-Spherical Particles
\
\
ReI
3
PI
vi
Co/Ret is calculated and the plot of Co/Ret versus Ret used to find Ret
and ReI hence dv
Equations (6.12) and (6.13) and the associated graphs, Fig. 6.7, are
valid over the whole range of Reynolds numbers.
6.3.2
"-
"-
1,.0-0----'----'16
,pOO
\
~
\
18p,
t{J
KST
tPv
=JI ~
3
(pp - Pf) g dv
KN Pf
Note that Eq. (6.17) implies Co = 0.43 for spherical particles (see Table 6.2).
In the transition regime (0.2 > Ret > 1,000) the method proposed by Becker
(1959) may be used, but it is complicated and has the disadvantage of being
based on large artificial particles. A simple interpolation to obtain a
correction factor, KTR, is sufficiently accurate for most purposes. The
terminal Reynolds number Ret is calculated for a sphere having the same
value of dv as the particle, using CD Re~ and Fig. 6.7, and Vt (sphere) is found.
As estimate is made of '" from Tables 2.1 and 2.2 and KST and KN calculated
using Eqs (6.15) and (6.17). Then:
K=-jK" J( ~:)l(:::=~~
)J(~:)
(618)
The terminal velocity for the non-spherical particle can then be found from:
Vt
6.3.3
KTR
Vt
(sphere)
(6.19)
lit
It can be seen from Eqs (6.9) and (6.11) that increasing the temperature will
cause a reduction in the terminal velocity for particles in the Stokes region
(small particles) and an increase for those falling in the Newton region (large
particles); increasing the pressure has little effect in the Stokes region but
reduces Vt for large particles.
6.4
MECHANISMS
surface (Fig. 6.4). George and Grace (1978) did experiments which enabled
them to calculate particle ejection velocities; 275 p.m ballotini were found to
be ejected at velocities two to three times the bubble velocity. Leva and Wen
(1971) considered that stratification of fines within a bed was an essential
requirement for entrainment; Geldart et aL. (1981) showed that this ~ay be of
importance in beds of coarse solids containing small amounts of fI~es, but
beds of fine particles which are extremely well mixed also have considerable
entrainment rates. George and Grace (1978) obtained data which they
interpreted as demonstrating that it is the bubble wake which is responsible
for ejecting particles into the freeboard, but observations of the surface of
two-dimensional beds indicate that in general it is the nose of bubble which
ejects the particles; however, ejection from the wake can occur when a
bubble bursts through the base of another which is itself about to break at the
surface.
The picture is complicated even more by three other recent findings;
Morooka, Kawazuishi, and Kato (1980) and Horio et aL. (1980 report that the
solids concentration in the freeboard is non-uniform, with a downwardmoving denser stream of solids at the wall and a dilute upward-moving region
in a central core; Yerushalmi et aI. (1978) deduced that particles form
clusters, or agglomerates, making it possible for fines to remain in the system
even at very high velocities (see Chapter 7); and Geldart et aL. (1979) and
Geldart and Pope (1983) showed that fine particles interact with coarse in the
freeboard, increasing the height to which coarses are lifted and causing the
carryover of particles much larger than would be expected as judged by their
terminal velocities.
It is therefore not surprising that entrainment and carryover cannot be
calculated from first principles, nor that empirical correlations give predictions which differ by factors of over 100.
== Kih {bed}
area
dt
(XBi
MB)
fraction of bed }
{ consisti?g of size
dpj at time t
Kih
AXBi
Eih
where Eih is the net carryover flux for a component of size dpi when the gas
offtake is at a height h above the bed surface.
For continuous operation, XBi, the concentration of size dpi in the bed, and
MB, the mass of solids in the bed, are constant, and:
K:
Ri =
h A XBi = Eih A
RT =!. Ri = !. K;h A XBi
Eh =!. Eih = !. K;h
or
XBi
Ri
in the light of more recent work, we may now picture four (Fig.
(6.22)
(6.23)
Phase 2. Agglomerates
(6.23a)
Phase 3. Agglomerates
falling downwards.
freeboard;
6.8):
Eih
= VA =U
= !. Pi
The concentration of size dpi in the exit gas stream may be calculated from
Eqs (6.22) and (6.23):
For batch operation, XBi changes with time and Eq. (6.21) must be integrated.
Providing MB does not change by more than about 15 per cent., mi.h the mass
of size fraction dpi carried over in time t increases asymptotically as:
mi.!
= XBio
MB /1
- exp
t I
K;h ~:
(6.27)
where XBio is the initial concentration of size fraction dpi i~ the bed.
Similarly, the concentration
of size fraetio~ dpi in the bed declines
exponentially according to:
XBi
= XBio
exp
At )
( -Kih MB
(6.28) ,
6.6
ON
rib
The rate of carryover cannot be predicted unless K;h is known, and as yet K;h
cannot be calculated from first principles, though several hydrodynamic
models have been proposed.
An approach originally proposed by Lewis, Gilliland, and Lang (1962) and
developed by Kunii and Levenspiel (1969) postulated three phases in the
There is mass transfer between these phases at rates which will depend on gas
velocity, bubble action, particle size and size distribution, and bed diameter.
Although algebraic equations can be written for this model, as yet the
approach has not yielded any useful or realistic predictions.
For the present, the simplified approach of Large, Martini, and Bergougnou (1976) seems more promising. They picture the overall carryover flux
Eih, for a given component of size dpi as consisting of two partial fluxes:
(a) A continuous flux flowing upwards from bed to outlet (this corresponds
to phase 1), E
(b) A flux of agglomerates ejected by bursting bubbles, which decreases
exponentially as a function of freeboard height (this corresponds to the
net algebraic sum of phases 2, 3 and 4).
j",.
Expressed algebraically:
Eih
E j",
+ E io
-a;h
The total solids carryover flux when the gas offtake is at any height h above
the bed surface:
Eh
E",
+ Eo exp (-ah)
Wen and Chen (1982) develop this idea further and propose:
Eh
E",
(-ah)
VI
Intuition suggests that particles with terminal velocities larger than the
superficial gas velocity should not appear in the exit gas, or that if they do, the
freeboard must be less than the TDH. However, coarses have been found in
the cyclones of a commercial zinc roaster having a 9 m high freeboard
(Avedesian, 1974) and of a fluid bed combustor with a 3.5 m freeboard
(Merrick and Highley, 1972). Geldart and Pope (1983) investigated this
phenomenon in a 0.3 m diameter bed 5 m tall and found that the size and
quantity of coarses carried over depends strongly on the carryover rate of the
fines and can be considerable at fluxes above 2 kg/m2s. The cause is believed
to be collisions and momentum interchange between the fines and coarses; in
effect, the TDH of the coarses, TDH(C), is a function of the f!nes carryover
flux.
On a component basis:
Eih
or K;h
= E + (Eio
= K;oo + (Eo
j",
(6.33)
(6.33a)
If the column is sufficiently tall that the second term on the right-hand side
of Eq. (6.33) can be considered negligible, a measurement at the exit can give
Eioo, and two other measurements lower down can then be used to find
exponent ai and Eio' The ultimate objective is to be able to predict all these
factors from first principles' or, alternatively, from correlations. Unfortunately, many of the published correlations are based on data taken from
columns which were too short, too small in diameter, or both; consequently,
they correlate K;h, not the intrinsic or ejection component rate constants, and
this makes their application to dissimilar systems unreliable. However, we
can make some general comments on the effect which various parameters
have on the carryover of particles.
Particles whose terminal velocities are less than the superficial gas velocity the fines
Particles with vlU < 1 are the most likely to be carried over, and most
researchers agree that as the size of the fines decreases, the component
6.6.3
In powders which have a small mean size, say less than 300 Mm,and a normal
size distribution of particles of equal density, there is little evidence of
segregation within the bed provided it is vigorously bubbling, and the solids
presented to the freeboard by the bubbles have a composition similar to that
of the bed as a whole. If, however, the mean size of the particles is large, say
> 800 Mm, and there is either a very wide or a bimodal distribution, then
there will be vertical segregation, with more fines at the top of the bed even at
high velocities (Geldart et al., 1981). Similarly, if the bed is composed of
solids having different densities, in general the top of the bed will be richer in
the lighter solids. Under these circumstances carryover is likely to be higher
than predicted by correlations based on a well-mixed bed of fine solids.
6.6.4
2'
All correlations include the superficial gas velocity, usually in association with
Vt, as U - Vt, (U - Vt)/Vt, (U - vt)/U, or v/U. Certainly the component solids
carryover flux is very sensitive to gas velocity, but although the dependency is
of the form K~h a if no single value can be assigned to the exponent which
may range from 2 to 4 depending on the systems.
if
o
c:
's::J
Expected
~ 40
Rj
I
U'1
<;f
C(.
line based on
XBj
/.
'0
..
6.6.5 OperatingPressure
As pointed out in Section 6.3.3, terminal velocities are unaffected by gas
density in the Stokes region, slightly in the transition region, and in the
turbulent regime according to V(l/Pg). This means that as the gas pressure is
increased at constant gas velocity, the size of the particles carried over will
increase slightly. More importantly, however, the rate of carryover has been
found experimentally to be directly proportional to absolute pressure (May
and Russel, quoted in Zenz and Weil, 1958).
~.
~ 20
t
o
.~~
Experimental
values
0.2
0.4
OB
0.6
Average concentration
in bed.
x Bi
Figure 6.9 Carryover rate of fines versus average concentration of fines in the bed (from
qeldart et al., 1979).
~
~
.~
gti 60
E
<1' 50
25mm
U'1
coarse in
bed "'--.;
('\I
6 40
(Xl
....~20
/
'0 10
/ 0
a::
l/
xl
..
Gas Velocity
0.01
0.02
Average concentration
0.03
in bed
XBi
There are relatively few reports on the effect which baffles, in and above the
fluidized bed, have on entrainment. Geldart (1981)and Colakyan et ai. (1979)
found that the presence of tubes beneath and just above the bed surface had
no discernible effects in beds of coarse solids containing fines. Martini,
Bergougnou, and Baker (1976), working with fine sand, found that louvers
situated just above the bed surface helped to reduce carryover of the larger
fractions. If situated higher in the freeboard they could actually increase
carryover. Similarly, filling the freeboard with tubes would increase the
V:)2
6.7
CORRELATIONS
FOR K;",
In view of the number of variables and the complexity and interrelation of the
mechanisms occurring in and above the bed, it is hardly surprising that the
many published correlations predict widely different rates of carryover when
applied to systems other than those on which they are based. Also there is no
guarantee that the offtake was above TDH(F). A ful1 discussion of the
correlations is beyond the scope of this section, but Fig. 6.11 shows how much
correlations differ and a list is given in Table 6.4. Another problem which
complicates the prediction of carryover rates is that fines may be generated in
the bed due to chemical, hydrodynamic, or mechanical breakdown of the
solids; this makes it difficult to predict the concentration of any particular size
fraction in the bed, and experimental work may be required if carryover is a
crucial parameter. The results should then be compared with published
correlations, and the one which agrees most closely used for subsequent scaleup calculations.
f.-: Merrick
,.. Highley
/ j-CoIokyan
20
10
"'--
"'e
0'
*J
et 01
.' :
et 01
05
02
/:
/ ,,:
f 1.26
4.31
107 ( g
104
lr,
U2
)
)
u2
1.88
when
1.18
when
( g dpi P~
pi Pp
U2
2
g dpi Pp
<3
10-4
>3
10-4
(1960):
( Pp
Re~.725
Pg )
LIS
U~
Vt)U
K~",
~U-~
{(U -
4.6 x 10-2
Vt?
g~
l0.5 Re~.3
r
(Pp
Pg )
0.15
130 exp
{_ 10.4 (~)
Umf
0.5 (
K;",
pgU = 23.7 exp
Colakyan et
(V-
5.4ij
at. (1979):
K~", (kglm2s) = 33 ( 1 - ~
vi}
Geldort
U2
dpi
0.25}
U - Umf
.vIi
lo
and Toiloka
)/J.
0.01 Ret
ond
Zenz and
'Neil
Wen and
'/Hoshi~r
/'
/
et 01
-1/4.7
U(m/s)
.!!:....]
Pg
2.5
15.17
{ Pg(U ~ Vt)dpi }
-1.5
} -2.5
D2 for Pg(U~
vt)dpi
2.38
.::;D
2.38
~LT
e-5 .4 vuu
(a) No feed; cyclone 100 per cent. efficient; total recycle of cyclone product
(b) Continuous feed; cyclone efficiency varies depending
recycle of fines
on dpi; partial
(6.34)
~=A
pgU
e-BvJU
31.4;
Linear interpolation of A and B can be made for solids between 1 and 2.5
mm.
High accuracy should not be expected from any of these approaches and in
the present state of knowledge agreement between experiment and prediction
is unlikely to be better than 100 per cent.
6.8
CALCULATION
OF CARRYOVER RATE
Assuming K;h has been predicted from correlations for each size range (e.g.
from Eq. 6.33a using Eo from the last equation in Table 6.1) or determined
experimentally, calculation of the carryover rate requires a knowledge of the
concentration of each size range in the bed. The general case is shown in Fig.
6.12 and many combinations are possible; for example:
XpiRT
+ XqiQ
(6.36)
XpiRT = K;h A
RT
= Ei0
XBi
1K;h A
(6.38)
(6.39)
XBi
XFi
XB"
(6.40)
KihA +F-RT
There is still a long way to go before carryover rates can be predicted with real
confidence. Cold model experiments in columns at least 0.1 m in diameter can
be of assistance but there is no substitute for making measurements on the
plant. Unfortunately,
due to the different perceptions and objectives of
production and development engineers, these are never easy to make and the
data are frequently incomplete or unsatisfactory.
In addition to the influence of the quantifiable variables discussed in Section
6.6, other parameters often assume importance in a bed operating at high
temperature
and/or pressure: e.g. production of fines by mechanical,
thermal, and chemical attack on the particles at the grid, in the bed, and in
the cyclones; particle stickiness caused by deposition and softening of
impurities on the surface; blocking of cyclone diplegs; leakage around the
distributor which gives mal-distribution of gas. These other effects may occur
in many fluid beds but only become apparent when there is a serious increase
in the rate of solids carryover.
6.10
A powder is fed to a fluidized bed 0.5 m in diameter at the rate of 540 kglh.
The column, which is 3 m tall from distributor to gas offtake, contains 200 kg
of solids having a settled bulk density of 1,450 kg/m3 and a particle density of
2,630 kg/m3. The powder is to be fluidized at 1 m/s at 300C by a gas of density
0.61 kg/m3 and viscosity 2.95 x 10-5 N s/m2. The size distribution of the feed
solids is given in Table 6.5. Estimate the solids loading on the cyclone if (a)
none, (b) all of the elutriated solids are returned to the bed.
The residence time of the size fraction dpi in the bed is:
XBiMB
tR=--1
xFiF
Substituting
= PBmf A
PBmfA
tRi
KihA
EXAMPLE ON ELUTRIATION
that
Hmf
Hmf
+ F-
RT
and
K: = K;,
Sieve size
dp, ILffi
-44+60
- 60+85
That is, the residence time is independent
proportion alto the bed depth.
of the concentration
PBmfA
Hmf
and directly
- 85
-100
-120
-150
-200
-350
+ 100
+ 120
+ 150
+
+
200
350
300
215
165
137
115
90
60
(30)
3.3
22.8
16.4
20.3
16.8
13.3
5.2
1.9
XFj
Assumptions
XBi(l)
Step 1.
Preliminary
XPi
XBi(l)
0.01 m/s.
(d) We need to know the height of the freeboard when the bed is in
operation. Using the same approach illustrated in Example 4.4, the
bubble size at the bed surface deqs is calculated to be 0.5 m, which means
that the bed would be near slugging under ambient conditions. The
average expanded bed depth is calculated (Eq.4.7) to be 1.5m, giving a
freeboard height of about 1.5 m.
(e) Critical particle size corresponding to U = 1 m/s is calculated using Eq.
(6.13) and Fig. 6.7 to be 164 J.Lm, so almost 70 per cent of the solids are
potentially elutriable.
Step 2. Estimate TDH. Since most of the particles are elutriable we are
interested in TDH(F). Values calculated using equations in Table 6.1 are
listed below. Correlations of Horio and Wen and Chen require a knowledge
of bubble size at the bed surface deq,s which in this case has been calculated as
0.5 m.
TDH(F),
Fournol et ai.
Horio et ai.
102
Amitin
Zenz and Weil
6.3
125 J.Lm.
K~coA + F
= 0.0188 and
calculations:
0.15 x 0.0188
x 0.196 + 0.15
= 7.34
0.00177
This is done for each size fraction (see Table 6.7, column 3) and so the first
estimate of RT is found. This is then inserted into Eq. (6.4;) and the second
estimate of XT is found. Three trials are sufficient; it can be seen
from the equilibrium values of XBi that compared with the feed, the bed is
deficient in the finest sizes and richer in the coarser.
30
60
90
115
137
0.044
0.19
0.35
0.55
0.74
3.28
1.26
0.59
0.37
0.27
0.19
0.13
K:=, kg/m2s
(Geldart et al., 1979)
11.4
5.18
2.18
0.74
0.27
0.065
0.018
7.34
3.22
1.38
0.56
0.27
0.13
0.07
dpi, ~m
VI>
m/s
1(=,
kg/m2s
165
195
1 1.24
3.2
4.3
Clearly the available freeboard height of 1.5 m is below TDH(F) and (a)
particles larger than the critical size (164 J.Lm) will be carried over, (b) the
, carryover rate will be larger than the value based on K~co.
Step 3. Since the powder will be well mixed and dp is less than 300 J.Lm,
, calculate K~oofor each size fraction from Zenz-Weil (1958) and Geldart et at.
(1979) revised, and take the average (Table 6.6).
Step 4. Calculate equilibrium concentration of each size fraction in the bed
using Eq. (6.40). In order to simplify the calculation it, will be assumed that
K~h = K;co. This will enable us to calculate values ofxB; Eioo can then be found
(Eq. 6.30). In the first trial assume RT = 0:
tip,
~m
30
60
90
115
137
165
XFi
XBi
E;",A,
kg/s x 10-3
XBi
Ei",A,
kg/s X 10-3
XBi
Ei",A,
kg/s X 10-3
0.0188
0.0524
0.1328
0.1684
0.203
0.164
0.00177
0.01
0.0473
0.0972
0.15
0.14
2.55
6.31
12.8
10.6
7.94
3.57
0.00183
0.01
0.053
0.117
0.191
0.187
2.63
6.31
14.3
12.8
10.0
4.76
0.00183
0.01
0.054
0.121
0.2
0.197
2.63
6.31
14.6
13.3
10.6
5.0
RT= E,.A
= 43.8 x
10-3
RT
= 50.8
10-3
RT
= 52.4
10-3
Step 5.
(a) From Table 6.7, E", :== 52.4
1 x 0.196
0.354 kg/m2s
K:~
K~h
0.35 kg/m3
mi,t
MB
Step 6. If all the solids from the cyclone are returned, the bed will have the
same composition as the feed and the loading on the cyclone is calculated to
be 0.746 kg/m3
!:i.p
Q
Ri
RT
}
6.12
g
h
Hs
Therefore total carried over = 0.354 x 0.196 = 0.0694 kg/so Of 0.15 kg/s
fed in, 0.0694 kg/s (46 per cent.) is elutriated and the solids loading to the
external cyclone is:
---
E",
0.0694
entrainment
(= !. Ejo)
(b) From the last equation in Table 6.1, the total ejection flux at the bed
surface, Eo, is calculated to be 35.4 kg/m2s, using deqs = 0.5 m (step Id.)
Eo
2
NOMENCLATURE
rn2
m-1
Ret
Rep
t, tRi
TDH (C)
TDH(F)
TDH(F)j
m
m or porn
m
m
m
kg/m2s
U
Vt
XBi
XBio
XBit
XEi
XFi
kg/m2s
fraction dpi when offtake
E",)
kg/m2s
Xpi
kg/m2
kg/s
kg/s
kg/s
m
m
m/s
GAS FLUIDIZATION
TECHNOLOGY
kg/ms
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg solids/m3
kg/m3
Pettyjohn, E.A., and Christiansen, E.B., (1948). Chern. Eng. Progr., 44, 157.
Ryan, W.J. (1970). Cherneca 70, Chemical Eng. Conf. Australia, Butterworh and Co.
(Australia) Ltd.
Schillar, L., and Nauman, A. (1933). Z. Ver. Dtsch. Ing. 77, 318.
Tanaka, I., and Shinohara, H. (1978). Int. Chern. Eng., 18, No.2, 276.
Tweddle, T.A., Capes, C.E., and Osberg, G.L. (1970). Ind. Eng. Chern. Proc. Des.
Dev., 9,85.
Wen. C.Y., and Chen, L.H., (1982). A.I.Ch.E.J., 28, 117.
Wen, C.Y., and Hashinger, R.F., (1960). A.l.Ch.E.J., 60,220.
Wohlfarth, W. (1979). Private communication.
Wong, A.C.Y. (1983). Ph. D. Dissertation, University of Bradford.
Yagi, S. and Aochi, T., (1955). Paper presented at Soc. Chern. Engrs. (Japan) Spring
Meeting.
Yerushalmi, J., Cankurt, N., Geldart, D., and Liss, B. (1978). A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser.,
74 (176), I.
Zenz, F.A. (1983). Chern. Engng., Nov. 28.
Zenz, F.A., and Weil, N.A. (1958). A.l.Ch.E.J., 4, 472.
7.1
INTRODUCTION
Consider a bubbling fluidized bed (Fig. 7.1a). As the velocity of the gas is
slowly raised, the heterogeneous, two-phase character of the bed first peaks,
then gradually gives way to a condition of increasing uniformity culminating
in the turbulent state (Fig. 7.1b) in which large discrete bubbles or voids are
on the whole absent. In the turbulent fluidized bed, there is an upper bed
surface, though it is considerably more diffuse than in a bubbling fluidized
bed because of the greater freeboard activity attending operation at higher
gas velocities,
The turbulent regime extends to the so-called transport velocity. As the
Bubbling
fluidized
bed
Fluidizing
(0 )
gas
Turbulent
fluidized
bed
Fast
fluidized
bed
TRANSITION
FROM BUBBliNG
TO TURBULENT FLUIDIZATION
Lanneau (1960) appears to have been the first to recognise the transition.fro~
bubbling to turbulent fluidization and the potential advantages of operatmg m
the turbulent regime. He studied the fluidization characteristics of a fine
powder (see Table 7.1) in a bed 4.6 m deep contained in a column 7.62 cmi.d.
as the velocity of the fluidizing gas (air) was raised to about 1.7 mls. At a
given gas velocity, he recorded tra:es of in~tantaneous point de~sities from
two small-point capacitance probes Inserted m the bed spaced vertically apart
at any desired elevation. Lanneau conducted experiments at two pressure
levels, 1.7 and 5 atmospheres absolute. At both pressures, he noted that at
low gas velocities, up to about 0.3 mis, the tracings from the probes clearly
reflected the pronounced two-phase structure of the slug flow regime. As the
velocity was raised above 0.3 mis, the heterogeneous character of the bed
;;- 250
tlJ
6200
~
~
8.
150
100
50
"C
~
0.3
0.6
0.9
1.2
1.8
Figure 7.2 Lanneau's heterogeneity - the mean deviation of the instantaneous point density from the timeaverage bed density (from Lanneau, 1960).
158
Table 7.1
159
Transition
from
bubbling
to turbulent
Size
range,
Solids
JAoffi
Catalyst
Catalyst
Catalyst
Ballotini
Ballotini
Ballotini
Catalyst
Catalyst
Catalyst
Catalyst
Catalyst
Catalyst
B
B
B
C
C
C
Summary
fluidization;
Mean
diameter",
p.m
Particle
densit~,
em
Particle
sphericity
30-150
30-150
70
70
2.0
2.0
NA
NA
15-43
15-43
15-43
15-43
15-90
15-90
15-90
40-90
40-90
40-90
22c
22c
22c
22c
26c
26c
26c
55c
55c
55c
1.1
2.2
2.2
2.2
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.1
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
0.4
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
of test conditions
Experimental
methodsb
and results
Pressure
level
(atm)
v"
cmls
Lanneau (1960)
7.5 cm i.d.
C
7.5 cm i.d.
C
1.7
5.0
27
21
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
2.3
10.0
10.0
10.0
Massimilla (1973)
15.6 em i.d.
C
1.0
9.5
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
2.3
7.8
10.6
10.6
58.2
58.2
116.0
116.0
95.0
Varies
with
pressure
Varies
with
pressure
Apparatus
1.6
3.2
3.2
3.2
2.3
2.3
Uc,
cmls
30
30
Uk
cmIs
Uk/V,
Uncertain
Uncertain
11.0
35.0
40.0
35.0
18.0
17.0
32.0d
44.0
50.0
~ 50.if
5.0
~ 5.0
30-40.0
3.1-4.2
53
61
91
61
122
137
274
150-215
150-215
107.0
61.0
137.0
107.0
274.0
255.0
550.0
Uncertain!
Uncertain
47.1
7.8
12.9
10.9
4.7
4.4
4.7
6.8
11.0
12.5
11.0
7.8
7.4
14.0
4.4
a
b
Unless otherwise
indicated,
Catalyst
NA
50
1.0
Dicalite
FCCHFZ-20
HFZ-20
Alumina
Alumina
Sand
Sand
Glass
~16O
0-130
0-130
0-130
40-200
40-200
80-670
80-670
105-210
33
49
49
49
103
103
268
268
157
1.67
1.07
1.45
1.45
2.46
2.46
2.65
2.65
2.42
Glass
550-750
650
2.48
1.0
Glass
2,500-2,700
2,600
2.92
1.0
0.8
0.8
1.0
FCC
FCC
FCC
0-180
0-180
0-180
60
60
60
0.93
0.93
0.93
NA
NA
NA
Catalyst
Alumina
Ludox
NA
NA
NA
60
95
60
0.94
1.55
1.4
NA
NA
NA
dp is used.
1.0
1.0
1.0
10.0
10.0
10
NA
0.5-0.65
NA
0.3-0.35
41
22
22.5
conducted
4.1
2.2
0.25
2.0
2.8
2.2
by Kehoe and Davidson
bed
'
where Vt mm
. is the terminal velocity of particles belonging to the smallest cut.
Since then, the transition from bubbling to turbulent fluidization has been
the subject of a number of investigations (Carotenuto, Crescitelli, and Donsi,
1974; Thiel and Potter, 1977; Crescitelli at ai., 1978; at General Electric,
Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub, 1976, and Staub and Canada 1978; and at
the City College of New York, Yerushalmi, Turner, and ~quires, 1976,
Cankurt and Yerushalmi, 1978, Turner, 1978, and Yerushalmt and Cankurt
1978, 1979). The test conditions, experimental methods, and the results of
these investigations are summarised in Table 7.1.
7.2.1
Transition Velocities
0 0
oSO/DS~D/CALlr - <1200
$Ol/D$~rCC
""-
0-
00
0
"0
'. .........
Hmf (em)
.---110
.---164
4
Dimensionless
+ k')
o.
0"
.,
.Po.OOoCS
-0'
.,
0.25
.~.,
'"
~
~
z
~ 0.2
0.20
0.15
0.15
~
ii
...
5IS! 0.10
0.10
t!
0.05
a
(Q)
0.5
1.0
1.5
200
~~~
1.0
II
2.0
LS
......
1600 _
800
0
SOL./O$" HFZ - 20
1200 ~
700 ~
800>0.14
i!c
0.12
...
~
400
0.10
300
ti
~
g
......
0.04
>
(c)
0.6
0.4
Ei
.. o. 2
0.02
0
~o
0.8
::>
l-
II>
UI
0.06
It:
l!:l
400
. 1.0
0.08
~
j:;
..J
..J
in
l!l
Q
::>
~
g
>800 ~
~
z
500
100
Decreoslng
veloc~y
0.5
(b)
en
Increoslng
veloclly
1I Daa
2.0
300~
6
8
10
Reaction Velocity Constent (11')
'r~
.,
'" 0.25
400 \
It!
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
(d)
GAS VELOCITY
10
U (m/s)
Figure 7.4 Pressure fluctuations relative to the mean pressure drop across a fluid bed of (a)
Dicalite, (b) fluid cracking catalyst (FCC), (c) HFZ-20, and (d) sand. The upper curve gives
the corresponding mean pressure drop across the bed.
fluctuations, observed that the transition occurs between two velocities: Ue,
the velocity at which the pressure fluctuations peak, and Uk, the velocity at
which the fluctuations, having decayed from the peak value, begin to level
off. Uk marks the end of the transition and the onset of the turbulent regime.
Results for four solids are illustrated in Fig. 7.4. The data were obtained in
a 15.2 m diameter column incorporated in the apparatus shown schematically
in Fig. 7.5. Figure 7.4 gives the relative pressure fluctuations - i.e. the
fluctuations of the pressure drop across the bed divided by the mean pressure
drop - as a function of the superficial gas velocity. Corresponding to each
data point, the figures also display the fluidized density reckoned from the
mean pressure drop across the bed and the bed depth.
These relative pressure fluctuations are akin to Lanneau's heterogeneities,
but apart from noting the approach to an almost uniform fluidization in the
15.2 em 1.0.
BED
34.3em 1.0.
SLOW BED
range of 1 to 1.7 mis, Lanneau does not recognize any clean onset of a
different regime.
Like the City College investigators, Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub (1976)
characterize the transition in terms of the relative pressure fluctuations and
similarly mark the onset of the turbulent regime, Uk, as the velocity at which
the fluctuations begin to level off. With the exception of Thiel and Potter the
remaining investigators cited in Table 7.1 report only a single transition
velocity while stressing the progressive character of the transition. Kehoe and
Davidson note that the transition to turbulent fludization was chosen rather
arbitrarily as 'the velocity above which it was impossible to detect slugs' on
traces from capacitance probes. In a similar fashion, Massimilla, Carotenuto
et ai., and Crescitelli et ai., report the velocity at which the traces from
capacitance probes no longer exhibit any strong and clear periodic element as
the onset of the turbulent regime.
The decay of the relative pressure fluctuations from their peak, on the one
hand, and the gradual loss of a strong periodic component in the traces from
capacitance probes, on the other, reflect essentially the same physical
phenomena, the same progressive changes in the structure of the bed. For this
reason, I have listed in Table 7.1 under Uk all the transition velocities
reported by Kehoe and Davidson, Massimilla, Carotenuto et ai., and
Crescitelli et ai. I have similarly listed the results of Thiel and Potter although,
apart from stating on the basis of visual observations that the transition
velocity marked the breakdown of slugs into smaller bubbles, these authors
are vague on precisely how the transition was determined.
It is apparent marking off Uk from either the relative pressure fluctuations
or the traces from capacitance probes entails a large degree of arbitrary
judgement. Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub, plotting the superficial gas
velocity UIE versus U (Fig. 7.6), noted a clear change of slope near the
transition velocity. A different approach was taken by Kehoe and Davidson
and Crescitelli et ai. Both utilized capacitance probes to deduce the bubble or
lean phase velocity in narrow beds of fine powders undergoing transition from
slugging to turbulent fluidization. The results are shown in Figs 7.7 and 7.8. In
both cases, the experimental results are compared to the familiar expression:
UA
U - Umf
+ O.35(gD)112
(7.2)
arising from the two-phase theory. Crescitelli et ai. also compare the results
with:
In both cases, the actual lean phase velocities exceed the rise velocity
predicted by the two-phase theory (a point to which I shall return presently),
and there is a sharp change in slope at Uk' However, there is one essential
difference between the results of Kehoe and Davidson, and those of Cresitelli
~
E
o
<100
:J
50
U - Urntlcm/s)
0.5
1.0
Superficial
1.5
Gas Velocity,
U(m/s)
et at. The former show an increase in the lean phase velocity past Uk; the
latter show a decrease. An inconsistency? Or are the two transition velociti~s
somehow dissimilar?
7.2.2
The last column in Table 7.1 shows the ratios of the transition velocity Uk to
the terminal velocity Vt of a particle of size dp The ratios are strongly
dependent on the particle's size and density. The- ratios approach and even
exceed 10 for the finer solids, and decrease sharply with particle size and
density. For the coarse glass beads tested by Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub,
Uk/vt falls below unity and lies in the range of 0.5 to 0.65 for the 650 fJ-m
glass, and 0.3 to 0.35 for coarser 2,600 fJ-msolid. The significance of these
results is discussed later.
7.2.3 Effect of particle size and size distribution
20
10
20
30
40
U - Urn! (cm/s)
velocity was lowered significantly. This is not surprising since the mean size of
catalyst B is considerably smaller than that of catalyst C. Information on the
effect of size distribution for solids having comparable mean size is lacking.
7.2.4 Effect of bed height
Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub report no apparent effect of bed height over
a range of 25 to 70 cm. Kehoe and Davidson, on the other hand, report that
(for catalyst Band C) a bed 2.55 m in height gave rise to transition velocities
higher than those recorded in beds of the same solids ranging in heights to
only 1.7 m. The shallower beds, they argue, support a greater degree of slug
coalescence and the approach to the 'breakdown' velocity is accordingly
faster.
Lanneau conducted his experiments in a bed 4.6 m deep, and he noted that
the structure of the bed could vary significantly with bed height. When
operating at 5 atm and at a gas velocity of 0.15 mls the pressure traces showed
that the bubbles forming immediately above the distributor were still small.
In the middle of the bed, owing to coalescence, the bubbles had grown large
and the two-phase structure of the bubbling (slugging) regime dominated, but
in the upper section of the bed the bubbles appear to have become smaller
again. The implication that the structure of a fluid bed can vary significantly
with height, especially in tall beds, ought to be taken into account in reactor
modelling.
7.2.5 Effect of pressure
Canada, McLaughlin and Staub report that, at the same gas velocity, the
fluidization grows smoother, as reckoned from the relative pressure fluctuations, as the pressure is raised. For a given solid, the transition velocity Uk
decreases with increasing pressure, but over the range of 1 to 10 atm the
ratio of Uk to the particle's terminal velocity VI remained essentially constant,
0.5 to 0.65 for the 650 Momglass and 0.3 to 0.35 for coarser 2,600 p.m solid.
Lanneau also notes that at a given gas velocity, the fluidization is more
uniform at the higher pressure level. This is reflected in the lower
heterogeneity measured past the peak at 5 as compared to 1.7 atm (Fig. 7.2).
Other workers have also noted the 'smoothing' effect of pressure,
particularly in fluidized beds of group A powders.
drawn between the data from the 15.2em diameter column and that from the
two-dimensional bed. In the latter, the transition generally came into play at
lower gas velocities. The two-dimensional bed is comparable in crosssectional area to the 15.2 cm column, but as it affords growth bubbles larger
that 15.2 cm in that respect it could be regarded as effectively larger.
That bed size may affect the transition in question should not be surprising.
Essentially all the experiments summarized in Table 7.1 were conducted in
equipment of relatively small size which gave rise to slugging behaviour over
the range of gas velocities preceding the transition and overlapping its earlier
stages. Over that range, bed size directly affects the shape, size, and rise
velocity of the slugs, and the fluidized density at a given gas velocity.
Equation (7.2), which is a statement of the two-phase theory for the slugging
regime, is a reminder of that. Since the transition to turbulent fluidization
involves changes in the structure of the bed, it may be expected to show some
dependence on bed size. In beds of sufficient size, where freely bubbling
behaviour prevails, the transition to turbulent fluidization ought to be no
longer influenced by bed size.
The dependence of bed size of the results described here provides a clue to
one of the underlying elements to which the mechanism of the transition must
ultimately be linked - the absolute rise velocity of the bubble (or slug) UA'
All the investigators who have commented upon the transition's mechanism
agree that it entails a breakdown, gradual or otherwise, of the slugs into
smaller bubbles or voids. Clearly, the size the slug attains, its rise velocity,
and its interaction with the emulsion just before the transition must be the
focus of those seeking to understand the forces that drive the transition and
the attendant changes in the bed's structure.
Invoking the two-phase theory, one may gather from Eq. (7.2) that over
the slugging range two different powders in the same bed will give rise to slugs
of comparable size and speed at a given superficial gas velocity. The process
of slug disintegration would accordingly commence earlier for the lighter
and/or smaller powder. This generally accords with the study of Clift, Grace
and Weber, (1974) on the splitting of bubbles.
On the other hand, given two beds of different size holding the same solid,
the transition will commence at a lower gas velocity in the larger because it
supports a larger slug rising at higher velocity. The results of Thiel and Potter
(1977) corroborate this point.
It should be noted that although the results of Kehoe and Davidson do
show a dependence on bed size, the dependence is slight.
1+
-=
Hrnf
U - Urnf
1/2
0.35(gD)
(7.4)
Massimilla (1973) reports data which strongly deviate from Eq. (7.4)
beginning with a superficial gas velocity around 15 cm/s (Fig. 7.9).
1.8
I
I
I
I
1.4
I
0
8
o D.
I
I o 0r:t o
1011.
1.2
1
0
Figure 7.9
1.6
'lee
0
0
0
-0
r/rI'.
Hmf
110Cm
164 em
0.4
Bed expansion
1973).
Massimilla attributes the departure from ideal slug flow behaviour to. slug
velocities exceeding the rise velocity predicted by Eq. (7.1), owing to the
acceleration effect brought about by coalescence of slugs throughout the
column. Above the transition velocity (30 to 40 cm/s), the higher velocity of
the lean phase, he argues, arises from the continuous process of slug
breakdown and the coalescence and rearrangement of the resulting small
bubbles or voids into new slugs. This picture of higher lean phase velocities
accords well with the results of Kehoe and Davidson and Crescitelli et at.
presented earlier (Figs 7.7 and 7.8). An equally plausible explanation is the
expansion of the dense phase which affords higher interstitial flow and
smaller slugs or voids.
7.2.8 Mechanism
All this does not quite add up to a complete picture of the transition to
turbulent fluidization, but several elements of the mechanism do emerge
more clearly. These I attempt to recapitulate briefly below.
The transition to turbulent fluidization involves the gradual breakdown of
large bubbles (or slugs) into smaller bubbles and voids. The process of bubble
These observations are borne out by photographs of the transition in twodimensional beds presented by Kehoe and Davidson (1971).
Consider a fluidized bed of closely sized coarse particles, such as those used
in the experiments of Canada, McLaughlin, and Staub (1976). The turbulent
regime for the 2,600 p,m glass extends for around (0.3 to 0.35)vt up to a
velocity at least equal to Vt. Over this range, since the gas velocity lies below
the terminal velocity of the individual particle, no carryover occurs provided
the freeboard is sufficiently high. In a bed of fine powder, however, the
turbulent regime start at values of Uk/vt much larger than 1, and the ratio
increases as the mean size of the powder decreases (Table 7.1).
The concept that particles combine into loose clusters can be used to
explain the range of the turbulent regime for a fine powder. The mean
effective size and density of these clusters at any gas velocity is such that their
terminal velocities remain greater than the velocity of the gas. This concept
can explain why a bed of fine solid can be maintained at gas velocities that are
10 to 20 times the terminal velocity of its median particles. Entrainment will,
of course, take place as particles are swept from the lean phase near the top of
the bed, and by the erosion of clusters by the surrounding lean phase.
The turbulent regime extends from Uk to the transport velocity UTR. The
approach to the transport velocity is accompanied bya sharp increase in the
rate of carryover. It is difficult, without having made suitable measurements,
to associate the transport velocity with some mean cluster size. By analogy to
the behaviour of beds of closely sized coarse particles, one may surmise that
when the transport velocity is reached, the terminal velocities of a large
proportion of the clusters are smaller than the velocity of the gas. For fine
solids, the transport velocity is typically an order of magnitude greater than
the terminal velocity of the individual median particle. For coarse particles,
the transport velocity lies closer to the terminal velocity of the median
particle.
Though they differ in structure, the turbulent and the bubbling fluid beds
. are similar in several respects. Over the turbulent regime, though particle
carryover rates are relatively high, the fluidized density of the bed remains
quite high and an upper bed level is present, though it is, of course, more
diffuse than in a bubbling fluidized bed. As in the bubbling bed, when solid is
fed to the turbulent bed at a rate matching the saturation carrying capacity,
the concentration of solid above the bed 'decays through the transport
disengaging height and approaches a constant value. If solid is fed to the bed
at a rate above the saturation carrying capacity, the bed level rises until the
new solid rate is matched by solid carried out of the bed. The gas exit now lies
within the transport disengaging height. However, unless the slip velocityi.e. the relative velocity of gas and solid - changes significantly, the fluidized
density of the bed itself remains virtually the same.
Some of the general points made above may be illustrated by experimental
results reported by Yerushalmi and Cankurt (1979)for fluid cracking catalyst
SOllO=FCC
~~30
\
GAS
VELOCITY
U (m/sl.
1.2 \
I'
SOLID RATE
G. (ka Im2_
21.'
0
~13.2
2
4
6
8
HEIGHT ABOVE THE BOTTOM OF 15.2 em BED (m)
SOL/ONCC
TIME
,.'--.
(SECONDS) 400
\
0.5
1.0
1.5
U (m/sl
Figure 7.11 Time required for the pressure drop across a
bed of fluid cracking catalyst (FCC) maintained in a 15.2 cm
column to decay to 2.5 cm of water as a function of the
superficial gas velocity.
bubbling and the turbulent fluid beds where, save for some carryover, the bed
in general experiences no net flow and remains at the bottom of the holding
vessel. These are, to use Lanneau's description, the captive states. Above lie
the transport regimes which encompass a wide range of states from dilute
phase flow to the fast bed condition.
The.transport velocity for the fluid cracking catalyst lies around 1.2 to 1.5
m/s (which is nearly 20 times the terminal velocity of a single particle with a
size equal to the mean diameter of the powder, 49 /Lm). As this velocity is
approached, there is a sharp increase in the rate of particle carryover and in
the absence of solid recycle the bed would empty rapidly. This may be
illustrated by the results, shown in Fig. 7.11, of a simple experiment in which
the flow of recycle solid to the 15.2 cm diameter column was suddenly halted,
and the time it took the bed pressure drop to fall to 2.5 cm of water gauge
(w.g.) was measured at different gas velocities. Because of the continuous
nature of the curve in Fig. 7.11, it could hardly serve to pinpoint the transport
velocity. To do that, other approaches, to be described shortly, proved more
useful.
Beyond the transport velocity, solids traverse the column in fully entrained
flow, and the density or concentration of the resulting suspension depends not
only on the gas velocity but also on the solid rate. If the solid rate is low,
dilute phase flow results (Fig. 7.12). As its name is meant to suggest, solid
concentration is low in the dilute phase flow regime, the particles stream
upwards in relatively straight paths, and slip velocitieslie in the neighborhood
of the fIee-fall velocities of the individual particles. As the solid rate
Figure 7.12 The concentration of a gas/solid suspension as a function of the solid rate.
175
40
GAS VELOCl'!.V U
2.2
S(/(.IOSFCC
(lIl/s)
4.0
35
30
>
I-
U
0
..J
AP
-zL
(Kt/m31
2.16
25
5.5
>
..J
GAS VELOCITY
j 20
a::
w
I-
U (m/sl
....
>
I-
15
0
..J
W
> 10
a.
::::;
CII
50
100
ISO
200
2SO
small (Van Swaaji, Burman, and Van Breugel, 1970;Turner, 1978), and the
pressure gradient can essentially be regarded as the fluidized density p in the
section of the bed in question. Figure 7.13 attests to the high solid
concentrations that can be maintained in the fast bed at gas velocities that are
an order of magnitude greater than those normally employed in a bubbling
fluidized bed of the same solid.
The fluidized density is not uniform along the height of the fast fluidized
bed. The density is normally higher at the bottom, owing in part to
acceleration effects, and decays towards the top. In beds of light powders
(such as the fluid cracking catalyst), the decay is very gradual. In beds of
coarser or heavier solids the decay could be rather sharp.
Slip velocities are high in the fast bed. Those corresponding to the data
shown in Fig. 7.13 and normalized by dividing by Vt for the mean size of FCC
are given in Fig. 7.14. The slip velocity used in Fig. 7.14 is a mean value based
on the mean solid velocity.
100
SOLID RATE
150
200
250
Gs (kg/m'-sl
Slip velocity =
where e is the bed voidage and
defined by:
Vs
Gs
Vs
- -
Vs
=p; =
Vs
is turn is
Gs
pp(1 - e)
The large slip ratios can be explained by the aggregation of the solid in the
fast bed into relatively large dense clusters of particles. A large cluster would
naturally have an effective free-fall velocity that is considerably greater than
that of a single particle in isolation. If a cluster is sufficiently large, it cannot
be sustained by the rising gas; it will fall back and will subsequently undergo
disintegration by one mechanism or another - hence the apparent high
degree of solid backmixing in the fast bed.
7.4.1
In Fig. 7.15 the data far FCC obtained in the 15.2 cm column (Fig. 7.13) are
compared with similar data obtained in a 7.6 cm diameter column
(Yerushalmi, Turner, and Squires, 1976). There is obviously, a discrepancy
between the two sets of data. At a given solid rate, a higher gas velocity must
be employed in the narrower 7.6 cm bed to register the same pressure drop.
Two factors may contribute to the difference: wall phenomena and wall solid
friction. The results of Van Swaaji, Burman, and Van Breugel (1970) and
Turner (1978) indicate that friction effects, being relatively small, could not
alone be the cause of the observed discrepancy, but wall phenomena could.
Segregation of solid along the wall has been observed in the narrower 7.6 em
column to a degree clearly greater than in the 15.2 cm unit. With the core
I
I
I
I
somewhat more dilute, gas in the 7.6 cm bed can stream relative to the solid at
higher velocities than in the 15.2 em bed, for the same solid rate and solid
hold up. That is, slip velocities are higher in the 7.6 cm bed. In the extreme
case, if the entire solid segregated along the wall in a dense layer, leaving the
core empty, slip velocities would be even higher. The bed diameter at which
wall phenomena ceases to exert a significant influence, for a given solid, has
not been determined.
In principle the transport velocity should not be dependent on bed size.
However, in laboratory experiments, it might appear to be dependent to the
extent that wall phenomena influence the structure of the bed in narrow
columns and in tests with coarse or heavy particles.
7.4.2
7.4.3
I
I
I
50
100
150
200
Effect of pressure
Following the practice of students of vertical gas liquid flow, Yerushalmi and
Cankurt (1979) used the data shown in Fig. 7.13 to prepare plots of the
volumetric gas flux, in cubic metres per square metre, versus the volumetric
solid flux at constant bed densities. The results are shown in Fig. 7.16. Note
that U is in fact the volumetric gas flux and (1 - e)vs is the volumetric solid
flux G/pp; (1 - e) is the volumetric solid concentration.
The curves of Fig. 7.16 are straight lines converging, with one exception, on
the point defined by U = 1.37 and vs(1 - e) = 0.02 m/s. The line
corresponding to p = 32 kgim3 does not converge on this point probably due
to predominance of wall phenomena at this relatively low suspension density.
The intersection is the so-called flooding point (Wallis, 1969), the onset of
concurrent flow of both phases, and U = 1.37 m/s is acordingly the transport
velocity. The flooding point will always have a positive coordinate for
viI - e) because of particle carryover from a turbulent bed. Indeed, Vs (1 ) = 0.02 m/s reflects the fluidized density (about 192 kg/m3) and the
lis" 19.5Kt' S
Figure 7.16 Volumetric flux of gas U versus the solid flux V. (I-E) at constant bed densities.
Drawn from data shown in Fig. 7.13.
Further experiments to delineate the boundary between the turbulent and the
transport regimes (i.e. the transport velocity) were conducted in the modified
version of the 15.2 cm diameter system shown in Fig. 7.17. The U-tube solid
transfer line, connecting the standpipe ('slow bed') and the 15.2 column, was
replaced by a 60 (from vertical) transfer line also measuring 15.2 cm i.d.
Control of the solid flow in the modified system was afforded by a conical
valve installed at the entrance from the slow bed to the lateral transfer line.
In a typical experiment, air was supplied to the 15.2 cm column through the
ports located at its bottom. At the start of the experiment, the solid control
value was closed; then, with the velocity of the gas set at some desired value,
the solid rate was slowlyraised in small increments. After each increment, the
character of the gas solid flow along the column was observed and the
pressure drops across the various sections of the column were recorded.
Attention was primarily focused on two sections: the bottom section of the
15.2 cm column below the point where solids from the slow bed enter and the
section of the column between the pressure taps numbers 1 and 2 in Fig. 7.17.
We shall concentrate on section 1-2.
0'
()
ta.P
':
1-2
UQs
."
~L
< Uge
~~<~/~CJ2
\
: .~~ /8 Ua4
/Ugi
/:~ ..
: A':
..
UTR
.',
: \
~~
:p \
~\.QCo
181
400
SOl/OS
350
FCC
'0.64
300.
GAS VELOCITY
,-
(:~t2
(kg
1m3)
U (Ill/,l
.~~~
250
~.-1.3
.'
.,
200
1.5
0
0
0
0
0
0
150
100
50
010203040506010
SOLID RATE
Gs Ikg/1ll2-sl
Figure 7.19 gives the pressure gradients measured between taps 1 and 2
using FCC. During the experiments the solid rate suffered continuous
exursions which introduced a scatter in the data. Notwithstanding, the results
shown in Fig. 7.19 support the earlier findings that for FCC, the transport
velocity lies around 1.5 m1s and that the corresponding saturation carrying
capacity GTR is in the region of 20 kg/m2 s.
Figure 7.20 shows the corresponding data for HFZ-20, and indicates that
the transport velocity is about 2.1 mls and that GTR lies around 34 to 39
kg/m2s. Table 7.1 shows that HFZ-20 is similar in size distribution to FCC
but its particle density is about 50 per cent greater.
'
Experiments with fine alumina (dp = 103 p.m, Pp = 2.46 g/cm) reported
elsewhere (Graff and Yerushalmi, 1978) indicate that for this solid the
transport velocity lies around 3.7 to 4 m/s.
The few values of transport velocity presented in this section obviously do
not afford a basis for any correlations, though, like the other transition
182
600
0
SOLIOS~HFZ-20
1.0
0
500
1.34
'"
'" '"
400
( :~ }1-2
,GAS
1.65
VELOCITY U Imlsl
2.16
"
300
It.
"
(kg/mil
'I
U~
200
100
./
80
7.6
Figure 7.20 Pressure gradients measured in the modified 15.2 cm system
between points 1 and 2. Solid = HFZ-20.
velocities, Uc and Uk, the transport velocity UTR with particle size and
density.
The phenomena of choking, described in the pneumatic conveying
literature, is associated closely with the typical experiments described above
(Yang, 1976). To the practising engineer, choking is an undesirable clear-cut
event in which a stable smoothly flowing suspension collapses into a slugging
condition with the attendent large pressure fluctuations (Zenz and Othmer,
1960).
REGIMES OF FLUIDIZATION
In Fig. 7.21 the data obtained in the 15.2 em column over the bubbling,
turbulent, and fast bed regime, have been assembled in the form of a
fluidization map depicting the slip velocity versus the solid volumetric
4
SOLID RATE, Gs (Kg/m2
SLIP
VELOCITY ;
19~~
146
SOl/OS~FCC
FAST FLUIDIZED
-
U
--Vs
51
REGIME
(m/sl
9~,TRANSPORT
VELOCITY
~I
I
19.5
,BREAKDOWN OF SLUGS
~.
,!YBBLING
REGIME
"- I-:mf
0.2
1-
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
'Chonge in scale
Figure 7.21 Fluidization data for a fluid cracking catalyst (FCC): the slip
velocity versus the solid volumetric concentration. Data obtained in the 15.2 cm
system.
concentration at the bottom of the bed. The slip velocity is used rather than
the superficial gas velocity since it is the former which provides a relevant
measure of the interaction of gas and solid. The figure attempts to highlight
some of the points made above. Over the bubbling and the turbulent regimes,
the relation between the slip velocity and the solid concentration appears
unique. Not so in the fast bed where, corresponding to each solid rate, a
different function connecting these variables exists. If the particles were
uniformly dispersed in the fast bed, then the relation between these functions
would be unique, as it approximately is, for example, in hydraulic transport of
any but very fine solids (Price, Lapidus, and Elgin, 1959). However, the
'structure of a fast bed of fine solids is characterized by the presence of clusters
and streamers of particles. The hydrodynamic behaviour of the fast bed
accordingly reflects the interaction of the gas not so much with individual
particles as with clusters of various sizes. A change in gas velocity or solid
rate, at a given solid concentration, produces a change in the spectrum of
cluster sizes - hence the multiple functions relating the slip velocity to the
solid concentration.
Figure 7.22 is a qualitative fluidization map for fine solids. It is patterned
after Fig. 7.21 but extends further to the dilute phase flow regime. The figure
also displays schematics of equipment typical of the various regimes, each
sized approximately for the same gas-treating capacity.
The difference between dilute phase flow and the fast bed condition was
enumerated in Section 7.4. The distinction between the fast fluidized bed and
the riser transport reactor used in many modem cat cracking plants is less
Transport
riser" reactor
II
~t
:;:~
Turbulent
,', ~;'
-a
vt
.=1
i:S
.
....
--_Urn! tEmf
fluidized
-:"'$: bed
;;:::
Higher
solid
Transport
velocity
Transition to
turbulent
fluidization
1-E
,"
Bubbling
fluidized
bed
enhanced by the use of fine solids, gas velocities around 3 to 5 mis, and high
solid circulation rates.
7.7
may still be appreciable, over the turbulent range (0.82, 1.19, and 1.52 m/s)
and, in the absence of a pronounced gas velocity profile, gas is essentially in
plug flow in the fast fluidized bed (1.80 mls and beyond).
This conclusion is reinforced by Figs 7.24 and 7.25, which provide complete
concentration profiles (radial and axial) upstream of the injection point at gas
velocities of 0.21 and 1.52 mls. A striking aspect of these profiles is the
increased concavity of the radial profiles with gas velocity. This suggests a
physical picture of a mixing pattern dominated by downwards movement of
dense phase solid along the wall, and a fast-moving gas flowing upwards
through a leaner core.
120
100
80
~
~
60
....
(,)
(,)
40
20
~7.6
::E J
-5.1
-2.5
2.5
5.1
o~
-7.6
-5.1
-2.5
~i~
T~5.64
2.5
5.1
7.6
Figure 7.26 and 7.27 add further details to this picture. Figure 7.26 shows
radial profiles obtained at three locations below the injection point (i,e,
upstream) when the tracer was injected near the (left) wall of the bed
fluidized at 1.52 mls. Figure 7.27 gives the corresponding axial profiles
measured along the left wall, the right wall, as well as along the centre
of the bed.
-\
UNICANIP
. t\ISLlOTECA
CENTRAl.
~
e....
10
~
u
50
________________________
75
Distance
100
Upstream
125
150
175
(em)
6
4
0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0
Superficial
Gas Velocity,
U (m/s)
1
L
Dense
phose
..,
SOLID "FCC
.-......:....
"'
GAS VELOCITY
.~
Im/S\
.':-.....0.21 .~
g.% \\
1.0
0.82
oCi
1.2
'"
"
\ ,,:
Figure 7.29 Schematic of the countercurrent
two-phase model for the study of gas backmixing.
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
DISTANCE UPSTREAM
Theory
The physical picture, sketched above, of the mlXlng patterns over the
bubbling and turbulent regimes invites the application of a simply counter
current model. The model is illustrated in Fig. 7.29, and the governing
equations and their solutions are given below:
de
q -
dx
+ k(C
- c)
=0
2.5
3.0
3.5
Cm)
The relevance of the model is borne out in Fig. 7.30 where semi log plots of
the axial concentration profiles at 0.82, 1.19, and 1.52, and also at 0.21 m/s do
indeed form straight lines. From the intercepts, one may deduce the ratio of
Q to q. Figure 7.31 gives the results. The figure shows the diminishing
percentage of gas backflow with gas velocity over the turbulent range.
100
de
Q dx - k(C - e)
=0
= constant
e = a + /3e-k(r-l)xlq
C = a + f3re-k(r-l)xlq
qe - QC
(7.9)
(7.10)
(7.11)
q
r=-
In the above, q is the volumetric rate of gas flowing upwards and Q is the
corresponding rate for the gas flowing back; a is the tracer concentration far
upsteam.
Yang, Huang, and Zhao (1983) have recently studied axial and radial
dispersion of helium tracer gas in a fast bed. They found virtually no gas
backmixing in the central part of the riser but some near the walls. Radial
dispersion was found to decrease slightly with increase in gas velocity and to
increase with solid circulation rate. The relationships were expressed in an
empirical corelation:
Er
= 43.4 (
We ~
)
s
1: e )
+ 0.7
High velocity recirculating beds are proving increasingly attractive for certain
applications. Lurgi Chemie and Huttentechnik GmBh of Frankfurt, West
Germany, was the first to appreciate the broad potential of the fast fluidized
bed. Lurgi realized this potential in its successful process, developed jointly
with Vereinigte Aluminum Werke (VAW), for calcining aluminium hydroxide to supply cell-grade alumina (Reh, 1971). The heart of the process is a
high velocity fluid bed furnace (Fig. 7.32), which Lurgi often refers to as the
highly expanded circulating fluid bed furnace.
Calcination is conducted at a temperature between 1,000 and 1,100C.
Heat is provided by direct injection of oil or fuel gas into the lower section of
the furnace. That section is considerably denser owing to the staging of the
combustion. Primary air supplied through a distributor is substoicheiometric
and the combustion is completed with secondary air in the upper portions of
the reactor. The temperature, however, remains remarkably uniform all
along the height of the reactor which, in commercial installations, is typically
around 15 to 20 m. The secondary air is introduced through a few tuyeres.
Reh (1971) reports that the overall gas velocity in the pilot plant which
preceded the first commercial unit was in excess of 3 mls. Given that the mean
size of the alumina particles lies around 50 to 80 /km, one may presume that
below the secondary air ports the bed is maintained in turbulent fluidization.
Above the secondary air ports, the suspension is circulated in the fast bed
mode.
Since its introduction in 1970, the LurgiN AW has proved very successful,
and several of these plants now supply the bulk of alumina in West Germany;
they are also in operation or under construction in other countries in Europe
and Asia. The largest units have a capacity of about 12.5 kg/s and have a
diameter of about 4 m. The Lurgi development suggests that fast beds could
be scaled up rather readily for applications of this type. Lurgi's scale-up was
in two steps: a 12.5 cm i.d. unit was followed by a pilot 90 em diameter and
8,5 m tall unit. Both the pilot and the first commercial plant (which was over 3
Electrostatic
precipitator
Figure 7.32
of alumina.
and chemical reactions and tracer studies are required to elucidate the
interaction of gas and solid.
C
dp
Cooler
groups
Catalyst settling
hopper
Gs
GsTR
Standpipe
----
Cooling
inlet
fluid
Hmf
q
Q
Fresh feed and
recycle
demonstrates that a major and still growing portion of the market of fluid bed
boilers has been captured by circulating fluid bed boilers. These boilers
typically operate at higher combustion efficiencies and at lower excess air
levels than bubbling-type fluid bed steam generators. They utilize a simpler
and more forgiving fuel-feed system and, when burning high-sulphur fuels,
require less limestone for S02 capture. Also, they are more adaptable to
staged combustion affording NOx control as well as a better load-following
capability.
There are indications that some well-established successful processes
operate in the turbulent regime e.g. acrylonitrile synthesis, roasting of
sulphide ores (Queneau,Bracken,
and Kelly, 1958); others are under
development, e.g. Mobil's methanol-to-gasoline process (Penick, Lee, and
Mazink, 1982). The coming years will see the catalogue of new processes
expanding, but if these processes are to fully reap the potential of high
velocity fluidization, they must be able to draw from a richer reservoir of
fundamental research than that available at present.
There is a need for research at a scale that goes beyond the few inches that
has characterized much of the work to date - for systematic study of solids
spanning a wide range of properties and of the influence of temperature and
pressure. Diagnostic tools that can probe the beds must be brought to bear,
Crescitelli, S., Donsi, G., Russo, G., and Clift, R. (1978). Chisa Conference, Prague.
Gajdos, U., and BierI, T.W. (1978). Topical report for the US Department of
Energy, Contract No. EX-C-76-01-2449,
Grace, J.R., and Tuot, J. (1979). Trans. Inst. Chem. Engrs., 57,49.
Graff, R.A., and Yerushalmi J. (1978). Seventh quarterly report, prepared for the US
Department of Energy, Contract No. EX-76-S-01-2340.
Harrison, D" Davidson, J.F., and de Kock, j.W. (1961). Trans. Instn. Chem. Engrs.,
39,202.
Hoogendoorn, J.C. (1973). Clean Fuelsfrom Coal., Symposium Proceedings, Institute
of Gas Technology, Chicago, Illinois, p. 353.
Horsier, A.G., Lacey, J.A., and Thompson, B.H. (1969). Chem. Eng. Prog, 65 (10),
59.
Kehoe, P.W.K., and Davidson, J.F. (1971). Inst. Chem. Eng. (Lond.) Symp. Ser., 33,
97.
Solid-Gas Separation
197
8.2
PRINCIPLES
OF PARTICLE SEPARATION
OF EQUIPMENT
AND CLASSIFICATION
In the first phase of gas cleaning, forces are applied to the particles in order to
bring them to a collecting surface; the principles of particle separation are
usually classified according to the nature of the forces involved. These may
be:
(a) External forces due to fields of acceleration which are external to the
gaseous suspension, such as gravity, electrostatic, or magnetic forces, or
(b) Internal forces due to fields of effects which take place within the
suspension itself, e.g. inertial or centrifugal forces, diffusion, coagulation, electrostatic effects of charged particles, thermophoresis, diffusiophoresis, and piezophoresis.
The process of screening, in which particles are classified in relation to their
ability to pass through an aperture in the screen, does not lend itself to the
above classification, but its role in gas cleaning is relatively minor.
Gas-cleaning equipment often combines two or more of the abovementioned principles in one unit; the classification of equipment therefore
does not necessarily follow the same pattern. The most common classification
is into four groups, as follows:
(a) Aeromechanical dry separators in which gravity and/or inertial effects
prevail. This group includes (Svarovsky, 1981b) cyclones, settling
chambers, intertial separators, dual vortex separators, and fan collectors
(or 'mechanical cyclones'). Only the first will be considered in this
chapter.
(b) Aeromechanical wet separators (scrubbers) which make use of diffusional
and inertial effects.
(c) Electrostatic precipitators which depend on electrostatic and gravity
forces.
(d) Filters which use inertial and diffusional effects.
Flowrate-pressure drop relationship; efficiency; economic criteria; suitability for different conditions (the nature of both the dust and the gas),
solids concentration, method of disposal, reliability, etc.
8.3.1
V2 Eu Pg U2
(8.1)
Efficiency
Many gas-cleaning systems combine two or more of the above groups either
by using different equipment in series or by combining these in a single unit.
The above classification of equipment will be followed in the sections on
equipment and a separate section will be devoted to each of the four groups.
8.3
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
OF EQUIPMENT
Particle size d (}km)
There are several factors affecting the choice of gas-cleaning equipment for
any particular application. These are:
)0
Figure 8.1 Typical grade efficiency curves of dry separators (D), wet separators (W),
electrostatic precipitators (E), and filters (F).
8.3.3
Economic criteria
Economic criteria consist of the capital and running costs of the dust-arresting
plant. Capital cost is normally expresse~ per thousand cubic metres. of
cleaned gas per hour; it may be further spht mto the cost of the ~on~tr~ctlO.n
material cost of labour erection, design, etc. There are other cntena 10 this
'fi floor
category," such as specific volume of the plant (m3/1,000 ~ 3) , s~ecl.c
area taken (m2/1,OOO m3), etc., the importance of which vanes with different
applications.
.
Running costs include cost of power, mamtenance, water, etc;. ~ower
needed for running the plant consists of the power for pumps, electnclty for
cleaning (electrostatic precipitators), and also the power for blowing the gas
through the plant.
Whenever the total power requirements consist solely of the po~er needed
for passing the given flowrate Q through the separator, the theoretical power
can be calculated from the product of the required pressure drop I:1p and gas
flowrate: Q x I:1p (W). To allow relative comparisons .b.etween differe~t
separators, the theoretical power may be expressed as speclfi~energy per UOit
flowrate, and this is usually in watt-hours per thousand cubiC metres. Thus;
each newton per square metre of pressure drop represents 0.28 Wh/l,OOOm
or in practical engineering units, 1 mm w.g. (column of water) represents 2.73
Wh/1,000 m3 The actual power can only be derived from th~ theoretical
power requirements if the efficiency of the fan and the electnc motor are
known or assumed.
8.3.4
The most important disadvantage is their relatively low efficiency for very
fine particles which leads to their frequent role as a pre-cleaner.
Cyclones are now used in many different fields of technology, but their
most extensive application still remains in gas cleaning, where they are
employed for the separation of relatively coarse dusts.
There are basically two main designs of cyclones available: the reverse-flow
cyclones and the 'uniflow' cyclone., the former being more frequently used.
In both types, tne inlet gas is brought tangentially into a cylindrical section
and a strong vortex is thus created inside the cyclone body. Particles in the
flow are subjected to centrifugal forces which move them radially outwards,
towards the inside cyclone surface on which the solids separate. The two types
of cyclone differ in the direction in which the clean gas leaves the main body,
as is shown in the following.
A typical reverse-flow cyclone (Fig. 8.2) consists of a cylindrical section
joined to a conical section and the clean gas outlet is through a pipe which
extends some distance axially into the cyclone body through the top. The gas
inlet may be tangential, spiral, helical, or axial. Different inlet types lead to
some variations in performance, but the effect is not strong and, in most
cases, the tangential inlet is preferred for its simple construction.
There are a number of other factors, such as gas temperature and humidity,
the cohesiveness and abrasiveness of the dust, reliability, limits in dust
concentration, etc., which may exert an overiding influence on the final
choice.
8.4
CYCLONES
1
2
3
4
5
Helical Axial
Spiral
Three other types of gas
inlet available
Gas inlet
Cylindrical port
Conical port
Gas outlet
Top cover
-~--f~-*-
....
Particles with small gas
flow (5 to 10 per cent)
It can be shown theoretically (see Eq. 8.6 below) that for a given pressure
drop the cut size of a cyclone is proportional to the square root of the cyclone
diameter; i.e. the smaller the cyclone the higher will be its efficiency. It is
therefore theoretically sound to build multi-cyclone arrangements which use
several smaller units in parallel, with common inlet and exit manifolds. Great
care must be taken in designing the systems to ensure even distribution of
both the gas and the solids between the individual cyclones, because, if this is
not achieved, the resulting blockages (and even backflow in some units)
reduce the overall efficiency and the advantage of using multi-cyclones may
thus be completely lost. Generally, the overall grade efficiency of any multicyclone is never as good as that of the individual cyclone units.
Both reverse-flow and uniflow cyclones are used in multi-cyclone arrange-
ments, the axial, vane inlet being most commonly employed. Figure 8.4 gives
a schematic diagram of a typical multi-cyclone unit.
Multi-cyclones are generally more elaborate in construction and therefore
more expensive than single cyclones; they are also more liable to abrasion and
blocking of the dust discharge orifice due to the smaller diameter of the
individual units. The latter disadvantage makes multicyclones unsuitable for
cohesive dusts and leads to a lower limit in feed concentration of dust.
8.4.1
Flow characteristics
The static pressure drop measured between the inlet and the gas outlet of a
cyclone is usually proportional to the square of gas flowrate Q: this means
that the resistance coefficient defined as the Euler number, Eu, in Eq. (8.1) is
practically constant for a given cyclone geometry or 'design', independent of
the cyclone body diameter. The characteristic velocity U can be defined for
gas cyclones in various ways but the simplest and most appropriate definition
is based on the cross-section of the cylindrical body of the cyclone, so that:
U-
4Q
1T'D~
Efficiency of separation
The second dimensionless group which characterizes the separation performance of a family of geometrically similar cyclones is the Stokes number Stkso
defined as:
where dso is the cut size (equiprobable size). The cut size and its relationship
to separation efficiency are defined below.
In general, the separation efficiency of gas cyclones depends on particle
size (it is then called the 'grade' efficiency) and increases from zero for ultrafine particles to 100per cent for very coarse particles (see curve D in Fig. 8.1).
The particle size recovered at 50 per cent. efficiencyis referred to 'as the 'cut'
size dso and can be understood as equivalent to the aperture size of an ideal
screen that would give the same separation performance as the cyclone. The
total solids recovery in a particular case then depends on the grade efficiency
(or cut size) which characterizes the cyclone operated under given conditions
and on the size, density, shape, and dispersion of the particles (i.e. the
characte ristics of the feed material).
As the grade efficiency does not rise very steeply with increasing particle
size, some particles in the feed coarser than the cut size will pass through the
cyclone while some particles finer than the cut size will be separated.
As can be seen from Eq. (8.3), the separation efficiency is described there
only by the cut size dso and no regard is given to the steepness of the grade
efficiency curve. If the whole grade efficiency curve is required in design or
performance calculations, it may be generated around the given cut size using
plots or analytical functions of a generalized grade efficiency function
available from the literature or from previously measured data. The
knowledge of the exact form of the grade efficiency is usually not critical in
solid-gas separation applications because only total mass recovery is of
interest, and this is not much affected by the shape of the curve.
Consequently, very little is known about how the shape of the grade
efficiency curve is affected by operating pressure drop, cyclone size or design,
and feed solids concentration.
In powder classification applications, however, including the case of degritting, the shape of the curve determines the amount of the 'misplaced'
material, such as the amount of grit reporting to the gas outlet.
The Stokes number Stkso defined in Eq. (8.3) is usually constant for a given
cyclone design (i.e. a set of geometric proportions relative to the cyclone
diameter Dc), when the cyclone is used to separate granular material at feed
concentrations of less than about 5 g/m3.
Particle size d is best measured as the equivalent Stokes diameter by
sedimentation or elutriation methods. This equivalence is based on the
assumption that, if a spherical particle and an irregularly shaped particle
settle at the same velocity (in gravity or centrifugal fields), they will separate
at the same efficiency. This assumption does not hold for flat or needleshaped particles which assume different orientation in a cyclone than under
gravity or centrifugal settling. Problems are also encountered when the
particles undergo the separation process in an agglomerated state and the
agglomerates are subsequently redispersed into single particles before
particle size analysis.
8.4.3
Equations (8.1), (8.2), and (8.3) form the basis of gas cyclone design and
scale-up. There is a whole host of different cyclone designs available today,
which are usually divided into two main groups according to their geometrical
proportions relative to the body diameter: the 'high efficiency' designs and
the 'high rate' designs. Table 8.1 gives the geometry of the two best-known
cyclone designs (refer to Fig. 8.2 for dimensions). Note that only the reverseflow cyclone is considered here because that is the type used most widely in
industrial practice.
The so-called 'high efficiency' cyclones are characterized by relatively small
inlet and gas outlet orifices, and a long body, and give high recoveries. The
'high rate' designs give medium recoveries but offer low resistance to flow so
H.E."
H. R. b
ponding values of Eu and Stkso are plotted for several commercial and other
well-known designs. The points are well scattered but a line can be drawn
through them to show a general trend. The line drawn in Fig. 8.5 can be
described by the following approximate equation:
Dc
Eu =
4.0
4.0
2.5
2.5
1.5
1.5
0.375 0.5
0.2
0.575 0.875 0.375
0.5
0.75
0.5
0.75
that a unit of given size will give much higher air capacity than a high
efficiency design of the same body diameter. The high rate cyclones have
large inlets and gas outlets, and are usually shorter. In order to prevent the
incoming jet of air impinging on the gas outlet pipe, the inlet is spiral (wrapround type) while the high efficiency units can (and often do) have to a simple
tangential entry.
It is interesting to find that, for well-designed cyclones, there is a direct
correlation between Eu and Stkso: high values of the resistance coefficient
usually lead to low values of Stkso (therefore low cut sizes and high
efficiencies), and vice versa. This is shown in Fig. 8.5 where the corres-
. *nnv
xa
t.:Il:!:J "'465-20
VI
Slai,mand
HR.<$>..
R[
--
Stkso
This equation may be used for estimates of cut size of unknown cyclone
designs (of 'reasonable' proportions) from the cyclone flow characteristics
and is intended for guidance only.
Note that the scale-up of cyclones based on Eu and Stkso works well for
near ambient conditions but also predicts the performance reasonably well at
high absolute pressures and high temperatures; this means that there is no
effect of high pressures and temperatures other than that accounted for in the
definitions of Eu and Stkso on gas viscosity and density.
8.4.4
One of the most important characteristics of gas cyclones is the way in which
their efficiency is affected by pressure drop (or flowrate). Correctly designed
and operated cyclones should give pressure drops within a recommended
range, and this for most cyclone designs operated at ambient conditions is
between 2 and 6 inches of water gauge (w.g.) (approximately from 500 to
1,500 Pa). Within this range, the recovery increases with applied static
pressure drop. At higher absolute pressures the limits increase to higher
pressure drops and the equivalence is based on the same inlet velocity.
At pressure drops below the bottom limit, the cyclone represents little
more than a settling chamber, giving low efficiency due to low velocities
within it which may not be capable of generating a stable vortex. Above the
top limit the mass recovery no longer increases with increasing pressure drop
and it may actually decline; it is therefore wasteful to operate cyclones above
this limit, the value of which depends very much on the cyclone design, and
particularly on the geometry at and below the dust outlet orifice (Svarovsky,
1984). This top limit can be as high as 15 in H20 (3,740 Pa).
These recommended limits for pressure drop are demonstrated in Fig. 8.6.
If a given dust is fed into a cyclone and the input dust concentration is kept
constant but the flowrate Q is varied, the total efficiency ET first increases
until a maximum is reached (point B) beyond which it falls off. Theoretically,
it should carryon increasing as indicated by the dashed line in Fig. 8.6 since
higher tangential velocities due to higher flowrates cause stronger centrifugal
fields and should improve separation. In practice, increasing turbulence at
higher flowrates causes reentrainment of particles and, at very high flowrates,
the efficiency falls rapidly. Although, with different dusts, different curves of
(8.5)
Alternatively, for the same pressure drop and variable cyclone diameter, Eqs
(8.1), (8.2), and (8.3) give another proportionality:
dso ex:
(Dc)lf2
(8.6)
Determine the diameter of a gas cyclone and, if necessary, the number of the
cyclones to be operated in parallel to treat 2.5 m3/s of ambient air (viscosity is
18.25 x 10-6 N s/m2, density 1.2 kg/m3) laden with solids of density 2,600
kg/m3 at a pressure drop of 1200 N/m2 and cut size not more than 6 p.m.
Take the resistance coefficient Eu (related to the superficial velocity in the
cyclone U) equal to 46 and the Stokes number, corresponding to the cut size,
equal to 0.006.
Solution
2.5 x 4
Tr.
D=--
1.2 x 46
1,200 x 2
---
This is for the case of one cyclone to treat the whole of the flow. Check on cut
size: from Eq. (8.3):
0.006
x 18 x 18.25 x 10-6 x
2,600 x 4 x 2.5
1T X
0.6953
This is greater than 6 ,um and therefore unsatisfactory. The calculation can
be repeated by using Q12, Q13, etc., until the cut size becomes less than 6
,um. This is reached for Q15, so the solution is that there should be 5 cyclones
operating in parallel, each 0.31 m in diameter.
It should be stressed here, however, that the scale-up procedure shown
above is only approximate because there are effects other than inertial
separation which determine the collection efficiency, such as dust reentrainment and electrostatic effects, which do not necessarily scale up in the same
way.
The feed concentration of solids is known to affect the separation
efficiency. Concentrations higher than about 1 glm3 usually lead to higher
efficiency because of the increased rates of interparticle collisions and the
resulting agglomeration. Most cyclones serving fluidized beds process gas
having concentrations much higher than 1 g/m3 in some cases. It is therefore
fortunate that, if a cyclone is designed on the basis of the scale-up described
here, the estimate of the expected collection efficiency at higher concentrations is usually conservative.
8.4.5
just or nearly as fine as the fine product in the gas overflow. In isolated cases,
when the feed solids are very fragile or have a shape which is easily broken
(thin-shelled hollow spheres, scale particles, or such like), the coarse product
may even be finer than the solids remaining in the gas flow and reporting to
overflow. Any meaningful evaluations of grade efficiency curves or any other
assessments of the separation performance of the cyclone are then impossible.
There is clearly a need to investigate the mechanism of attrition with the
view to relating it to the fracture properties of the solids, and to develop a
realistic attrition 'index', similar to that used for abrasion in cyclones (Eq.
8.7). An empirical correlation for abrasion, specific to fluid catalytic cracking
applications, has been proposed by Zenz (1975) and there are several similar
tests used by catalyst manufacturers and users. These are usually based on
attrition in a high velocity jet which enters a small bed of the powder.
Clogging of cyclones is the greatest single source of failures in their
operation. This is usually caused by plugging or overloading of the dust outlet
orifice and as soon as this happens, the cyclone cone quickly fills up with dust,
pressure drop increases, and recovery reduces or ceases altogether. Clogging
may be caused by a variety of reasons such as mechanical defects (bumps on
the cyclone cone, non-circularity of the dust outlet, weld or gasket protrusion,
etc.), changed chemistry, or physical properties of the dust: condensation of
water vapour for example, is a sure cause.
Smaller diameter cyclones are more likely to clog than the large ones; there
is a top limit in feed solids concentration (above which clogging is likely to
occur) for each cyclone and, for given solids, it is roughly proportional to the
cyclone diameter (Svarovsky, 1981b).
8.4.6
The design of the dust discharge end is very important for correct functioning
of a gas cyclone. Any inward leakages of air at that end lead to sharp
deterioration of separation efficiency (due to dust reentrainment) while if the
cyclone is under pressure, outward leakages may marginally improve
recovery but lead to pollution and loss of product. It is therefore best to keep
the dust underflow as airtight as possible.
The strong vortex inside a cyclone reaches into the space underneath the
dust outlet and it is most important that no powder surface is allowed to build
within at least one cyclone diameter below the underflow orifice; the greater
the distance the better. In order to reduce the headroom necessary to fulfil
this requirement, a conical vortex breaker is sometimes used just under the
dust discharge orifice which stops the vortex intruding into the discharge
hopper below. This design practice is particularly common in Germany. Some
companies use a 'stepped' cone to counter the effects of reentrainment and
abrasion, and a recent investigation (Svarovsky, 1984)has proved the value of
this design feature.
.
In fluid catalytic cracking beds with internal cyclones, diplegs are used to
return the collected carryover particles into the fluidized bed. These are
vertical pipes of 'chutes' connected directly to the dust discharge orifice of the
cyclone (a stepped cone is usually used in the lower part of the cyclone) or to
the bottom of its discharge hopper (if such a hopper is fitted), extending down
into the fluidized bed below. Returning particles flow down the dipleg in the
lean phase but in the dense phase flow into the lower part before entering the
bed. The level of the dense phase in the dipleg is always higher than the bed
surface and provides a necessary resistance to reduce the upflow of the air
which would reduce cyclone efficiency. Trickle valves are usually fitted to the
bottom end of diplegs in order to provide the seal at start-up, when no
powder is yet returning into the bed; such valves do not allow any return of
the solids into the bed until a sufficient head of solids has accumulated in the
dipleg (see Chapter 12).
As to the designs of diplegs, Zenz (1975) recommends a clear dipleg height
of at least 7 feet (2.1 m) and a minimum inside diameter of 100 mm. The
solids downflow capacity of a dipleg pipe can be calculated from an existing
correlation (Zenz, 1975), and this may be used to size the pipe from the
properties of the solids and the amount of solids returned by the cyclone.
8.4.7
Cyclones in series
The solids recovery of a single cyclone does not continue to rise with applied
pressure drop above a maximum. The recovery can be further increased by
connecting cyclones in series, and this is often done in practice. No more than
two cyclones should be used, however, unless steps are taken so that the cut
size of the subsequent stages is made progressively lower by 'tightening up' on
the design (primary stage of medium or low efficiency design and further
stages of progressively more efficiency design or smaller diameter). The first
stage often has a high dust loading and the operating cut size is thus reduced
by agglomeration; the second stage, if identical in design, may operate at a
greater cut size on account of it receiving much more dilute feed. This does
not make good utilization of the second stage as its recovery is small; it is like
using a fine screen followed by a coarse screen, and design changes in the
second stage should therefore ensure that its cut size is as small or smaller
than that of the first stage.
Apart from the resulting gain in recovery, two-stage systems are also
advantageous for separation of fragile, agglomerated or abrasive dusts in that
the first stage is then designed to operate at low inlet velocity. A large
diameter primary cyclone may be used to collect the grit which would plug or
erode the high efficiency cyclone in the second stage. The two-stage systems
also offer additional reliability in that if the primary cyclone plugs, the
secondary still collects.
AEROMECHANICAL
1 - exp (-AdB)
(8.8)
where A and B are constants. Packed towers, sieve plate columns, and
Venturi scrubbers (for 2 < Stk < 8) follow the above equation with B = 2,
while for centrifugal scrubbers B is about 0.67. The constant A depends on
the scrubber type, specific water consumption and other variables, and on the
nature of the dust (particularly its affinity to water).
In the other types of scrubbers, where diffusion and other additional
principles contribute aPt'reciably to the separation, more complicated
mathematical models have to be sought (Calvert et al., 1972)
FILTERS
217
SOLID-GAS SEPARATION
8.8 NOMENCLATURE
A
AI
B
c
C
dso
size)
m
(see Eq. 8.7)
m
kglm3
m
m
Dc
E
Eu
F
K
L
M
n
R
Q
Stkso
U
t:.p
JL
Pg
Pp
cyclone diameter
dust outlet diameter
Euler number
length of gas outlet pipe
inlet height
inlet width
gas outlet diameter
exponent
radius of cyclone body
gas flowrate
Stokes number for dso
superficial gas velocity based on Dc
static pressure drop
gas viscosity
gas density
particle density
m
m
m
m
m
m
m
m3/s
m/s
N/m2
kg/ms
kg/m3
kg/m3
REFERENCES
Calvert, S., Goldschmid, J., Leith, D., and Mehta, D. (1972). Scrubber Handbook,
Natl Techn. Info. Service, Springfield, Va., PB 213-016.
Ernst, M., Hoke, R.c., Siminski, V.J., McCain J.D., Parker, R., and Dremmel, D.C.
(1982). 'Evaluation of a cyclone dust collector for high temperature, high pressure
particle control', Ind. Eng. Chem. Proc. Dex. & Dev., 21, 158-161.
Fluidized Combustion Contractors Ltd (1982). 'Observation and analysis work
associated with a 1Q0l}-hourtest program in a pressurized fluidized-bed conbustion
facility', EPRI CS-2582, Project 979-3, Topical Report, Sept.
NCB/CURL (1981). 'Fluidized bed combustion, 1000hour test program', Vols 1, 2, 3,
US/DOE/ET-10423-1101, Sept.
Storch, 0., et al. (1979). Industrial Separators for Gas Cleaning, Elsevier, Ansterdam.
Svarovsky, L. (Ed.) (1981a). Solid-Liquid Separation, 2nd ed. Butterworths, London.
Svarovsky, L. (1981b). Solid-Gas Separation, Elsevier, Amsterdam.
Svarovsky, L. (1984). 'Some notes on the use of gas cyclones for classification of
solids', in Proc. First European Symposium on Particle Classification in Gases and
Liquids, Nuremberg, May 9-11, Dechema.
Zenz, F.A. (1975). 'Cyclone separators', Chapter 11 in Manual on Disposal of
Refinery Wastes, Volume on Atmospheric Emissions, API Publication 931, May.
The low limiting Nusselt number obtained can be accounted for by the fact
that not all of the total particle surface area is available for heat transfer with
the gas. Zabrodsky (1963) proposed a model involving 'microbreaks',
pointing out that the gas did not necessarily flow uniformly through the
continuous phase of the bed. Littman and Sliva (1970) showed that,
particularly in packed beds, there is a strong dependence on Reynolds
number because the region near the point of contact between particles is not
fully accessible to the flowing fluid. Reference is made (Botterill, 1975) to two
studies which report that higher coefficients are obtained when the system is
operated at elevated pressure.
For a well-mixed bed of particles of low Biot number (i.e. negligible
internal thermal resistance) operating at a steady temperature, a simple heat
balance relates the change in temperature
of the fluidizing gas to its
penetration into the bed. Thus, on the basis that the gas exchanging heat with
the bed is in piston flow through the continuous phase, then:
for an element of bed dl m deep and of unit cross-sectional area where IlTg is
the change in temperature of the gas flowing through the element of bed and
S6 is the surface area of solids per unit volume of bed. This can be integrated
directly to give:
In
Tg - Tp )
~-~
( Tg.in - Tp
=-
( --hgp S6 ) l
U Pg Cg
6(1 - p)
dp
dg
Cg
p~.3 l.f1.3 kg (1 -
5.5 In n
M1.3
difference falls by a
Example 9.1
A bed of 450 }Lm particles is operating at 150C. the temperature and
superficial velocity of the incoming gas are 550C and 0.4 mIs, respectively.
Approximately how far will the incoming gas have penetrated into the bed
before it is cooled to 350C?
Solution
This estimate can be made using Eq. (9.4) and the gas physical properties for
the average temperature over the specified range, i.e. between 550 and
350C. At this temperature of 450C the appropriate physical properties are:
Pg
= 0.68
kg
Cg
=
=
}L
kg/m3
0.04 W/m K
1025 J/kg K
2.8 X 10-5 N s/m2
transfer and a simplification for the situation where that resistance may be
neglected.
Under the usual bubbling fluidized bed operating conditions, the heat
transfer coefficient h between an immersed surface and a gas fluidized bed
can be thought to consist approximately of three additive components
(Botterill, 1975), namely:
(a) The particle convective component hpc, which is dependent upon heat
transfer through particle exchange between the bulk of the bed and the
region adjacent to the transfer surface
(b) The interphase gas convective component hgc, by which heat transfer
between particle and surface is augmented by interphase gas convective
heat transfer and
The gas velocity at 450C for an inlet velocity of 0.4 m/s at 550C will be 0.35
m/s:
550 - 150
_ 150 = 2
= 350
approximate
range of
significance
40}Lm ~
1 mm
>
800}Lm
and at higher
static pressure
higher temperatures
(> 900 K) and
difference
group A, the operating velocities for fast fluidization exceed the particle
terminal velocity and there is very extensive back mixing in the transporting
solids (Yerushalmi and Cankurt, 1979). Under these conditions, it would
seem profitable, as Staub (1979) suggested, to apply the correlation methods
earlier developed for flowing dense solid/gas suspensions. This is briefly
referred to below (Section 9.4).
9.3.1
V(kmf
Pmf
Cp S)
The terms representing the thermal conductivity and density of the bed, kmf
and Pmf, are for the material at the condition of minimum fluidization
representative of the condition of the 'packet material'; Cp is the heat capacity
of the particles; and S is a 'stirring factor' representative of the frequency of
50
40
r .
""30
0,
:b .!?
., 0;:
20
.:!:
_ +:
u
.....
u "
:; 8
0(;
o E
~~
Cl:_
2 3 4 6 810
2 3 4
6 8 10
Ratio of particle-to-gas
2 3 4
6 8 10
thermol conductivity
3 4
6 8 10
kplkg
Figure 9.2 Diagram for estimation of effective continuous phase thermal conductivity
(Baskakov, 1968). Reproduced by permission of the author.
t--
1 Pp Cp d~
36
---->
kg
r-1
Decker and Glicksman (1981) then suggest the use of the heat transfer
resistances measured for packed beds in the estimation of rates of heat
transfer.
The chief resistance to heat transfer lies in the low thermal conductivity of
the fluidizing gas, and this is the limiting factor. Particle-particle and
particle-surface contact areas are too small for significant heat transfer to
~'~~
~
i2 800
"'e
~i
Reduci~
i~
!
Hmf
Gro~p A
Some
stobie
bed
ex pons ion
)213
h'
:f.i~1 ,.
Group C
occur through points of solid contact; heat must flow by conduction through
the gas and there is evidence of additional resistance to heat transfer in the
region of increased voidage at the transfer surface (Botterill, 1975). The
strong inverse dependence of coefficient upon particle size over the range 800 to 80 porn (Fig. 9.3) is a consequence of the increase in the percentage
area of transfer surface through which the heat can flow to the particles by
short transfer paths. With very fine powders, however, bed circulation is
inhibited by interparticle forces, and this is responsible for the marked fall in
coefficient as particle size is further reduced and the bed has the fluidization
characteristics of a group C system. Bed-to-surface coefficients increase with
an increase in the gas thermal conductivity upon operating beds at higher
temperatures (see below, Fig. 9.5). It is not until particle size and/or static
operating pressure are sufficiently increased for the fluidizing gas flow
condition through the emulsion phase to enter the transitional or turbulent
flow regime that significant interphase convective transfer occurs through the
gas (hgc, mechanism (b), Section 9.3), and not until then does pressure have
a significant effect on bed-to-surface heat transfer apart from through its
minor influence on overall bed behaviour.
A simple model (Botterill, 1975) suggests that particle packing close to the
transfer surface will be important. The voidage there will be highest with
closely size bed materials and will be affected by the material size
distribution. Thus, bed-to-surface coefficients were observed to fall as
predicted for a reduction in particle packing density at the surface when a
heat transfer element was 'stirred' through a stably expanded bed to give low
effective particle/surface residence times:
Group B
~
~/
(Botterill et at., 1966). With increasing gas flowrates, for either group A or
group B materials, there comes a point where the effect of reducing the
particle residence time caused by the increasing bubble-induced mixing is
countered by the increased bed expansion and the blanketing effect of the
bubble flow across the transfer surface. The resultant maximum in the bed-tosurface coefficient (Fig. 9.1) occurs at velocities relatively closer to that for
minimum fluidization as mean particle size increases. Todes (1965) has given
the approximate correlation for Reop! which is used on Fig. 9.4.
For powders falling within Geldart's group A, the minor peak commented
on above (Fig. 9.1) is a consequence of some initial restricted particle
circulation by diffusive mixing as the bed fluidizes. Additional continuous
phase expansion leads to a reduction in the bed-to-surface coefficient. With a
further increase in gas velocity, the bed reaches the minimum bubbling
.e
Ql
..Q
~ 10
..,'"
g
v v
38o}'om
462}'om
533}'om
x
664}'om
+
775j.4m
887}'om
o 1276}'om
!l 2320 f'm
sand
sand
sand
sand
sand
sand
sand
sand
coal ash
~.p
820
p.rn
occurring in large scale equipment. Bubbles rise up the centre of the bed and
there is the return of solids 'stick/slip' flow down the column wall. The tests
have also most usually only been carried out at comparatively low
temperatures, although the results are presented in generalized correlations.
Van Heerden (1952) tested the then-available correlations with four
hypothetical systems. For one of these systems there was greater than a four
hundred-fold range in the predicted coefficient! The article by Gel'perin and
Einstein (1971), in which they propose a generalized correlation, further
illustrates the scatter in the reported measurements, and casts doubt on the
value of such correlations at all. Nevertheless, Zadbrodsky's (1966) approximate correlation for the maximum bed-to-surface coefficient neglecting
radiation effects is to be recommended for powders of Geldart's group B for
which the particle convective component predominates and with which there
is negligible stable bed expansion - generally within the mean size range of
100 to 800 pm mean diameter:
it;'
a:
Ar
Figure 9.4
Archimedes
;;:
Ole
...
500
10-2).6 (480
10-6)-0.36
Bed
temperature,
C
Excess air,
%
f.l.m
Estimated
gas
conductivity,
W/mK
Figure 9.5 Variation in maximum bed-to-surface heat transfer coefficient with temperature for beds of sand of different particles sizes and
predictions of Zabrodsky's equation (Eq. 9.9) (Botterill, Teoman, and
Yiiregir, 1981).
170
360
540
620
800
960
Negligible
proportion
of combustion
products
300
90
70
40
20
Estimated Maximum
coefficient measured
coefficient,
hmaf
W/m K
W/m2 K
3.55 x 10-2
366
370
x 10-2
x 10-2
x 10-2
428
492
512
572
617
430
500
510
610
690
4.6
5.8
6.2
7.45
8.45
10-2
x 10-2
and Shakiri
w
=-1 [ 1--ln R
pc Ra
2Ra
1+-
2Ra)]
Rw
where Ra is the resistance to heat transfer within the packet phase and Rw is
the additional wall region resistance. Ra may be estimated from development
kmf Pmf
) 1/2
Cp
d g
[ U~f(U/~mf-Af
to = 0.33
U
[
mt
(UIU _
d mf
11.1-1
d
D~J
A)2]
11.1-1
pg
where the value of the constant A varied with the bed material and the tube
diameter. However, packet residence time is usually unknown a priori,
although developments in the understanding of mixing processes (Chapter 5)
may eventually permit a realistic estimate of it and of the fraction of time
bubbles shroud the transfer surface. The resistance in the wall region Rw is
independent of time to a first approximation. More recently, this resistance
has been associated with an effective gap between particle and surface
originating from their inherent roughness (Decker and Glicksman, 1981).
However, if the resistance is considered to be generally the region of
increased voidage which extends to about half a particle diameter from the
surface and the heat transfer through this region is solely by steady state
conduction, Rw can be represented by:
where kw is the effective thermal conductivity in the near wall region and can
be estimated following Kunii and Smith (1960).
Very good correspondence
between observation and prediction was
obtained on this basis using Eq. (9.11) to predict the coefficients for flowing
packed bed experiments in which the particle residence time at the heat
transfer surface was known (Denloye and Botterill, 1977). Fortuitously, the
effect of a resistance represented by a 'gas gap' of one-tenth of a particle
diameter was tested in earlier theoretical studies (Botterill, 1975) and found
235
to correspond well in its predictions with observed experimental observations. It corresponds closely with predictions based on the more complicated Kunii and Smith model and is recommended for approximate estimates.
Rw would be greater and more complex in form if conditions had developed
such that there was a return flow of solids descending in 'stick/slip' flow at the
heat transfer surface which was occasionally disturbed by bubbles penetrating
to the surface. The basic forms of this latter model have been developed by
Yoshida, Kunii, and Levenspiel (1969) but, as stressed above, it cannot
usually be applied because the physical properties and condition of the
particulate film adjacent to the transfer surface are not generally known.
However, Bock and Molerus (1980) have demonstrated the basic validity of
this type of model in experiments on heat transfer to vertical tubes in beds up
to 1 m in diameter in which simultaneous measurements of local bubble
behaviour and time-averaged local heat transfer were made. The claims of
general applicability often made for specific mechanistic models, however,
are very questionable. Where bubbling processes are explicity modelled, it is
salutary to test out the implications of that element in the model and see if the
bubble flow predicted is credible (BotteriIl, 1986). In any case, no simple
correlation incorporates the change in mixing consequent upon the transition
from group D to group B type behaviour (see Section 9.3.2 below). It is often
necessary for the models, too, to fall back on limited experimental tests to
evaluate a 'constant' which appears in the model (e.g. Heyde and Klocke,
1979; Martin, 1980).
kmf
Pmf
Ra estimated for
40 s as Ra
(kplkg
10kg
727)
401T)
= (
and
l/2
Rw estImated as 0.1-
hpc for
dp
0.lx200x1O-6
kg
= ------
40 s
89 W/m2K
9.8 x 10-
0.026
7.7
10-4 m2 K/W
7.7 X 10-4
1 - ------In
2 x 9.8 X 10-3
+ 2 x 8.8
107.7 x 10-4
X
)il
R.,
Rw,
(m2 KIW) x 103 (m2 KIW) x 104
40
20
10
Example 9.3
as
5
1
0.5
0.1
9.8
7.0
4.9
3.5
1.6
1.1
0.51
7.7
7.7
7.7
7.7
7.7
7.7
7.7
89
120
163
213
379
418
713
Note, for comparison purposes, that Eq. (9.9) predicts a maximum value of
2
hpc of 414 W/m k, which seems to be a reasonable value for a freely fluidized
system. Following Kunii and Smith (1960), the alternative estimate for Rw
obtained is 7.1 x 10-4 m2 K1W.
h
pc
= -R1 [ 1a
-R In
2Ra
1+ 2Ra)~
-R
w
9.3.2
Nugc
U
O.0175Aro.46 PrO.33 ( Urn
)0.3
for Urnf
1 20C. 1 aIm
2 20C, Gatm
3 GOOC, 1 aIm
where U is the fluidizing gas velocity and Urn the corresponding value for the
maximum bed-to-surface heat transfer. An alternative empirical correlation
for the interphase gas convective component has been derived by Botterill
and Denloye (1978) as:
i
~100
d1/2
g~
O.86Ar0.39
loJ
< Ar < 2 x
106
is
which has dimensions of m -1/2. The assumption was made that it measured
by the heat transfer coefficient at the point of fluidization. This is not strictly
true because, although no particle convection will occur with the bed in its
quiescent state, there will be conductive heat transfer through the gas
between the particle and surface close to the 'point bf contact' to augment the
interphase gas convective component when the particle thermal time constant
is larger than its residence time close to the surface (Decker and Glicksman,
1981). The relative significance of this conductive contribution compared with
the gas convective component reduces as particle size and operating pressure
increase, so the assumption is most in question for particles < 1 mm mean
diameter fluidized at atmospheric pressure at elevated temperatures. The
corresponding maximum particle convective component (assuming the two
components to be additive) was correlated against the Archimedes number by
the following dimensionless equation:
1,000
Particle diameler (fLm)
Before using the above correlations (Eqs 9.16 to 9.19) it should be noted
that there is some evidence that fines in the size distribution can have a large
effect. Thus, contrary to the predictions of Eqs 9.16 to 9.19, Golan et al.
(1979) came to the conclusion that particle size had a negligible effect on
the bed-to-surface heat transfer with four beds of mean particle diameter
between 800 and 2,700 porn with top fractions ranging from 1,410 to 5,600
pm, but it is significant that the fines distribution (1,410 porn downwards)
was very similar in all four cases. Thus it is possible that the fines present may
have determined what was happening and affected the turbulence in the gas,
so reducing the contribution of the interphase gas convective component.
The Baskakov and Suprun (1972) predictions corresponded well with the
experimental coefficients obtained for quiescent beds of large particles at
ambient temperature and pressure, but increasing discrepancy was observed
as the static operating pressure was increased (Botterill and Denloye, 1978)].
The form of the component will be relatively insensitive to an increase in gas
velocity, and this has been substantiated by Catipovic et ai. (1980). This
is reasonable because there will be little change in the actual gas flow conditions through the continuous phase or adjacent to the transfer surface with
group 0 bubbling beds and, indeed, the maximum bed-to-surface coefficient is relatively insensitive to further increase in fluidizing gas velocity,
though some allowance should be made for direct heat transfer between the
gas flowing through the bubbles and the transfer surface (Catipovic et aI,
1980).
An effect of relative probe/particle heat capacity has been observed
(Botterill, Teoman and Yiiregir, 1984a). When, for example, bed-to-surface
heat transfer coefficients were estimated by following the response of a 10
mm diameter spherical calorimetric test probe suddenly immersed into a hot
bed of 2.3 mm diameter sand particles, the measured coefficients were
approximately 30 per cent. higher than the values predicted using the
correlations given above (Eqs 9.18 and 9.19). However, correspondence was
very close between measured and predicted values when using a calorimetric
exchange surface of much higher heat capacity. The effect becomes
increasingly significant as the ratio of immersed surface-to-particle heat
capacity falls below - 10. This is consistent with the view that, when the heat
capacity of the exchange element becomes comparable with that of the
particles, the element does not extract sufficient heat from the particles to
cool them significantly during their period of close proximity and the timeaveraged particle-to-surface temperature difference is higher, resulting in
higher effective values of the heat transfer coefficients. This effect could be
expected, for example, to increase the heat transfer rate to crushed coal as it
is charged to a fluidized bed combustor above that predicted by the simple
correlation.
Heat transfer coefficients are further enhanced when the object is free
to move (Rios and Gibert, 1984). Polchenock and Tamarin (1983) have
developed the following empirical equation for the prediction of the transfer
coefficient between fluidized bed particles and freely circulating objects:
Numax
0.41ArO.3
D:
d
(
0.2
(pP:)
-0.07
",0.66
where the subscript p refers to the bed particle and 0 to the object being fed to
the bed, and'" is the bed particle shape factor. The correlation was derived
from tests with bed particles of different materials of densities equal to or less
than that of sand and of diameters up to 6.3 mm. They predominantly had
group D characteristics but included some group B materials. The objects
were spherical or cylindrical.
400
52
N
!.
0
."E
C
300
'u
f
.
0
u
.:!.,~
........-
c::
~
'0
~
E::J
200
'x0
-- -~-
1.......
--- ------~
!
Copper probe
o Gold probe
:::E
Figure 9.7 Variation in maximum bed-to-surface heat transfer coefficient with temperature for 1,150!-Lm alumina compared with predictions
of Zabrodsky's equation, (Eq. 9.9) and the Botterill and Denloye
equations (Eqs 9.18 and 9.19).
heat capacity until, at about 600C, there is a sharp change in the temperature
dependence of the heat transfer coefficient. The transition is consistent with a
change in the dominant transfer mechanism consequent upon the change in
gas physical properties with increasing temperature; Remf has fallen to -12.5
and the corresponding Archimedes number is about 26,000 (Botterill,
Teoman, and Yiiregir, 1981, 1984b). At higher temperatures, the bed is
behaving with the characteristics of a group B material and the particle
convective mode of heat transfer becomes dominant. (The increasing
difference between coefficients measured to an oxidized copper and a fine
gold surface at the higher operating temperature also illustrates the increasing
contribution of radiant heat transfer). It seems probable that the interstitial
gas flow conditions change at the transition and that there is a change from
'slow' to 'fast' (see Chapter 4) bubbling behaviour, with a consequent
increase in the effectiveness of solids mixing as bed operating temperature is
increased. It is conceivable that bed operating conditions exist under which it
is possible to have effectively slow bubbling behaviour in the lower bed
regions but fast bubbling higher within the bed with consequent implications
for bed-to-surface heat transfer.
9.3.3
Radiative Component hr
Table 9.2 Measured effective emissivities (Pikashov et at., 1969), probably underestimated by 10 to 20 per cent (Makhorin, Pikashov, and Kuchin. 1978)
Material of bed
dp
mm
Gas
velocity
UlUmf
770 - 1,470
River sand
(rounded particles)
1-1.5
1.2 - 3.0
770 - 1,370
0.60
0.85
Chamotte
(irregularly shaped
particles)
1-1.5
1.2 - 3.0
720 - 1,370
0.60
0.80
0.21- 1
1.2 - 4.0
870 - 1,320
0.23
0.59
Alumina Al203
(rounded particles)
1.5-2
1.2 - 3.0
1,070 - 1,720
0.27
0.59
0.95
that the total bed-to-surface heat transfer coefficient h will be of the order of
600 W/m2 K for an immersed tube in a bed operating at 800 e which is of
similar magnitude to the likely steam side coefficient for a unit raising steam
at 3000e and 20 atm pressure. Under such circumstances the tube surface
temperature may approximate to 550 to 600oe, leading to an apparent
emissivity of about 0.6, which seems reasonable.
In contrast to lower temperature systems, maximum heat transfer coefficients with group B bed materials in particular are likely to be less sensitive to
the gas f1owrate. Thus, when the bed is bubbling vigorously while bubbles will
increasingly shroud the heat transfer surface, they will also open up the bed so
that the heat transfer surface can see deeper into it where there has been less
influence of the cooled immersed transfer surface and the bed is behaving
n:or.e like a black body radiator (Botterill, Teoman, and Yiiregir, 1984a).
Sumlarly, the apparent emissivity of the free surface of the bed will be higher.
For rule of thumb estimates, the radiative component can be estimated using
absolute temperatures and an adaptation of the Stefan-Boltzman equation in
the form:
0
hr =
5.673
--------
10-8
Tb
Er
-
cn, ..-_--~)
Ts
+ lIea) -
9.4
Figure 9.9 Variation in apparent emissivity with transfer surface and
bed temperature for a bed of alumina (Baskakov et al., 1973).
Reproduced by permission of the author.
USE OF IMMERSED
HEAT
If the walls of the bed provide insufficient heat transfer surface, the available
transfer area may be increased by the immersion of tubes within the bed.
Figure 9.10 Polar diagram showing variation in local heat transfer coefficient round a 35 mm
diameter tube immersed in a bed of 0.37 mm alumina operating at 500"C; excess fluidizing gas
velocities of 0.89 m/s (e) and 0.23 m/s (A), corresponding value of Umf 0.11 m/s (Botterill,.
Teoman, and Yiiregir, 1986a).
tendency for the rising bubbles to displace the stagnant particles from the top
of the tubes periodically. Although very close tube spacing seriously affects
the particle circulation (in the extreme, the bed may even rise above the tubes
so that they become the effective gas distributor if they are so closely spaced),
McLaren and Williams (1969) found no drastic reduction in heat transfer
coefficients as the tube spacing was progressively reduced in low temperature
tests. Their heat transfer results for both in-line and staggered arrays fell on a
single curve if the results were plotted in terms of the narrowest gap between
the tubes. Thus, coefficients fell by about 25 per cent. as the gap reduced
from 282 to 15 mm in tests which fluidized ash of wide size distribution and
mean particle diameters between 400 and 500 p.m but including small
fractions of greater than 1.78 mm diameter. They commented on obtaining
coefficients some 20 per cent. lower when the tube bundle was located close
to the distributor, a region strongly influenced by the functioning of the
distributor and where the bubbles generating particle circulation are still
small compared with those higher within the bed. If gas jetting at the
distributor should increase particle exchange at the transfer surface, this
would, conversely, be expected to increase the particle convective component
of the heat transfer coefficient. However, this would also be likely to be at the
expense of particle attrition and tube erosion damage if the jets actually blow
the particles on to the tubes.
The most extensive series of measurements on heat transfer to a single
immersed tube was carried out by Vreedenberg (1958, 1960), although he
worked predominantly over the rising range of the heat transfer versus the gas
flowrate-curve. He fo~nd it more difficult to correlate the results for a vertical
tube than for a horizontal one, which is to be expected. In the latter instance,
complicated though it is, the prevailing conditions of strong vertical solids
circulation past horizontal tubes is a simpler process than that obtaining at a
vertical surface when local particle residence time at the surface, under the
prevailing bed circulation conditions, can be expected to be a more complex
function of bed operating conditions. The experiments of Piepers, Wiewiorski, and Rietema (1984) with 19 vertical tubes of 2 m length arranged in a
bundle of three concentric rings immersed in a bed of 66 }km mean diameter
catalyst (Umf = 0.0018 m/s) operated at velocities up to 0.4 mls illustrate this
well. Measurements of the local coefficient along a tube mounted at the three
different radial locations were consistent with a predominant circulation of
material up in the central region of the bed, with return flow downwards at
the wall but changing in detail with a change in the operating conditions.
To characterize his material, Vreedenberg used a particle Reynolds group
which included both the particle density and diameter, and he did not,
therefore, include the gas density in it. However, he did not use this group
directly in his correlations but used, instead, the tube diameter in a modified
Reynolds group. For a vertical tube he also included the bed diameter in his
correlations, which is somewhat surprising. For a horizontal tube, Vreedenberg's correlation (1958) takes the form:
hDT)
kg
(~.)
0.3
= 0.66
(U
DT Pp (1 -
Cp}k
E) )
0.44
}kE
}k2) 0.3
U DT Pp
(
}k
d~ P~
U dp
for --}k
Pp
> 2,550
(9.24)
The form of the correlations for vertical tubular inserts was considerably
more complicated (Vreedenberg, 1960).
Andeen and Glicksman (1976) introduced the factor (1 - E) into the
correlation (Eq. 9.25) so that it should be able to follow the observed
decrease in the bed-to-tube coefficient with increasing gas flowrate beyond
the maximum. Andeen, Glicksman, and Bowman (1978) subsequently
reported that the modified form of correlation would also fit results for
horizontal flattened tubes if the constant is adjusted appropriately, but their
experimental results show considerable scatter within themselves.
The very complete review by Saxena et at. (1978) of work on heat transfer
to immersed tubes at temperatures below which radiant transfer is significant
draws attention to the wide range of results reported. In various circumstances, the different correlations lead to unrealistic predictions with the
Vreendenberg correlations best following the observed temperature dependence of the coefficient (Botterill, Teoman, and Yuregir 1984a, 1984b). Of
seven other correlations also tested, those by Grewal and Saxena (1981) and
Ternovskaya and Korenberg (1971) tended to predict the more extreme
values (Fig. 9.11), but none predicted the' right overall temperature
dependence. As reliable for horizontal tubes, and easier to use, are the simple
correlations recommended in Sections 9.3.1 and 9.3.2 above, namely: for
materials of group B, characteristics to use 70 per cent. of hpc,maxas predicted
by Eq. (9.9) to allow for the effect of the immersed tube when the hot bed is
being cooled (Fig. 9. 11a) and about 75 per cent. of the sum of the components
predicted by Eqs (9.18) and (9.19) for beds of group D characteristics,
immersion of the tube not then affecting the coefficient so much. The
boundary between the two classes of behaviour is at Remf - 12.5 and Ar
-26,000, as outlined above (Botterill, Teoman and Yiiregir, 1984a, 1984b).
This occurs at about 550C for the 1.15 mm alumina bed (Fig. 9.11b). The
detail of the results obtained by Piepers, Wiewiorski, and Rietema (1984) for
heat transfer to vertical tubes would suggest that it is not so easy to estimate
an average bed-to-vertical tube coefficient. Some tests on vertical (Bock and
Molerus, 1980) and horizontal arrays (Catipovic et ai., 1980) showed little
difference between the maximum coefficients obtainable to a tube within an
array and that to a single isolated tube.
Staub and Canada (1978) reported interesting tests of large particle bed
models (dp = 600 and 2,600 }km fluidized at high velocities and pressures up
to 10 atm in the so-called 'turbulent' fluidized bed regime. They reported
results which show a maximum heat transfer coefficient at gas velocities onequarter of the particle terminal velocity, typical values being of about 230
2
W/m
K for 550 }km particles fluidized under atmospheric pressure
conditions; they also found a dependence of the coefficient on the 0.2 to 0.3
power of the gas density depending on the particle size and tube geometry.
,,
t:l
a;
a;
"- . \.
"- "-.
"-\
"
'\.
\
\
\
\
\
c:
.~
'\
oJ>
0."0
" ,,
,,
'"
'\
"
,
,
\
::J
a.
0
Cl
" ae'..."
\
0
'\
!!I
~'t:
<Ii
<7
"
U
ai
~.
0
~
c:
"
u
"0
'..." !..~
::J
0
0
'"
<;
a.
:e
!!
1 +(
"0
to
150
dp
6)
10
0.73
(0.42Pp
(1 -
Eav)
t.zZ.4
)J
0.45
pgU
'"
"0
This compares with powers of 0.39 and 0.15 for the gas and particle
convective components, as indicated by the correlations of Eqs (9.18) and
(9.19), but one can hardly expect the correlations for ordinary bubbling bed
flow to be applicable. Staub (1979) has developed a credible heat transfer
model based on the correlations established for flowing dense solids/gas
suspensions. This uses gas and solid superficial velocities pertinent to the
upflow and downflow situations as a prediction within his flow model. The
simplified form of his general relation predicts the ratio of Nusselt numbers
(based on the tube diameter) for the conditions with the bed present Nu and
without particles Nugas in the form:
C\l
E
E
()I
0
0
0
0
0
0
<t
C\l
'"
wnw!xDW
~
WnW!XDW
for 20 p.m < dp < 1,000 p.m; for 1,000 p.m < dp < 3,000 IJ-ma value of dp =
10-3 m should be used in Eq. (9.26). t.Zm in the expression is a mixing length
which is the average distance between tube centres in this model. The average
bed hold-up (1 - Eav) is taken from bed expansion data or the correlation
data given by Staub and Canada, (1978). Wood, Kuwata, and Staub (1980)
have extended this model to heat transfer to tubes in the splash zone of a
fluidized bed of large particles.
Because of the reported range of behaviour, it is only prudent to carry out
tests on a model of as large a scale as possible. Preferably, when concerned
with a multi-unit system, this should be a 'unitcell' of the proposed system,
i.e. incorporating all the features of one full-scale complete unit of the
proposed design. This would be the area of bed fed from one fuel distribution
point, say, in the design of a combustor. However, because bed behaviour
can change markedly with operating temperature (Botterill and Teoman,
1980; Botterill, Teoman, and Yiiregir, 1981), the results of cold tests should
be interpreted with caution.
For a bed of given cross-sectional area, the depth of bed required in order
to immerse adequately the tubes providing the necessary heat transfer surface
area will be dependent on the chosen tube diameter and pitch. The available
surface area of tube within a given volume of bed increases both as the tube
diameter is increased and as the pitch is decreased. Higher fluidizing gas
pumping power cost in order to overcome the pressure drop across the bed is
the penalty to be paid for deeper beds. Thus, for example, the choice can be
important in the design of atmospheric pressure fluidized bed combustors
for steam-raising plant. At higher superficial velocities, a larger immersed
9.5
The use of finned tube heat transfer elements has been advocated for
applications where the bed-side coefficien~.may be limiting. Generally, in
deep bed applications, bed-to-surface coeffICIentsbased on the total expo~ed
surface area are considerably reduced. Thus, Staub and Canada (1978) gIve
values showing something like a 30 per cent. reduction after allowing a
correction for the fin efficiency, but this obviously depends on the geometry
of the system (see also Saxena et ai., 1978). Not only .will p~rticle ~cce~s
within the fins depend on the relative size of particle and fm spacmg but It wIll
also depend on the relative location of neighbouring tubes. Nevertheless,
rough calculations indicate that a tube with 2.1 fins per centimetre length and
with a fin structure that will not exceed a maximum fin tip temperature of
500C in a 900C combustion bed, offers a threefold improvement in heat
transfer capability compared with a bare tube bank (Staub and Canada,
1978)..
Shallow fluidized beds have an advantage through their low pressure drop,
and the most efficient gas/solid contacting also occurs in the region of the
distributor, where bubbles are growing rapidly by coalescence (see Chapter
4). They also afford the basis for very efficient waste heat recovery units
(Virr, 1976). In this latter application, finned tubes are immersed in shallow
fluidized beds and the regions between the fins behave virtually as separate,
dilute fluidized beds. Bubbles remain restricted in size by the closeness of the
fin spacing, which may be as small as 3 to 5 mm or 15 to 20 times the particle
diameter. In operation, bed expansion as high as 400 per cent. is usual while
still obtaining high bed-to-surface coefficients, as good as those to a bare
tube, because of the very short particle residence times obtaining at the heat
transfer surface; particle velocities are possibly an order of magnitude higher
than in a deep bed and this more than compensates for the greatly reduced
bed density. Based on the outside area of the tube, obtainable coefficients are
in the range of 1 to 4 kW/m2 K. Because the particles in the bed present a very
high surface area to the gas, very good heat recovery can be achieved from a
hot fluidizing gas. Typically a unit can be operated with an overall pressure
drop as low as 50 mm water gauge from the suction developed by an exhaust
fan which is used to suck the hot flue gases through the bed. For space
heating, 150 kW of hot water has been recovered using a small unit to cool
flue gases from 600 to 180C. Another unit is producing 3.5 tonne/h of steam
from the waste gases from a 1,200 h.p. diesel engine in a 32,000 tonne dead
weight oil tanker.
a liquid metal cooled nuclear reactor system. In this scheme, heat would be
transferred between the lower horizontal tube array through which the liquid
metal circulated to an upper bank of steam-raising tubes by the fluidized bed.
Thus they thought to use the fluidized solids as an inert heat transfer medium,
so obviating the danger of direct sodium/steam contact in the event of tube
failure.
There is much potential for the use of beds of particles in heat storage
associated with generation and recovery systems. There is a possible
advantage in separating the heat generation from steam-raising sections of the
boiler plant by interposing a large store between the combustion bed and the
steam generating plant (Botterill and Elliott, 1964). For an electricity
generating power station, the combustion equipment could then be rated at
the average load over 24 hours, whereas only the heat exchangers and
electricity generating equipment would have to be rated for the peak
capacity. A cube of side 40 m would provide adequate store for a 500 MW
unit, and this is no bigger but much cheaper than a larger boiler. In the
defluidized state heat losses from the store would be low. The system offers
improved reliability against combustor failure through the period of grace
afforded by the energy in store. By controlling the rate at which material is
fluidized and withdrawn from the store, the turndown problem occurring
when tubes are immersed directly within the combustion bed (referred to in
Section 9.4 above) is overcome; such a system posseses very quick startup
capabilities, limited only by the rate at which the turbine can accept load.
Many high temperature processes produce dirty exhaust gases at varying
rates. In the steel industry, for example, the BOS unit operates intermittently, producing exhaust gases at 1,600C, and the order of energy to be
disposed of is typically about 8 GJ/t of steel production. Currently, this is
wasted and is expensive to dispose of. It could be transferred to a store using a
falling cl<JUdheat exchanger and recovered from there using fluidbed
techniques for transport and the heat transfer operation. A solids flow rate of
3 kgls is readily capable of transporting energy at a rate of 2 MW. Basic
studies on the feasibility of this and solar energy storage utilizing fluidized bed
tehcniques are outlined by Bergougnou et at. (1981).
255
Do
DT
to
g
h
hgc
hgp
hpc
hr
H
Hmf
ke
kg
kmf
kp
kw
Ra
Rw
Tg
Tp
Ts
LlZm
IE
lEapp
9.8 NOMENCLATURE
A
Cg
Cp
dp
S
Sa
V
Vmf
t
Ta
lEa
Jlkg K
Jlkg K
m
m
m
lEeff
IEp
IEr
s
j.L
Pg
m/s2
W/m2 K
W/m2 K
W/m2 K
W/m2 K
W/m2 K
m
m
W/mK
W/mK
Pmf
Pp
u
'T
t/J
Ar
Nugc
Nugp
Pr
Rep
Remf
m/s
m/s
s
K
K
K
K
m
N s/m2
kg/m3
kg/m2
kg/m3
W/m2 K4
s
9.9 REFERENCES
W/mK
W/mK
W/mK
m2KIW
m2KIW
Barile, R.G., Seth, H.K., and Williams, K.A (1970). Chem. Eng. J., 1,236.
Baskakov, A.P. (1968). High Speed Non-oxidising Heating and Heat Treatment of
Metals in a Fluidized Bed, Metallurgy, USSR.
Baskakov, A.P., Berg, B.V., Virr, O.K., Phillippovsky, N.F., Kirakosyan, V.A.,
Goldobin, J.M., and Suprun, V.M. Powder Technol., 8, 273.
Baskakov, AP., and Suprun, V.M. (1972). Int. Chem. Eng., 12, 119.
Bergougnou, M.A., Botterill, J.S.M., Howard, R.J., Newey, D.C., and Teoman, Y.
(1981). Third International Conference on Future Energy Concepts, London, p. 61.
Bock, RI., and Molerus, O. (1980). Proceedings of the 1980 Fluidization Conference
(Eds J. R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Publishing Corporation, New York, p.
217.
Botterill, I.S.M. (1975). Fluid Bed heat Transfer, Academic Press, London.
Botterill, J.S.M. (1986). "Advances in Fluidized Bed Heat Transfer" in Transport
Phenomena in Fluidising Systems. (Eds. L.K. Doraiswamy and B.D. Kulkarni)
Wiley EasternlWiley Halsted, in press.
Botterill, I.S.M., Brundrett, G.W., Cain, G .L., and Elliott, D.E. (1966). Chem. Eng.
Prog. Symp. Ser, 62, (62), 1.
Botterill J.S.M., and Denloye, A.O.O. (1978). A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 74 (176),194).
Botterill, I.S.M., and Elliott, D.E. 1964). Engineering, 198, 146 (July 31).
Botterill, J.S.M., and Teoman, Y. (1980). Proceedings of the 1980 Fluidization
Conference (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Publishing Corporation,
New York, p. 93.
Botterill, I.S.M., Teoman, Y., and Yiiregir, K.R. (1981). A.l.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 77
(208), 330.
Botterill, I.S.M., Teoman, Y.,and Yiiregir, K.R., (1984a). Powder Technol., 39,177.
Botterill, J.S.M., Teoman, Y., amd Yuregir, K.R., (1984b). XVI ICHMT Symposium, Dubrovnik, 5-7 Sept.
Catipovic, N.M., Jovanovic, G.N., Fitzgerald, T.L, and Levenspiel, O. (1980).
Proceedings of the 1980 Fluidization Conference (Eds J.R. Grace and J. Matsen)
Plenum Publishing Corporation, New York, p. 225.
Davidson, J.F., and Harrison, D. (1971). Fluidization, Adademic Press, London.
Decker, N., and Glicksman, L.R. (1981). AI.Ch.E. Symp. Ser, 77 (208), 341.
de Groot, J.H. (1967). In Proceedings of the International Symposium on Fluidization,
Ed. A.AH. Drinkenburg Netherlands University Press, Amsterdam, p. 348.
Denloye, A.O.O., and Botterill, J.S.M. (1977). Chem. Eng. Sci., 32,461.
Donsi, G., Lancia, A., Massimilla, L.,and Volpicelli, G. (1984). In Fluidization (Eds
D. Kunii and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation Conference, p. 347.
Elliott, D.E., Healey, E.M., and Roberts, AG. (1971). Conference of the Institute of
Fuel and L'Institut Francais des Combustibles et de L'Energie, Paris.
Geldart, D. (1972). Powder Technol., 6, '85.
Gel'Perin, N.I., and Einstein, V.G. (1971~'In Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.
Harrison), Academic Press, London, p. 471.
Gel'Perin, N.I., Einstein, YG., and Zakovski, A.V. (1966). Khim Prom., 6, 418.
Golan, L.P., Cherrington, D.C., Diener, R., Scarborough, C.E., and Wiener, S.C.
(1979). Chem. Eng. Prog., 75, 62 (July).
Grewal, N.S., and Saxena, S.c. (1981). Ind. Eng. Chem. Proc. Des. & Dev., ZO, 108.
Heyde, M., and Klocke, H-J. (1979). Chem. Ing. Technik, 51,318.
Khan, A.R., Richardson, J.F., and Shakiri, K.J., (1978). In FluidizationProceedings of the Second Engineering Foundation Conference (Eds I.F. Davidson
and D.L. Keairns), Cambric!ge University Press, p. 345.
Kunii, D., and Levenspiel, O. (1969). Fluidization Engineering, Wiley.
Fluidizing with hot air is an attractive means for drying many moist powders
and granular products. The technique has been used industrially since 1948,
and today it enjoys widespread popularity for drying crushed minerals, sand,
polymers, fertilizers, pharmaceuticals, crystalline materials, and many other
industrial products.
The main reasons for this popularity are as follows:
(a) Efficient gas solids contacting leads to compact units and relatively low
capital cost combined with relatively high thermal efficiency.
(b) The handling of the particles is quite gentle compared to some other
types of dryer. This is important with fragile crystals.
(c) The lack of moving parts, other than feeding and discharge mechanisms,
keeps reliability high and maintenance costs low.
The main limit on the applicability of fluid bed dryers is that the material
being dried must be fluidizable. Some potential feedstocks are too wet to
fluidize satisfactorily. This is usually due to an excessive amount of surface
moisture on the particles, causing them to agglomerate. This problem may be
overcome by flashing off the surface moisture in a pneumatic conveying dryer
preceding the fluid bed dryer. Another limitation is encountered if the
product has a very wide size distribution, so that at an air velocity high
enough to fluidize the large particles there is an unacceptable loss of small
particles from the bed. To some extent this limitation can be overcome
nowadays by the use of a vibrating fluid bed (see below).
The potential user of fluid bed drying has a wide variety of equipment to
choose from. The main categories are described briefly below. Within each
category there are many variations offered by equipment vendors.
10.2.1
Batch dryers
The first distinction to be made is between batch and continuous fluid dryers.
Batch dryers are normally used when the production scale is small and several
different products have to be made on the same production line. Figure 10.1
Dried
product
shows a typical batch fluid bed dryer. The wet feed is loaded into the cabinet
and clamped to the filter sock module. The cabinet doors are then closed and
the blower started. An adjustable damper controls the degree of air
recirculation. The circulating air may be heated by a steam tube battery or by
gas firing. Batch fluid bed dryers are particularly popular in the pharmaceutical and dyestuffs industries.
10.2.2
The first continuous fluid bed dryer was the 'well-mixed' type, illustrated in
Fig. 10.2, which was introduced in the United States in 1948. It is usually of
circular cross-section, and takes its name from the fact that the particle
residence time distribution approaches the perfect mixing law:
E(t)
~exp
(-
t~ )
-Fuel
Air
10.2.3
These are beds of shallow depth (typically 0.1 m) in which the particles flow
along a channel whose length/width ratio is much greater than unity (typically
in the range 4:1 to 30:1). The objective is a more or less close approach to
plug flow of the particles, so that they all emerge with approximately the same
moisture content. For length/width ratios up to about 10 the particle flow
channel may be straight, but for higher ratios a reversing path or spiral path is
more practicable as shown in Fig. 10.3. Straight channel designs are often
provided with baffles normal to the direction of particle flow in an attempt to
improve the approach to plug flow.
-air
Exhaust
to
cyclone
Adjustable
weir
I Dried
product
Plan view
Feed--BL....
This is simply a straight channel plug flow bed with a vibrating distributor, as
shown in Fig. 10.4. Alternatively, it may be viewed as a vibrating fluid bed
~G_
Product
(bl
Plan view
Flexible
Z:=couplings
Feedl'
_______
~I
Product
F = feed
P= product
Figure 10.3 Continuous 'plug flow' fluid bed dryer: (a) straight
path; (b) reversing path; (c) spiral path.
conveyor which uses hot air as the fluidizing medium. Compared to the
simple plug flow bed, it has the advantage that any agglomerates arising at the
feed will be kept moving by the vibrations of the distributor, hopefully until
they have dried sufficiently to break up.
Furthermore,
feeds with a wide size distribution can be processed
successfully in this type of bed. The air velocity can be set low enough to
avoid excessive elutration of the smaller particles while the largest particles
are kept moving by the vibration of the distributor.
Finally, these beds are often used to dry feeds consisting entirely of large
particles with a minimum fluidization velocity of the order of 1 m/s. With a
static distributor an air velocity considerably in excess of the minimum would
be needed to ensure adequate fluidization and conveying, but this would be
far more air than is required to satisfy mass and heat balance considerations.
If the distributor is vibrated the air velocity can safely be kept in the vicinity of
the minimum fluidization velocity, with consequent savings in capital and
operating costs.
Present technology imposes two limitations on vibrated fluid bed dryers.
Firstly, the materials of construction available for vibration mountings limit
air inlet temperature to about 400C. Secondly, if the bed is to vibrate at its
natural frequency, which is the simplest and most economical way of
operating, bed lengths are limited to about 8 m. Therefore, vibrated fluid bed
dryers are limited to intermediate temperatures and intermediate throughputs. Finally, they have a higher maintenance requirement than static fluid
beds.
10.2.5
Multi-stage
Multi-stage beds
(a) To accomplish drying and cooling in the same vessel, which is usually a
straight channel plug flow unit with a divided chamber below the
distributor (see Fig. lO.Sa.)
Feed
1:::~~t~~?
Exhaust
-air
~tt'---==-.~-===;...
=...------1~ld~
~
Product
IWell-mixed
lsectian
I Plug flow
: section
Figure 10.5 Multi-stage fluid bed dryers: (a) dryer plus cooler;
(b) plug flow fluid bed following well-mixed fluid bed (plan view).
(b) To combine the ability of a 'well-mixed' bed to handle wet feeds with the
ability of a 'plug flow' bed to achieve a comparatively uniform product
moisture content, through having a 'well-mixed' section followed by a
'plug flow' section (see Fig. 1O.5b)
Purposes (a) and (b) can be combined in a three-stage unit.
In case (b) the temperature of the air supplied to the 'well-mixed' stage can
be higher than that supplied to the 'plug flow' stage because the higher
evaporation rate in the first stage will help to keep the bed temperature down.
A higher air velocity may also be used in the first stage to help in rapid
dispersion of the wet feed.
10.2.6
Fluidized beds can also be used for making dry powder from a feed which is a
slurry or solution. The feed is sprayed on to the bed, usually with a pneumatic
atomizer to give a very fine atomization. The particles in the bed are
continually growing, by one or both of two mechanisms. A drop may strike a
particle and form a thin layer of liquid on the particle surface, whereupon the
layer immediately dries and the particle grows by one layer. This mechanism
gives a hard, dense particle structured like an onion. Alternatively, the
particle may strike another particle before the layer has dried, in which case
the liquid may act as a binder and hold the particles together. This gives a
Top
spraying
Wet
~R
feed~
Submerged
feed
'-Surface
---""""solids
OR
-Bottom
w ----------(df'-
Separated solids
ar dust
Direct~OR
to fluid bed
10.3.1
..,.........
Solids treatment
(size reduction and/
or classification
Product
removal
-~I
x-x.
Figure 10.7 Batch drying curves.
called the constant rate period and the second called the falling rate period.
The moisture content at the transition between the two periods is called the
critical moisture content Xcr' If drying is continued for long enough, X will
approach the equilibrium moisture content Xe. For a given material this is a
function of relative humidity and temperature. At any point on the curve the
amount of removable moisture remaining, X - Xc, is called the free moisture
content. It should be noted that in reality Xcr rarely appears as a sharply
defined point on the experimental drying rate curve. There is usually some
curvature at the transition from constant rate to falling rate. Xcr is probably
best defined as the point at which the forward extrapolation of the constant
rate line intersects the backwards extrapolation of the falling rate curve.
The rate of drying - dXldt can be determined at any point by
differentiating the X versus t curve. A graph of - dXldt versus the free
moisture content X - Xe is an alternative way of representing the drying
characteristics of a material (see Fig. 1O.7b).
As a rough approximation, the constant rate period may be regarded as
corresponding to the removal of surface moisture from the particles, while the
falling rate period corresponds to the removal of internal moisture. Since
most materials will not fluidize satisfactorily if there is substantial surface
moisture, the constant rate period in fluidized bed drying may be so short as
to be unobservable, except under very mild drying conditions. On the other
hand, a non-porous material such as sand may show virtually no falling rate
period.
10.3.2
In the constant rate period the surface of the particle is wet enough for the
layer of air adjacent to the surface to be saturated. Hence, the drying rate is
determined by the rate at which vaporized moisture can be transported across
the boundary layer surrounding a particle. During this period the temperature of the particle surface remains constant at the wet bulb temperature
Twb of the air. If Pwb is the partial pressure of vapour at the wet bulb
temperature, P is the partial pressure in the bulk air stream, and Kp is the
mass transfer coefficient based on partial pressure, the rate of moisture
removal Nc per unit particle surface area (called the drying flux) in the
constant rate period is given by:
Nc = Kp (Pwb - p)
(10.2)
Since the particle temperature does not rise during this period, all the heat
transferred across the boundary layer from gas to particle must be used for
evaporation. Hence, an alternative formulation for Eq. (10.2) is:
hgp
NC=T(T-
Twb)
where hgp is the gas-to-particle heat transfer coefficient, A is the latent heat
of vaporization and T is the bulk gas temperature.
For the air-water system the wet bulb temperature of the air is almost equal
to the adiabatic saturation temperature, which is readily obtained from
psychrometric charts. For organic solvents in air or an inert gas, TWb can be
calculated if the psychrometric ratio of the solvent-gas system is known (see,
0.03Re~3
(10.4)
This suggests that the heat transfer coefficient, and hence the drying rate in
the constant rate period, should be proportional to the gas velocity U raised
to the power 1.3. This was confirmed by Mostafa (1977) in experiments on the
drying of small particles of silica gel, molecular sieve, and vermiculite in a
fluidized bed.
Many fluid bed dryers, particularly those with vibrating distributors,
operate on particles of diameter greater than 1 mm. Many less data are
available for this size range, and what there are suggest a much lower
dependence of drying rate on gas velocity. No generally applicable correlation is yet available. Zabeschek (1977) found that with a fluidized bed of
aluminium silicate particles the particle-to-gas mass transfer coefficient was
roughly proportional to If'.5 when the particle diameter was 2.76 mm, and
was almost independent of U when the particle diameter was 4.30 mm.
Subramanian, Martin, and Schliinder (1977) also concluded, from an analysis
of other investigators' results, that transfer rates are effectively independent
of gas velocity when the particle diameter is much greater than 1 mm.
Equations (10.2), (10.2), and (10.4) have a number of other practical uses.
They enable one to predict the effects of bulk gas temperature, bulk gas
humidity, and small particle diameter on the drying rate in the constant rate
period.
10.3.3
In the falling rate period the rate of moisture migration to the surface of a
particle is insufficient to keep the layer of air adjacent to the particle surface
saturated. Hence, the drying rate is no longer determined solely by conditions
in the boundary layer. It also depends on the pore structure of the material
and on the mechanism of moisture migration. There may, in fact, be several
simultaneous mechanisms. These include capillary action, vapour diffusion,
diffusion along internal surfaces, and, in the case of cellular materials,
diffusion across cell walls. The balance between these mechanisms may
change as drying proceeds. For example, capillary motion may predominate
during the early part of the falling rate period when the pores are relatively
full, while vapour diffusion may dominate towards the end when only small
pockets of moisture remain in the solid structure. In general, the falling rate
t Increasing
I
No
I
I
I
,'--Locus
I
of {X-x"Jc,
I
/
I
I
by:
N
Ncf
X - Xe)
( X _ X
cr
Nc V
X-X
Xcr
N=Nc
Xe
(X-X)
X
cr
-;
The available experimental evidence indicates that. for materials which dry
relatively quickly, - dXldt is almost inversely proportional to bed depth
(Mostafa, 1977; Reay and Allen, 1982). Therefore, the drying rate - WB
dXldt, where WB is the dry bed weight, is effectively independent of bed
depth, and increasing the bed depth does not increase the drying rate. It
appears that most of the drying takes place in a shallow layer just above the
distributor, and increasing the bed depth merely reduces the frequency with
which an individual particle enters this layer. If we assume that the gas flow
can be divided into an interstitial flow and a bubble flow with most of the heat
and mass transfer occurring in the former and not much gas exchange
occurring between them, then a plausible explanation is that the mass transfer
rate is so rapid that the interstitial gas becomes almost saturated a short
distance above the distributor (see Fig. 10.9a).
Bed depth
I
I
I
- ---------
..- -Soturation
the bed surface (see Fig. 1O.9b). If relatively quick drying materials have an
appreciable falling rate period they also tend towards this type of behaviour
when the drying rate has declined to a very low value.
10.4.1
Let F
= solid
= solid
Subscripts:
F(Xi
Let HF
Bed depth
I
I
Xo)
= G (o - j)
+ associated liquid
Hg
Qw
= rate
= rate
Qh
- - - - - - - - - - - ~----
Saturation
I
I
I
I
t
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
t
+ GHgj +
Qh
On the other hand, with a material such as wheat which dries very slowly,
- dX/dt is almost independent of bed depth (Reay and Allen, 1982).
Therefore, the drying rate - WB dX/dtis directly proportional to bed depth. It
may be surmised that in this case the intersitial gas is still far from saturated at
+ GHgo +
(10.7)
Qw
aoe,
= FHFo
HFj
HFo
Hgj
Hgo
aoe
= (Cs + XjC1)
=
=
TFj
(Cs + XOC1) TFo
(Cg + jCv) Tgi + jA
(Cg + oCv) Tgo + o A
(10.8)
(10.9)
(10.10)
(10.11)
yields:
+ Qh
The starting point of this calculation is always a batch drying curve measured
in laboratory equipment at a suitable bed depth z and gas velocity U. The
latter is chosen to be high enough to ensure good fluidization but low enough
to avoid excessive elutriation. The measured batch drying curve can be
transformed to other bed depths and gas velocities by means of the rules
presented earlier.
For simulation of a plug flow fluid bed dryer the batch drying curve should
be measured with the air inlet temperature Tg; constant at the desired value.
This will usually be dictated by material temperature limitations, with an
appropriate safety margin. If the deviation from plug flow is small, the
temperature and moisture content histories of the material as it flows along
the bed will correspond to its temperature and moisture content histories on
the batch drying curve, so the required mean particle residence time tm can be
read directly from the appropriate curve.
The calculation is more complicated for a bed with a well-mixed particle
residence time distribution. This case has been analysed in detail by Vanecek,
Markvart, and Drbohlav (1966). In this case, in order to simulate the passage
of particles through the continuous bed the batch drying curve should refer to
a constant bed temperature rather than a constant air inlet temperature. This
means that during the course of the laboratory experiment the air inlet
temperature must be progressively reduced as the drying rate declines in
order to prevent the bed temperature rising. A good control system is
needed.
In the continuous operation let Xl be the moisture content of a particle
after residence time t in the bed, and let Xo be the average moisture content
of the product. If E(t) is the residence time distribution function of the
product we have:
Xo
l;t
E(t) dt
(10.13)
and using Eq. (10.1) for the residence time distribution in a perfectly mixed
vessel we obtain:
In this expression the function Xl is given by the batch drying curve measured
at constant bed temperature.
In the general case, Eq. (10.14) must be integrated numerically with an
arbitrarily chosen value of tR, and by trial and error the value of tR found
which gives the desired Xo' This is not difficult with a computer or a
programmable calculator.
In certain special cases an analytical solution may be possible. For example,
suppose the batch drying curve can be approximated by a linear falling rate
curve with no constant rate period, i.e.:
dX
dt
--=
k(X-
X)
Xl
= exp (-kt)
e
Xe
Xo
10.4.3
= Xe + 1 + k tR
Let the bed area be A, the bed depth z, and the bed density
measured in the laboratory for a given gas velocity U). Then:
Bed hold-up
= FtR =
PB
(easily
PBzA
and
PgUA
(0.20
)
0.04 - 1
800 s
_ 1.39 x 800 _
2
A - 500 x 0.200 - 11.12 m
= 0.70
x 11.12
7.78 kg/s
(10.17)
The gas exit humidity Yo can now be calculated from the mass balance Eq.
(10.6). If reasonable values are assumed for Qh and Qw, the gas exit
temperature Tgo can then be estimated from the heat balance Eq. (10.12).
The psychrometric chart should then be used to ascertain how far Tgo is above
the dew point of the exit gas. A difference of at least 10C is usually
considered necessary to avoid the risk of condensation in the cyclones. If they
are too close, additional bed area may be required to increase G and thereby
reduce Ygo'
If desired, the entire calculation procedure can be repeated with batch
drying curves corresponding to different gas velocities until an optimal design
is achieved.
G (Xi - Xo)
1.39
7.78 (0.20 - 0.04)
Yo
+ Yi
= 0.034 kg H20/kg
+ 0.005
dry air
Reference to a psychrometric chart shows that air of this humidity has a dew
point of 34C. Therefore, since the air leaves the bed at 80C there is no risk
of condensation.
TFi
Therefore,
20C,
Cs
1.0 kJ/ktC,
C1
4.2 kJ/kgOC
Example 10.1:
= 0.005
tR
(1.0
+ 0.20
x 4.2) 20
36.8 kJ/kg
Let 6,000 kg/h of a wet porous solid entering at 20C be dried from a water
content of 20 per cent. by weight (dry basis) to an average water content of 4
per cent. by weight. The bed depth is to be 200 mm, the bed temperature
80C, and the superficial mass velocity pgU of the inlet air 0.70 kg/m2s.
Under these conditions the bed density is 500 kg/m3 The humidity of the inlet
air is 0.005 kg H20/kg dry air. The specific heat of the dry solid is 1.0 kJ/kg C
and the specific heat of liquid water is 4.2 kJ/kg C. There is no internal heater
in the bed. Heat loss from the walls may be taken as 5 per cent. of the heat
content of the inlet air. At the selected operating conditions the constant bed
temperature batch drying curve for this material consists entirely of a linear
falling rate curve obeying the equation - dX/dt = 0.0005X S-l. Calculate the
required mean residence time, bed area, mass flowrate of air, and air inlet
temperature. Check that the exhaust air is far enough above its dew point to
avoid condensation problems in the cyclone, and estimate the thermal
efficiency of the dryer.
Solution
HFo = (1.0
0,
Qw = 0.05 Hgi
0.05 GHgi
G
Hgi
= G (HFo
I~
I~:~:
(HFo
HFi)
+ Hgo
(69.6 - 36.8)
Xi
= 0.20,
Xo
6,000
1.20 x 3,600
0.04,
Xe
+ Hgo
HFi)
+ 148
0.~5
} 0.~5
Hgj
7.78 x 162
= 1,260 kJ/s
= F(X
=
=
Xo)
507 kJ/s
IN
ac
ax2
(10.18)
iflc
Pax
-=D-'--v2
ac
s~
The net flow velocity Vs = LltR, where L is the bed length. In terms of the
dimensionless variables e = t/tR and ~ = x/L, Eg. (10.19) becomes:
ac
DptR
371
iflc
ac
10-4 (U - Umf)
u~i
m2/s
(10.21)
J:
Eo de
than 8.
(c) For small deviations from plug flow, i.e. for small values of B, the
solution to Eq. (10.20) yields the symmetrical curve:
iflc
at = D
ac
at
p'
where the gas velocity U and the minimum fluidization velocity Umf are in
metres per second. The term (U - Umf) in the numerator is clearly a measure
of the extent of bubbling in the bed, but the denominator term is completely
empirical.
Having established that particle diffusion in a horizontal direction in a
shallow fluidized bed obeys the same basic equation as molecular diffusion,
we ca~ make use of the body of theory developed for deviation from plug flow
of flUids through process vessels. A good account of the latter is given in
Chapter 9 of the book by Levenspiel (1972). For our present purpose the
most important concepts and results are the following:
10.5
Eo
2 Y( 1TB)
exp
{(1-8)2
4B
!!....
(10.22)
deviation of the
Y(2B)
tm
This approximation is reasonable up to B = 0.1, which covers most
practical cases of true 'plug flow' fluid bed dryers.
(d) An alternative way of representing deviations from plug flow is to
consider the bed as consisting of a number n of perfectly mixed beds in
series. For perfect plug flow n = 00. With this model the dimensionless
standard deviation Uo = V(Un). Hence, comparing the two models we
have n = 1I(2B).
From the above analysis the designer can select the maximum value of B
which can be tolerated if the deviation from plug flow is to be kept within the
specified limits. Dp can be estimated from Eg. (10.21) and the required tR
estimated from the batch drying curve. Hence, the minimum acceptable bed
length L can be calculated. The process design calculations outlined earlier
yield the required bed area A, so the required bed width W can be found. In
the case of a bed with reversing or a spiral flow channel, Wand L should be
interpreted as the width and total length of the particle flow channel.
It should be emphasized that the validity of the above analysis has only
been confirmed for bed depths up to 10 cm. There is some evidence in the
literature that Dp may be an order of magnitude larger in much deeper beds
(Mori and Nakamura, 1965; Highley and Merrick, 1971). this is thought to be
due to the establishment of regular particle circulation cells in deeper beds, in
contrast to the more random particle motion in shallow beds. This large
increase in Dp with deeper beds suggests the use of the shallowest practicable
bed depth when the objective is a close approach to plug flow.
Calculation of the residence time distribution in a
'plug flow' fluid bed dryer
Bed length L
=5m
= 1,000 s
Gas velocity U
= 0.4
m/s
bed area
Et
E9
N
Nc
Nu
fO
F
G
hgp
HFi
HFO
Hgi
Hgo
k
0.1 m/s
kg
kp
Dp
DptR
-4
3.7
=0=
2.4
10
0.4 - O.
0 1/3
.1
= 2.4 x 10-4 m2/s
10-4
25
1
=-
2B
1,000
52
0.0096
kJ/kg K
kJ/kg K
kJ/kg K
kJ/kg K
m
m2/s
kg/s
i kg/s
W/m2K
kJ/kg
kJ/kg
kJ/kg
kJ/kg
W/mK
kg/m2s (N/m2)
m
kJ/s
kJ/s
The earliest applications of fluidization were for the purpose of carrying out
chemical reactions (see Chapter 1). Since that time there have been many
successful chemical processes involving fluid bed reactors. The principal
applications are listed in Table 11.1 under three headings:
Table 11.1
(a) Catalytic gas phase reactions. These are cases in which the solid particles
serve as catalysts, undergoing no chemical changes and limited physical
changes during the course of the reaction. The catalyst materials are
manufactured or selected to combine favourable activity and selectivity
characteristics with suitable physical properties - particle size and
density, resistance to attrition, etc. The most important application
historically is the catalytic cracking of petroleum.
(b) Non -catalytic gas phase rections. In this case the particles are inert. Their
purpose is to provide a uniform heat transfer medium or nuclei upon
which the product material can be deposited (as in fluid coking) or both.
Applications in this category are relatively rare.
(c) Gas-solid reactions. Reactions of this type involve the fluidized particles
themselves. The useful product may be the solid, a gas, thermal energy,
or some combination of these. In reactions of this type there is generally
less control over the properties of the solids than can be achieved in
catalytic reactions. Moreover, the solids undergo changes in their
chemical composition and their physical characteristics during the course
of the reaction. The most important applications of fluidization for gassolid reactions are in roasting of ores, calcination reactions, regeneration
of catalysts, and processing of coal and biomass.
The principal advantages of fluidized beds which make them attractive for
many chemical processes relative to fixed beds and other types of gas-solid
reactors are:
(a) Temperature uniformity. 'Hot spots' are avoided.
(b) Favourable rates of heat transfer to immersed tubes or to the walls of the
column.
(c) Ease of solids handling. Solids can be continuously added and removed
from the system. In catalytic reactors the deactivated solids may be fed to
a parallel regenerator bed and then recycled to the main reactor.
(d) Scale of operation. Successful operations have been achieved with
columns as small as 0.05 m and as large as 30 m in diameter.
(e) Turndown. The gas flowrate can be varied over a wide range.
(f) Pressure drop. The pressure drop across a fluidized bed of solids is less
than for the same bed at the same superficial gas velocity under fixed bed
conditions, especially for fine particles.
On the other hand, fluidized beds have certain limitations and disadvantages
which must be clearly recognized when considering what type of reactor is
best suited to a given process:
(a) Backmixing of both solids and gas is generally substantial, resulting in
lower conversions than with most competing types of reactor.
Fluidized beds are far too complex hydrodynamically to be used for deriving
reaction kinetics. Instead, kinetic parameters should be obtained in reactors
where the hydrodynamics can be described with confidence. Fixed beds are
well characterized by dispersed plug flow models (see Levenspiel, 1972;Wen
and Fan, 1975), but temperature gradients may be severe. Consequently, it
may be better to use a spinning basket reactor (TajbI, Simons, and Carberry,
of reactant species
of product molecules
which gas volume changes due to reaction can be neglected. Allowance for
volume changes accompanying reaction is complicated due to the fact that
most reaction takes place in the dense phase of fluidized bed reactors, while
most of the added volumetric flow probably finds its way into the bubble
phase.
11.3
BUBBliNG
Bubbles in fluidized beds are responsible for by-passing of gas and for limiting
gas-solid contacting. While there are important similarities between bubbles
in fluidized beds and bubbles in liquids, the gas motion in the two cases is
fundamentally different. In gas-liquid systems, the gas must circulate entirely
within the bubble. In fluidized systems, on the other hand, the bubble
boundary is permeable, and gas circulates through the bubble, entering at the
bottom and leaving through the upper surface. This factor, commonly
referred to as 'throughflow',
has important consequences for gas-solid
contacting and for interphase (bubble to dense phase) mass transfer in
aggregative fluidized beds.
Consider a bubble rising at steady velocity Ub' Whether or not elements of
gas leaving the top of the bubble recirculate through the dense phase and
reenter the bottom of the same bubble depends on the ratio
(g) Mass transfer of products from the exterior surface into the bulk
Catalyst particles used in most fluidized bed processes are quite small,
typically 50 to 120 J.tm in mean diameter, small enough for external mass
transfer and internal diffusion resistances to be minor. Temperature gradients
inside the catalyst particles can also usually be neglected. For many purposes
it is permissible to use a single apparent or overall volumetric rate constant
kn, defined as:
'A
-1 dNA
V dt
p
bubble velocity
a
Ub Emf
U mf
For a > 1 recirculation does occur. The region surrounding the bubble in
which gas recirculates (see Fig. 11.1) is called the 'cloud'. According to the
= knC;'
"'ass transfer at
bubble / cloud boundary
theory of Davidson and Harrison (1963), the cloud for a spherical bubble also
has a spherical boundary with the same centre and with volume:*
Vc = Vb
( 3)
a-I
1T
d~q
2 (a _
1)
(11.3)
Vb (~)
a-I
0.195 1T d~q
a-I
Emf
0.50
(e) Dolomite:
dp
Solution
The rise velocity of the bubble relative to the dense phase in each case is
(from Eq. 4.9):
Uh
0.71 (gdeq)l/2
0.71 (9.8
0.10)1/2 mls
Case
Umf, m/S
Emf
a
b
0.005
0.056
0.16
0.32
0.54
0.50
0.45
0.45
0.48
0.48
c
d
e
a
70
5.6
2.0
1.05
0.62
0.043
0.017
0.65
0.25
1.2
3.1
54
21
No clouds since a < 1
(11.4)
Experimental results (Rowe, Partridge, and Lyall, 1964; Anwer and Pyle,
1974) indicate closer agreement with the Murray analysis, but both theories
have been used as the bases for reactor models, as we will see below. For a
review of the fluid mechanics of fluidization and analyses of gas motion
around bubbles, see Jackson (1971).
As shown by Eqs (11.2) to (11.4), the cloud volume is strongly related to a
and hence to particle size. Typical cloud volumes are estimated in the
following sample problem.
(d) Dolomite:
The values of Umf and Emf together with values of a calculated from Eq.
(11.2) and V c!Vb from Eqs (11.3) and (11.4) appear below:
0.70 rols
'The terms cloud and cloud volume refer in this book only to the outer dense phase mantle
(particle and interstitial gas) surrounding the bubble in which gas recirculates. Occasionally
(e.g. Partridge and Rowe, 1966) the terms are used to include also the gas contained in the
bubble.
Clouds form the basis for a number of the reactor models to be discussed
below. For a < 1, gas emerging from the upper surface of bubbles does not
recirculate. Instead the gas short circuits through the bubbles on-its way
through the bed. Hence cloud models are not applicable to large particle
systems (often called 'slow bubble' systems) where a < 1. A qualitative
explanation of why a plays such a role may be helpful.
All of the theories suggest that the velocity of the throughflow gas at the
bubble roof is proportional
to the interstitial gas velocity, Umf/Emf'
(Davidson's theory gives a proportionality constant which is three times
greater than Murray's, and this accounts for the larger predicted clouds.) The
gas emerging into the dense phase from the bubble surface encounters
particles which are moving tangentially around the bubble surface with
velocities of order Ub and decreasing with increasing radial distance from the
bubble surface. This situation is shown in Fig. 11.2. If the interstitial velocity
Umrlemf is much less than Ub (i.e. for large-a), the particles near the bubble
drag the gas around the bubble surface in a tight trajectory and a thin cloud is
formed. As Umf/emf increases (i.e. as a decreases), the gas elements
penetrate further into the dense phase before the drag caused by the solid
particles is able to reverse the direction. A larger cloud therefore results. For
a sufficiently large Umf/Emf where a < 1, the gas is able to penetrate so far
that it never recirculates.
Pyle and Rose (1965) predicted gas streamlines inside rising bubbles. The
most notable feature of their predictions was that there were regions at all
values of a in which gas would circulate entirely within the bubble, without
ever making contact with particles. Total by-passing of this gas would
therefore occur. In practice, molecular diffusion, bubble dilations, and
raining through of solids are expected to cause rapid mixing of the gas within
each bubble. Hence almost all subsequent workers have assumed perfect
mixing within each bubble unit, and we will limit our attention to models of
this type.
6asmotion
inside006'
I+
particles is of order ub
Figure 11.2 Forces acting on an element of gas emerging from a bubble into the
dense phase. The frame of reference is moving with the bubble.
The first term represents the throughflow component, as given by the analysis
of Murray (1965). (In a number of reactor models the corresponding result
from Davidson's analysis (Davidson and Harrison, 1963) is adopted, leading
to the first term being larger by a factor of 3.) The second term in Eq. (11.5)
describes diffusion according to .the-penetration theory. The bulk flow or
convective term is dominant for large particles, but the diffusion term
becomes more important for small particles, as shown in the following
worked example.
Example 11.2: Interphase mass transfer rates
Determine the two components of the interphase mass transfer coefficient
and the total coefficient for the transfer of hydrogen in air at 20Cfor the five
cases of Example 11.1. The molecular diffusivity is 6.9 x 10-5 mls.
Solution
From Example 11.1, deq = 0.10 m and Ub = 0.70 m/s. We are given qj) = 6.9
x 10-5 m2/s. Inserting these values into Eq. (11.5) with the appropriate
values of Urnf and Emf from Example 11.1, we obtain the following results:
294
GAS FLUIDIZATION
TECHNOLOGY
Case
Particles
Convection
term, mm/s
Diffusion
kq,
term, mm/s mm/s
a
b
c
d
e
80 /Lm catalyst
250 /Lm sand
450 /Lm sand
700 /Lffidolomite
1.2 mm dolomite
1.3
17.5
14.0
40.0
80.0
135.0
16.6
16.6
17.2
17.2
18.8
30.6
56.6
97.2
152
Bulk
flow/kq
0.07
0.46
0.71
0.82
0.89
In addition to the influence of decreasing particle size, the diffusion term also
becomes more important as the molecular diffusivity increases and as the
bubble size decreases.
The fact that Eq. (11.5) gives a good representation of transfer rates from
the bubble phase implies that the principal resistance to mass transfer resides
at the bubble boundary, not at the cloud boundary. Theories for mass transfer
at the cloud boundary based on diffusional transfer alone (Partridge and
Rowe, 1966; Kunii and Levenspiel, 1969) predict much lower mass transfer
coefficients than are measured or inferred in practice. This implies that
neglected mechnisms of transfer at the cloud surface (in particular due to
adsorption by particles moving through the cloud region, due to unsteady
bubble motion, or due to shedding of cloud/or wake elements) are sufficient
to cause rapid dispersion of gas in the dense phase once gas elements are
transferred from a bubble. See Walker (1975), Chavarie and Grace (1976),
Lignola, Donsi and MassimiIIa (1983), and Grace (1984) for further
discussion and evidence on this point.
For bubbles undergoing interaction and coalescence, there is evidence of
enhanced interphase mass transfer (Toei et ai., 1969; Pereira, 1977; Sit and
Grace, 1978, 1981) compared with isolated bubbles. Indications are that the
throughflow term in Eq. (11.5) is augmented by 20 to 30 per cent. for a freely
bubbling bed when averaged over time, while the diffusion term is unaffected
(Sit and Grace, 1981). For freely bubbling beds the following relationship
should be used (Sit and Grace, 1981):
kq
Umf
=-+
3
(4 flJ _
Emf !lb.)
1T
Early workers tended to treat fluidized beds as if the gas and solids were
intimately mixed without segregation into dilute and dense phases. This led to
simple 'single-phase models' in which it was assumed that reactor performance could be determined from the residence time distribution of gas
elements. In practice, however, reactor performance is likely to be affected
less by the residence time distribution than by the 'contact time distribution',
i.e. by the distribution of times that gas elements spend in the vicinity of, and
in effective contact with, solid particles. Gas elements in the bubbles are in
poor contact with solids, while those in the dense phase are in intimate
contact. Hence single-phase models are unable to account for the true flow
and mixing behaviour of aggregative fluidized beds, and we must therefore
look at more complex models in which two or more phases are considered.
Single-phase models do, however, provide limits for the two-phase models
considered below. If we consider a first-order reaction (n = 1), the limiting
results are as follows:
deq
--
=exp (-k1)
(11.7)
1
1 + ki
(11.8)
CAin
CAout
--=-CAin
One or other of these results (depenaIng on the assumed dense phase gas
mixing pattern) will be approached as limiting cases for the simpler two-phase
models considered below, as mass transfer of reactants between phases
becomes very rapid or as the proportion of gas passing through the dilute
phase approaches zero.
11.6
112
CAout
The models considered in this section are based upon parallel onedimensional flow in two or three phases, as illustrated in Fig. 11.3. The word
'phase' in this context refers to a region which may include both gas and solid
particles. The phases are distinguished from one another in terms of the
volume fraction of solids, by physical appearance, and/or through their flow
characteristics. In one group of models, shown in Fig. l1.3(a), the dilute
phase is either free of particles or assumed to contain only widely dispersed
solids; in these models no distinction is made between the cloud and other
interstitial gas elements. In a second group of models, Fig. l1.3(b), the cloud
gas and solids (with or without bubble wakes) are lumped with the bubbles to
give a .combined bubble/cloud dilute phase. Gas within the cloud is then
assumed to have the same composition as gas within the bubble surrounded
by the cloud. In a third group the cloud is treated separately from both
bubbles and the remaining dense phase (often called the 'emulsion'), so that
there are three phases. This third group of models is illustrated schematically
in Fig. 11.3(c).
Having decided upon the general physical nature of the phases the model
builder must then decide on the distribution of gas flow between the phases,
on the extent of interphase mass transfer, and on the degree of axial
dispersion in each phase. Since each of these decisions is controversial, the
number of alternative assumptions which can be made is large, and the
number of combinations of assumptions even larger. Table 11.2 outlines the
assumptions upon which models have been based in the critical areas of phase
composition, flow distribution, axial dispersion and interphase mass transfer.
Table 11.3 lists some of the more popular and more recent models, and shows
A.
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
G. Bubble size:
1. Not specifically included.
2. Single representative size for entire bed.
3. Allowed to increase with height.
4. Obtained from separate measurements, correlation, or estimated.
5. Kept as fitting parameter.
Table II.3
Assumptions
A
Authors
(a) Two-phase models:
Shen and Johnstone (1955)
Lewis, Gilliland, and Glass (1959)
May (1959)
Van Deemter 1961
Orcutt, Davidson, and Pigford (1962)
Partridge and Rowe (1966)
Mireur'and Bischoff (1967)
Kato and Wen (1969)
Bywater (1978)
Darton (1979)
Werther (1980)
Grace (19B4)
(b) Three
Kunii and
Fryer and
Fan, Fan,
phase models:
Levenspiel (1969)
Potter (1972a)
and Miyanami (1977)
1
2
1
1
1
3
1
3
1
1
1
2
B
1
2
1
4
1
1
1
2
4
1
1
2
2,1 1 or 2
3
1
2
1
1 1 or 5 3 NA
1 1 or 5 3 NA
1 NA
2
1
1 NA
2
1
1 1 or 5 4 NA
2,4
5
1
1
2
1,3 NA
1
1,3
4
1
1
5
5
1
7
4,5
5
5
1
3 NA
1
1
4,6 NA
1
3
1
1
2
3
6
2
4,5
4,5
4,5
G
1
1
1
1
2,5
4
1
3,4
2,4
3,4
3,4
2,4
1,4 - 2,4
4,5 2,4
2,3 3,4
the assumptions which have been adopted in these models, using the
categories given in Table 11.2. This list of models is far from exhaustive. An
c;:xpandedlisting of pre-1970 models appears in the article by Grace (1971).
Except for assumptions regarding axial dispersion in the dilute phase, where
all models except one assume plug flow, we find that there is no unanimity in
the assumptions adopted by different authors. Even in cases where the same
number appears in a given column in Table 11.3, competing models may
employ different approaches, For example, there are a number of expressions
which may be used to predict interphase mass transfer rates, as discussed in
Section 11.4
Not surprisingly, models whose assumptions differ as radically as those
listed in Table 11.3 can give very different predictions of chemical conversions
and selectivities. For simulation of existing reactors, operated over limited
ranges of variables, it may be possible to use a number of different models,
especially if fitted constants are introduced. On the other hand, for reactor
scale-up or for prediction of reactor performance from first principles, it is
extremely important to choose a suitable model from the many alternatives.
Experimental testing of a number of competing models was carried out by
Model or
Interphase mass
transfer
Solids assigned
bubble phase
10
High
High
None
None
None
Davidson cloud
Low
Murray cloud
Intennediate
Two resistances in
series (one low.
one high)
Davidson cloud
(later include wake)
Little or none
Axial dispersion
in dense phase
Two-phase theory
Two-pbase theory
(U-Um,)A
+ gas
carried in clouds
(U-Um,)A
+ gas
carried in clouds
All
None
Perfect mixing
None
All
None
Well-mixed units
in series
None
In Sections 11.7 and 11.8 we consider only gas phase solid catalysed
reactions. Application of these models to gas-solid heterogeneous reactions is
treated in Section 11.12 below.
11.7
Substitution of this expression into Eq. (11.13) gives an equation for CAd
which can be solved for certain specific values of the reaction order n. The
final exit concentration of A is then obtained from a mole balance at z = H,
i.e.:
The key assumptions of this model are that no solids are associated with the
bubble phase while gas is assumed to be in plug flow in the bubble phase and
perfectly mixed in the dense phase. We generalize the model somewhat by
letting the fraction of gas which flows through the bubble phase at any height
be {3,and by letting the interphase mass transfer coefficient (volumetric rate
of transfer per unit bubble surface area) be kq. In the model proposed by
Orcutt, Davidson, and Pigford (1962), reproduced by Davidson and Harrison
(1963), the following expressions for {3and kq were assumed:
{3
kq
= 0.75
Umf
U-Umf
= --
U
0.975go.25
(11.10)
q; 0.5
dO.25
(11.11)
Table 11.5 Outlet {;oncentrations derived from generalization of the model proposed
by Orcutt, Davidson. and Pigford (1962) for some simple cases
O-order
irreversible
(rA = ko)
Half-order
irreversible
(rA = ko.5 <:15)
CAou<
~-C
1+
CAin
eq
Other values of the flow distribution parameter {3and of the interphase mass
transfer coefficient kq can be used instead, based on more recent experimental evidence (see Chapter 4 and Section 11.4, respectively).
With the assumption that there are no particles in the bubble phase, the
change in the molar flux of species A at any height in the bubble phase must
be accounted for by interphase transfer, Le.:
{3U dCAb = kq (CAd -
CAb)
(11.12)
ObEbdz
where ab is the interfacial bubble area per unit bubble volume. A mole
balance over the entire dense phase yields:
(l-{3)U(CAin-CAd)
Jff
kq(CAb-CAd)abEbdz=(I-Eb)(1-Emf)HknCA2
(11.13)
where kn is the nth-order rate constant as defined in Eq. (11.1). Here mass
transfer resistance within the dense phase is ignored so that the gas
composition is treated as being the same in the particles and local interstitial
gas. This assumption is valid unless the particles are large or the reaction very
rapid (Bukur, Caram, and Amundson, 1977). The boundary condition on
CAb is CAb = CAin at z = O. CAdis a constant throughout the column for this
model in view of the assumption of perfect gas mixing in the dense phase.
Integration of Eq. (11.12) yields:
CAb = CAd + (CAin-CAd) exp
-kqabfhz
{3U
kb
= 1-
CAin
(k' )2
0.5
1 - f3e-X
First-order
irreversible:
4(1-I3-X)2
1+----
(kfJ.5l
+ I3kie-x
1 - ,Be-x
A-+B
I-V
2(l-,Be-X')
ki
(rA = ktCA)
Second-order
irreversible
(rA = k2Ci
(1-,Be-X?
First-order
reversible:
A~B,
(rA = kt(CA-CBIKe))
Consecutive firstorder: A -+ B -+ C;
no B in feed
kACA;
= kBCB
rA =
rB
1-,Be-x
CAout
---
ki - (ki?/{ki
Ke(I-l3e-X
CAin
CBOUl
kA
-C-.
= l+k' _(.le-X
Am
B ~
(l_,Be-X)2
l-(.lo-X+k'
~
k'
k H '1n
)CAin<,,-J)
mf\
"
Emf
=---
(3U
X can also be thought of as the number of mass transfer units or the number
"",
"
"
"
,,
,
\
11.8
\ '\
""'\
\
\
001
"
\',
,,
"
...
o
~
absence of particles in the bubble phase, gas must be transferred to the dense
phase before reaction can take place. The expressions given in Table 11.5
could be used to construct curves for other values of {3or for reactions of other
orders. Generally speaking, the predictions become more sensitive to the
dimensionless hydrodynamic parameters {3and X with increasing order of
reaction. An example showing the use of this model to estimate chemical
conversions is given below in Example 11.3.
Although this model is useful in discussing the effects of different
parameters and simple enough to lead to a number of analytic results for
conversions and selectivities, as shown in Table 11.5, results are generally
disappointing. The predicted gas concentration profiles are not observed in
practice (Chavarie and Grace, 1975; Fryer and Potter, 1976). Moreover, the
lack of any solids associated with the bubble phase appears to lead to
underestimation of conversion for fast reactions. We turn therefore to a more
realistic two-phase model.
1
K; - k,Hmfrt-cmfJ
U
...
-.,
'- ...._-
-----
Figure 11.4 Outlet concentration for a first-order chemical reaction according 10 the
Orcutt model for f3 = 0.75 and several different values of the interphase mass transfer
group X.
reaction (n = 1) and for a particular value of {3,{3= 0.75, i.e. with 75 per
cent. of the gas passing through the bubble phase. The limiting results for
single-phase plug flow and perfectly mixed reactors, Eqs (11.7) and (11.8),
,respectively, are also shown in the figure as broken lines. As X ~ 00 or as {3
~ 0, the conversion, 1-CAout/CAin, predicted by the two-phase theory
approaches Eq. (11.8), i.e. that of the single-phase perfectly mixed reactor.
For this particular two-phase model, conversions are always less favourable
for finite X than for the perfectly mixed case. For slow reactions (k1 < 0.1),
the outlet concentration is controlled by chemical kinetics and virtually
independent of the hydrodynamics. However, for intermediate and fast
reactions, interphase transfer plays a very significant role, since, in the
TWO-PHASE BUBBliNG
where <!>b is the fraction of the bed volume occupied by bubble phase solids.
For the dense phase, a mole balance on component A gives:
kqahEb(CAd-CAb)
+ kn4>dQ3 =
(11.19)
where 4>dis the fraction of the bed volume occupied by solids assigned to the
dense phase.
These equations can be integrated in a straightforward manner with the
boundary conditions CAb = CAd = CAin at z = 0 for several simple cases. The
results for these cases are given in Table 11.6. For cases where the kinetics or
Table 11.6
Zero-order
irreversible
(rA = ko)
First-order
irreversible:
A --+ B (rA
CAout
ra
kACA;
= kBCB
1 - ~ (4)0 + rPd)
13 = 1; i.e.:
kqab~H
X=--U
where kq should be obtained from Eq. (11.6), while:
6
ab = =deq
The mean bubble
growth correlations
advocated by Fryer
from relationships
dimensionless rate
(11.21)
CAin
= ktCA)
CAout
CAin
= exp { -k~{X(4)o
X
+ rP~) + k~4>orPd
+ k1 rPd
CAout
Caou,
CAir
where FA
= -~--'----"---'-'-~;""::':"-
Let us now consider the variables <!>band 4>d, giving the fraction of bed
volume occupied by solids associated with the bubble and dense phase,
respectively. Kunii and Levenspiel (1969) defined a variable I'b = <!>bleb,
which is the volume fraction of bubbles occupied by dispersed or raining
solids, and cited experimental evidence suggesting that 0.001 ::;:;'Yb ::;:; 0.01.
Hence the lower and upper limits on <!>b
may be taken as:
O.OOleb ~ <!>b~ O.01Eb
(11.23)
The value of o/d can be approximated by including all of the solids in the
clouds, wakes, and emulsion in the dense phase and assuming the dense
phase voidage to be emf' Hence, we may write:
The actual conversion should be bounded between that predicted using the
upper and lower bounds for <!>b
given in Eq. (11.23). For slow reactions the
solids assigned to the bubble phase have little influence and the two limits are
indistinguishable. However, for fast reactions, <!>bplays a significant role.
The limits proposed for <!>b
are conservative in that all cloud and wake solids
are assigned to the dense phase, rather than to the bubble phase. In view of
this fact, the model can also be used for the so-called 'slow bubble' or
cloudless bubble case (a < 1).
The dimensionless outlet concentration for an irreversible first-order
reaction, as predicted by the model for 4>d= 0.4, is plotted in Fig. 11.5. Two
-------- --"
"
X-O1
"(,
,,
,,
gas velocity is 0.50 mls. The molecular diffusivity of the reacting species is 3.3
X 10-5 m2/s. Use both the Orcutt model and the two-phase bubbling bed
model to estimate the conversion if: (a) no baffles are present so that
unrestrained bubble growth occurs and (b) baffles are present limiting the
bubble size to 0.15 m.
Solution
Emf
0.48,k1 =
values of .<!>b, <!>b = 0 and <!>b = 0.005, are chosen to demonstrate the
influence of this variable. Note that <!>b has little effect for slow reactions or
for cases where interphase mass transfer is rapid, but that even a small
fraction of solids in the bubble phase can lead to a significant increase in
conversion for fast reactions and slow mass transfer (high ki and low X). As in
Fig. 11.4, all curves in Fig. 11.5 converge where the reaction becomes
kinetically rate controlled, i.e at small values of the dimensionless rate
constant. Conversion is again seen to depend strongly on interphase mass
transfer for intermediate and fast reactions. In general, the conversion
becomes somewhat more sensitive to the parameters X, cPt" and <Pd as the
order of reaction increases.
The following sample problem illustrates the use of the two-phase bubbling
bed model and of the Orcutt model outlined in the previous section.
The mean bubble diameter, d"q, can be obtained from the Mori and Wen
correlation (see Chapter 4), evaluated at a height of O.4H = 1.04 m above the
distributor. Assuming bubbles form at the distributor with an initial diameter
of 10 mm, we calculate d.,q = 0.300 m. The corresponding value of UA, the
absolute rise velocity of the bubbles, is found using Eq. (4.41):
UA
1.70 mls
0.48
1.70
UA
=0.282
=r6 = 20.0m
-1
eq
f3
U-U f
U rn
0.96
kq
0.0284 mls
O~~~O
]
(3.3
10-5).5 mls
Hence, from Eq. (11.17), the dimensionless mass transfer group is:
0.0284
= --------
CAin
0.96 x 0.50
-66.6
CAout
--=exp
0.867
{0.509(0.00028
= 0.596
Similarly, for 4>r, = 0.00282, we obtain:
e-X
The dimensionless
0.420
Aout
C
=
CAin
0.503
24.9
Case (b) With baffles present
--
CAin
The estimated
0.417
(l-CAoutICAin)
or 58 p~r cent.
_ 0.020
kq 3
{4
= 0.0174
10-5
7T
x 0.300
mls
.mls
0.0174
X
x 3.3
0.50
ki
12.8 x 2.60
0.50
66.6
The fraction of the bed occupied by bubble phase solids is expected to lie in
the range O.OOlEb to 0.01b; therefore:
0.00028 ~ 4>r, ~ 0.00282
while the fraction of the bed occupied by dense phase solids is:
<f>d
(1-0.282)
x (1-0.48)
0.373
The conversion
may now be calculated using the first-order
relationship in Table 11.6. For 4>r, = 0.00028, we calculate:
reaction
We are
before,
For the
and k1
Here we have made allowance for Ep, the internal porosity of the particles,
and have assumed rapid equalization of concentration between the outer
surface and inner volume of particle, usually a good approximation for the
small particles used in fluidized bed processes. Transfer functions have been
derived for the case where f3 = 1 by Heimlich and Gruet (1966) and
Barnstone and Harriott (1967), and good matching between residence time
distribution data and the model were demonstrated for reasonable values of
the dimensionless interphase transfer parameter X for beds of 0.076 and 1.50
m diameter. This technique has been shown to be a possible means of
estimating interphase mass transfer rates by Fontaine and Harriott (1972),
who cycled the mput concentration of different tracer gases.
In terms of the two phase bubbling bed model (Section 11.8), the unsteady
state equations in the absence of chemical reaction are:
"Note that our criticism of the dispersed plug flow model above applied to the case where it is
~sed for .thebed ~s a whole, no~to cases where it is used to describe an individual phase. There
IS some Justification for expectmg small random mixing steps in the dense phase.
312
GAS FLUIDIZATION
TECHNOLOGY
This model has been used in conjunction with a step input change by Yoshida
and Kunii (1968). Solution requires numerical integration.
In principle, either of these models can b~ used for proc~ss cont~ol of
fluidized bed chemical reactors when the reactIOnterms are remserted m the
above equations from Sections 11.7 and 11.8. In practice, simpler control
models are usually adopted for this purpose. .
.
.,
Although the two-phase models provide a good basIs for treatI~g ax~al
dispersion in gas fluidized beds, there are no proven methods for dealIng wI.th
radial dispersion. Experimental measurements are scarce. When radIal
dispersion coefficients have been reported, they tend to be abo~t an.orde~ of
magnitude smaller than values which ~ave .b~en.ascribe~ to axIal dI~persIOn
coefficients. The principal cause of radIal mIXmgm bUb~lIngsystems ISlate~al
motion of bubbles assocated with coalescence of non-alIgned bubbles. SolIds
circulation patterns may also playa significant role. .
..
Both axial and radial mixing can be altered by addmg baffles to flUIdIZed
beds. In general, any baffle which impedes bubble an? solids,motion in a
given direction or which tends to make bUbb~esmore umform will reduce t~e
mixing in that direction. For example, vertIcal tubes tend to red~ce r~~Ial
dispersion, while horizontal screens or perfora~ed plates reduce ~Ial mIXm~
and cause gas residence times to be more umform. For a multI-stage umt
(stages in series), the overall gas flow pattern can be made to approach plug
flow conditions.
{oj
(bJ
(cJ
CAj)
+ kI(l-j)
(l-mf)CAd
=0
(11.30)
where aj is the jet interfacial area per unit bed volume, j is the fraction of
the cross-sectional bed area occupied by jets, and 'Yj is the volume fraction of
the jets occupied by catalyst particles. The final terms must be modified for
non-first-order reactions. Integration of Eqs. (11.29) and (11.30) wit~ the
boundary conditions CAj = CAin at z = 0 yields the following concentration at
the level z = Hj, corresponding to the top of the jet or grid region:
CAHj = CAin exp
Xjki
X
+ ki -
k{ j'Yj
(l-j)(l-mf)
(11.31)
k1(1-Ej)(1-Emf)Hj
U
are analogous to X and kj or k~ in the bubbling bed models above.
Equation (11.31) can be used to estimate the concentration of the reacting
species A at the top of the grid region; the bubbling bed models outlined
earlier in this chapter can then be used to predict reaction rates in the
remainder of the bed. There are, however, several difficulties with these
models. Rowe, MacGillivray, and Cheesman (1979) studied the entry region
above single orifices for beds of fine and intermediate size particles with the
aid of X-ray photography and showed that the region directly above the
orifice is characterized by periodically forming elongated voids rather than
steady jets. This implies that models like that represented by Eqs (11.29) to
(11.31) can only represent the grid region behaviour in a time mean sense.
However, this difficulty is also present, and probably to a greater degree, for
the bubbling bed models.
A more serious problem is the estimation of parameters to use in the
model. There is a lack of data upon which to base most of these variables. Of
the various correlations for jet penetration, Hj (see Chapter 4), that of Merry
(1975) appears to have the soundest basis. To a first approximation, the
average jet diameter can be taken as V2 to 2 x dor where dor is the orifice
diameter. Hence Ejmay be estimated to lie in the range 2 to 4for and Qjin the
range 4 v2fo/dor to 8fo/don where for is the fractional free (orifice) area in
the grid plate. The volume fraction of solids entrained in the jets, 'Yj, is
expected to lie in the range 0.001 to 0.006 (Merry, 1976); except for fast
reactions, these values are generally too low to have an appreciable effect on
conversion. Of greater important is the jet to dense phase interphase mass
transfer coefficient kqj. Behie and Kehoe (1973) based some sample calculations on mass transfer data obtained in a 0.61 diameter column of 60 f.Lm
cracking catalyst (Behie, Bergougnou, and Baker, 1976). The values of kqj
were of order 1 mis, such a high value that the consequences for reactor
modelling were considerable at least for reasonably rapid kinetic rate constants
(Behie and Kehoe, 1973; Grace and deLasa, 1978). However, values of kqj are
very difficult to measure, and other workers (deMichaele, Elia, and Massimilla
1976; Sit, 1981) have inferred or measured transfer coefficients which are lower
by an order of magnitude. The following illustrative problems demonstrates
the importance of the interphase transfer step.
Estimate the conversion in the grid region of a fluidized bed reactor assuming:
(a) kqj = 1.0 mls and (b) kqj = 0.10 mls for a bed of 100 f.Lm catalyst particles of
density 2,000 kg/m3. The superficial gas velocity is 1.0 mls and the gas density is
1.0 kg/m3. The grid is a multi-orifice plate containing 12.7 mm diameter holes
on a square lattice with a hole-to-hole spacing of 0.102 m. The kinetic rate
constant is 12.8 S-l. Assume that Emf= 0.48.
Solution
The fractional free area in the grid is given by:
7T
for =
X (12.7?
X 1022
= 0.01218
U
1.0
= for = 0.01218 mls = 82.1 mls
Hj
= 5.2dor
(pg~or)
Pp
0.3
/1.3 ( U~r)
0.2
1/
gdor
1.0 x 0.0127)
= 5.2 x 0.0127 x ( 2000
x 0.0001
0.3
13
.
82.12
)0.2
9.8 x 0.0127 -1
=0.303 m
Ej :::::(2 to 4) for; take Ej = 3for = 0.0365
Qj :::::(4 V2 to 8)fo/dor; take Qj = 4 v'3 forldor = 6.64 m-1
'Yj =
o.(Xn
x (1-0.48)
1.0
x 0.303
1.0 m/s:
Xj =
1.943
exp
and
0.37
0.10 m/s:
AHj
0.83
CAin
from Eqs (11.32) and (11.31). The final result is insensitive to the choice
of 'Yj and not strongly affected by the choice of aj and Ej for the
conditions under consideration. However, there is a very strong influence
of the interphase mass transfer coefficient (the estimated conversion in
the grid region varying from 63 to 17 per cent. for a tenfold variation in
kqj). Note that these conversions can be appreciable with respect to those
in a much deeper bubbling bed (cf. Example 11.3).
The type of mass transfer envisaged in the model outlined above is probably
dominant only for relatively fine particles (for example dp < 200 /Lm). For
coarse particles (e.g. > 1 mm), the grid region, at least for upward facing
horizontal orifices, may resemble a series of parallel spouted beds (Mathur
and Epstein, 1974). The primary mass transfer is then via the bulk outflow of
gas, as predicted by Mamuro and Hattori (1968). Models and experimental
results for a catalytic first-order reaction in isothermal spouted beds are given
by Piccinini, Grace, and Mathur (1979) and Rovero et al. (1983).
Considerable work remains to be performed before reaction in the grid
region can be predicted with confidence. Even for the simplest grid geometry
of a multi-orifice plate, there is a need for definitive interphase mass transfer
results and reliable parameter estimation methods, and there is little to go on
for intermediate sizeparticles. For more complex grid geometries, that
reaction can be rapid in the grid region and that minor changes in grid
character can have significant effects (Cooke et al., 1968; Walker 1970;
Hovmand, Freedman, and Davidson, 1971; Chavarie and Grace, 1975;Bauer
and Werther, 1981).
diffuse to the front. In most cases one of steps (b), (c), or (d) may be assumed
to be rate controlling, i.e. to provide the bottleneck which determines the
overall rate of reaction. When the chemical reaction step controls, it can be
shown (e.g. Levenspiel, 1972) that the time required for complete conversion
of a spherical particle under isothermal conditions exposed at time 0 to a gas
concentration C:'" is:
tcr
PBdp
=.
(11.35)
2bkls CAMa
Here the reaction is assumed to be first order, kls being the reaction rate
constant based on the unit surface area of unreacted core; i.e.:
rA
=-
1
4~e
dNA
--;:it = k1sCA
l/k
1s
+ dpl12qj)s
(11.37)
where !:i's is the effective diffusivity of the gas through the porous solid. For
particles which shrink as the reaction proceeds so that the reaction front is
always at the exterior surface, then:
kef
1
l/k1s
+ l/kd
where kd is the mass transfer coefficient between the particle outer surface
and the bulk gas surrounding the particle.
SC,CR
3:8,C,
General
SC
2:8 and D
and
Penetration + leakage of
circulating gas
As Davidson
Coal combustion
Roasting of ZnS: allow for particles in
bubbles; compare with experimenfs
and Harrison
(1963)
I1Jd,;'l
~~~~a~~~~:~~
~a~~:a":ta(~71)
As Kunii and levenspiel
b
C
CR
(1969)
Dispersion
model
(lateral)
2:B and 0
= continuous reaction modeli Diff . control by diffusion through. ash layer; SC = shrinking core model; 0 = order. rxs = reactions.
various
11Id"
II
consider
cases
I lid,.
As Hovmand, Freedman.
Davidson (1911)
1st or Oth
order with
respect to
solid
model;
limiting
and E
allowance:
= entrainment
\)
II
~
0Il
If
~~I
....
:..: I
+\:i,)
rol
'-""
= 2.96
13
x 10. exp
-3.14 x 1<r }
RT
0.21P
CAin = ~
UA
= 0.71
ab
=--
x 0.10) + 0.78-0.0048
\/(9.8
0.10
m/s
1.479 m/s
60 m-1
0.78-0.0048
1.479
assume
Eb =
0.40.
We expect the solids in the bed to be highly reacted. Hence their density
will be:
Ps
4,100 x 0.0814
3
0.0975
kg/m
rn/s
The effective diffusivity of O2 and S02 through the solid ash may be taken as
9.0 X 10-6 m2/s. The density of the concentrate is 4,100 kg/m3. Estimate the
conversion of both gas and solids assuming that the bed operates entirely in
the bubble regime with a mean bubble diameter of 0.10 m.
Hmf
30,000
3,420 x ('lT14) X 6.382 x 0.5 m
0.548
1-0.40
0.548 m
0.915 m
2.48 x 0.0814
0.0975
kg/s
Solution
We assume Emf = 0.50 and estimate a molecular diffusivity of oxygen in air
at 1,233 K of 2.5 x 10-4 m2/s. The reaction may be written in the form of Eq.
(11.34) as:
02(g)
so that b = 2/3. The molecular weights of ZnS and ZnO are 0.0975 and 0.0814
kg/mol, respectively.
30,000
2.07
14,500 s
At 1,233 K:
k1s
= 2.96
13
x 10
exp
-3.14 x 1<r)
8.314 x 1,233
rn/s
kq
= 0.3
x 0.0048
1/2
{3
1 - 0.0048
0.78
(11.30); 4Jt,and 4Jdare estimated as outlined in Section 11.8. For step 4, the
gas conversion XA is now found as a function of k~ from Table 11.6. The
mean concentration of gas to which the solids are exposed CA, to be
calculated in step 5, is found by integration. For a first-order irreversible
reaction, it can be shown that:
0.994
1.415
C~
4Jt,C + 4JdCAd
CAinXA
= ----4Jt,+ 4Jd
(4Jt,+ 4Jd)k ~
= -----~.Ab
X A = 1 - exp
0.758 + ki
_ 2.075 x 0.758
3
CAd- 0.758 + ki mol/m
ef
tcr
2x
2f3
x 0.809
tcr
XB
= 0.809 mls
2.34
=--
O.0975CAd CAd
ter
= 1 - 4 x 14,500 = 1 - 58,000
The model developed above and the example are for the case of uniform
solids of unchanging particle size. In most fluidized bed processes, particles
fed to the bed have a wide distribution of sizes, and fines are elutriated from
the bed. To take these factors into account for particles of unchanging size,
we make the following changes in the procedures given above for calculating
the solids conversion:
1. The feed particle size distribution is represented by N size fractions of
representive size dpi and mass fraction Xi (generally determined by sieve
analysis).
2. Calculate the time for complete reaction of each size fraction (ter)i from
Eq. (11.35) or another appropriate kinetic model with dp replaced by dpi'
3. Determine the mean residence time of particles in this size range from the
equation:
M
0.758k1
= 0.0975 2/3
= munder+ (1-1/i)
XB
0.737XB
After trial and error, ki = 26; CAd = 0.0588 mollm3; tcr = 39.8s; XA =
0.737; XB = 0.9993,
Hence the solids are more than 99.9 per cent. converted while the oxygen
is nearly 74 per cent. converted according to the model.
To replace the Orcutt model by the two-phase bubbling bed reactor model
(outlined in Section 11.8 for a gas phase reaction), the steps are essentially the
same. However, in step 3, {3is set equal to unity; X is calculated from Eq.
K~A
1 -"
"
(Ie,)'
(1 - XBi)E(dpj, t)dt
(11.46)
where XBi> the conversion of particles of size dpi for a residence time t, is
obtained from standard kinetic models and the exit age distribution is
generally assumed to correspond to perfect mixing of each particle size
fraction so that:
E(dpi,t)
exp{ -(tIT;)}
= -----
T;
Hence, for example, the shrinking core model with chemical reaction
control XBi is given by Eq. (11.41) with T and tcr replaced by and (tcr);,
respectively.
5. Finally, to calculate the overall conversion, we must sum over the different
size fractions fed to the bed:
Tj
It is possible to extend the above procedure to cover more complex cases, e.g.
multi-stage beds, beds in series, or other cases where the solids residence time
distribution does not correspond to perfect mixing. For particles which shrink
or grow as a result of chemical reaction, attrition, or agglomeration,
population balances are required to account for the different size fractions. A
number of these cases have been considered by Kunii and Levenspiel (1969)
and in the models listed in Table 11.7.
As demonstrated by the models outlined above, modelling of the
disappearence of gaseous reactants follows the same general lines as twophase modelling of catalytic gas phase reactions. However, it is common for
the gaseous reagents (e.g. oxygen in the case of coal combustion) to be
present well in excess of the stoichiometric requirements. In this case, the
residence time distribution of the solids, including losses by elutriation, plays
a critical role in determining the overall conversion of solids. Where high
conversions of solids are required, it is often desirable to place two or more
units in series and to provide better solids recovery than is possible with a
single cyclone.
The freeboard region can playa significant role in determining the overall
performance of fluidized bed reactors. For example, nitric oxide levels in coal
combustors change rapidly in the freeboard region (Gibbs, Perlira, and Beer,
1975), while the temperature level, coke conversion, and afterburning in
cracking catalyst regenerators depend strongly on the freeboard (deLasa and
Grace, 1979).
The contribution of the freeboard arises from the following considerations:
(a) Additional contacting of gas and solids can take place in the freeboard
region. Although the hydrodynamics of the region are not well
understood, contacting appears to be favourable, with little or no
tendency of the gas to separate into two phases (as in the bubbling bed)
and near plug flow for the gas. This effective contacting and lack of
backmixing, coupled with the fact that entrained particles tend to be finer
than those in the bed, make up to some extent for the low hold-up of
solids in the region above the dense bed surface.
(b) Whereas temperatures tend to be highly uniform in the dense bed,
significant temperature gradients are possible in the freeboard region.
This may lead to increased reaction rates, unwanted side reactions, or
recycling of additional heat to the bed itself as solids return from cyclones
or by gravity.
(c) Where heat transfer surfaces extend into the freeboard region, additional
heat transfer occurs. Heat transfer coefficients are nearly as favourable
near the bed surface as for immersed tubes, but the coefficients fall off
rapidly with increasing height. Radiation losses from particles in the
freeboard can also be substantial.
The contribution of the freeboard region will depend on a number of factors:
(a) The extent of reaction which has already occurred in the dense bed. (It is
evident that if a reactant has already been used up before reaching the
bed surface, no further reaction involving consumption of that reactant
can take place in the freebaord.)
(b) The height and geometry of the freeboard region, including expanded
areas and fixed baffles or tubes, if any.
(c) The fines content of the powder.
(d) The efficiency of the cyclone or other solid recovery system in returning
entrained fines to the bed where they can be reentrained.
(e) The operating conditions, principally the superficial gas velocity,
pressure, and temperature.
To a lesser extent, reaction in the freeboard may also depend on the depth of
the dense bed and the presence of immersed tubes through their influence on
the bursting pattern of voids at the bed surface and hence on the ejection of
solids into the freeboard.
The freeboard itself may be divided into different regions, as shown in Fig.
11.7:
(a) Splash zone: this is immediately above the dense bed surface.
(b) Disengagement zone: This extends up to transport disengaging height
level; it may be taken to include the splash zone since there is no distinct
boundary between the splash zone and the disengagement zone.
(c) Region beyond TDH. In regions (a) and (b), particles travel both
upwards and downwards, amid periodic bursts (or splashes) of particles.
In zone (a), on the other hand, particle motion is almost solely upwards
first order gas phase solid catalysed reaction, their model leads to the
following expression:
CAz
CAH
/-gf3W(QB/A)
--=exp
(I-Emf) (z-H)
+ dpl6kd)
V(V-lit) (1Ik[
where f3w is the wake volume/bubble volume for bubbles reaching the bed
surface. The volumetric flux of bubbles, QB/A, can be estimated as detailed in
Chapter 4, while g, the fraction of wake particles ejected into the freeboard
as bubbles burst at the bed surface, varies with deq, but is typically of order
0.4 (George and Grace, 1978). The mass transfer coefficient kd can be
obtained for steady flow of gas past the particle at a relative velocity of VI as
detailed by Clift, Grace, and Weber (1978). Sample calculations performed
by Yates and Rowe (1977) show that the freeboard region can be more
effective than an equal height of dense bed.
Example 11.6
Narrow size fraction 60 ILm spherical catalyst particles are being used in a
fluidized bed reactor. The particle density is 2,650 kg/m3 and the catalyst
activity is 10.0 s-\ the reaction being first order. The fluidizing gas has the
properties of air at 20C and 101kPa. The molecular diffusivity of the reacting
gas in air is 2.0 x 10-5 m2/s. Estimate the fraction of the gas leaving the
expanded bed surface which is converted in the freeboard region if the total
height of this region is 4.0 m. The superficial gas velocity is 1.0 mls. Assume
isothermal behaviour.
.
Solution
From Clift, Grace, and Weber (1978), Vt = 0.26 mls and kd = 0.73 mls.
Estimates for Vmfand Emf are 0.004 m/s and 0.50, respectively. From George
and Grace (1978), we estimate g = 0.4. A reasonable estimate for f3w is
0.33. The visible bubble flowrate may, to a first approximation, be estimated
from the two-phase theory so that:
QB
11
=
Hence, Eq. (11.49) yields:
CAz
CAH = exp
= 0.029
Hence, the model indicates that only about 3 per cent. of the gas which is
unconverted leaving the surface of the dense bed is still unconverted at the
top of the freeboard region. This illustrates the prominent influence which the
freeboard can exert.
Generally speaking, it is necessary to allow for temperature gradients in the
freeboard region by writing a differential energy balance. For plug flow of
gas, this may be written:
dT
CgPg dz
hP(T-Tw)
VA
dXA
+ !i.HrCAin & =
where the particles and gas in the freeboard are assumed to have the same
temperature
T locally (usually a reasonable approximation), while h is the
freeboard suspension-to-wall heat transfer coefficient, P the column perimeter, Tw the column wall temperature, and !i.Hr the heat of reaction. The
middle term can be neglected for well-insulated systems. Allowance may be
made for radiation losses or cooling tubes in the freeboard by incorporating
extra terms.
Miyauchi and Furusaki (1974) used an equation like Eq. (11.50) to show
the effect of the freeboard on selectivity. The freeboard could be beneficial or
harmful to the yield of a desired product, depending on the mechanism of
reaction and whether the reaction is exothermic or endothermic. For
example, for reactions of the type A _ B _ C where B is the desired product,
the freeboard region is helpful for endothermic reactions, but not for
exothermic reactions.
DeLasa and Grace (1979) treated the freeboard region of a gas-solid
heterogeneous
reaction, the burning of coke deposits from deactivated
cracking catalyst particles in a regenerator. Separate allowance was made for
upward and downward moving solids. Material balances were written for
both the solid reactant (coke) and the gaseous reactant (oxygen); energy
balances were used in addition. The hydrodynamics of particle ejection and
trajectories in the freeboard were taken from George and Grace (1978).
Numerical integration was required to solve the equations for different
monodisperse
particle sizes and conditions matching those in an actual
industrial regenerator. The freeboard was shown to have a profound effect for
shallow beds, especially for particles whose terminal velocities are close to the
superficial gas velocity. The model has been extended to describe non-steady
state conditions by deLasa and Errazu (1980).
Chen and Wen (1982) modified the above approach by assuming axial
dispersion of gas in the freeboard region and by assuming an exponential
decay of solids concentration above the bed surface. The model was shown to
be in favourable agreement with experimental results obtained in a 1.8 m
square fluidized combustor. Fee et ai. (1982) considered the part of the
freeboard in which particles are ejected and fall back to the bed surface as a
continuously stirred tank reactor. Significant sulphur capture was shown to
occur in the freeboard of a fluidized bed combustor.
11.14
Two phase models similar to those described earlier for the bubbling regime
have also been written for fluidized beds operating in the slug flow regime.
The best known slug flow reactor models are those of Hovmand et al (1971)
and Raghuraman and Potter (1978). Yates and Gregoire (1980) found that
the latter gave better agreement with experimental conversions obtained in a
0.10 m column. It is essential to allow for favourable gas-solid contacting in
the region below the level where slug flow is reached (typically z=2D) in
applying slug flow reactor models.
11.15
REm~
11.16
REGIME
There has been considerable interest in recent years in circulating beds and in
riser reactors for both gas-solid reactions and solid catalysed reactions.
Operation within the fast fluidization regime (see Chapter 7) confers a
number of advantages including effective gas-solid contacting, increased gas
throughput,
ability to treat cohesive and low density materials (e.g.
peat,wood waste, caking coals), good radial mixing, improved turndown,
temperature
uniformity throughout the entire reactor volume, and (for
co~b.usti()n reactions) reduced NOx emissions. because of secondary air
addltlons. Erosion, attrition and particulate emissions can all be controlled
within reasonable limits by good design.
Wen (1979) suggested tentatively that a single-phase plug flow model
(sectio~ 11.5) mi~ht be appropriate for this regime in view of the effective
gas-solId contactmg. On the other hand, there is strong evidence of phase
segregation into either a Core of dilute phase moving upwards at high velocity
surrounded by a thin annular region of predominantly downward dense
part~cle motion (Bieri, Gajdos, and McIver 1980) or of the occurrence of
partIcle clusters (Yerushalmi, Cankurt, Geldart, and Liss, 1978). In either
case, there may well be a need for a two-phase model. The two-region model
of Van D~emter (1961), which allows for a dilute upflow and a dense region,
may provide a good basis for such models. However, additional work on the
hydrodynamics of the fast fluidization regime and reaction studies on beds
operated within this regime are required to allow the parameters needed for
the ~odel to be specified. Energy balances can be incorporated when
r~qUlre?, as for other regimes. For modelling of gas-solid reactions in
cIrculating beds, it would appear to be appropriate to assume that the solids
are perfectly mixed.
C/'
flis
E(dpj, t)
for
FA ,Fa
Fin
g
G
h
H
Hj
Hmf
k{
kls
column diameter
molecular diffusivity of component in gas stream
effective diffusivity of gaseous component through porous solid
exit age distribution function
fractional free area in the grid
functions defined in Table 11.6
solids mass feedrate
acceleration of gravity
function defined in Table 11.6
bed-to-wall or suspension-to-wall heat transfer coefficient
bed height
height of jet penetration
bed height at minimum fluidization
dimensionless first-order rate constant defined in Eq. (11.33)
first-order reaction rate constant based on unit surface area as
defined by Eq. (11.36)
first-order rate constants for disappearance
in Table 11.5
11.16
ab
aj
A
b
CA,Ca
C~
CAb,Cb
CAd, Cd
CAN
CAin, Cin
CAj
CAout
NOMENCLATURE
Cg
deq
dor
dp
kn
k~, k~
kq
kqj
Ke
K*
MB
n
bubble diameter
of A and B, defined
NA
p
QB
334
8.314 J/mol K
gas constant
time
time for complete reaction of a solid particle
absolute temperature
wall temperature
U
Umf
velocity of a particle
particles
transfer units (Eq. 11.7 or Eq. 11.20)
transfer units in grid region (Eq. 11.32)
/;J.Hr
Eb
Ej
Emf
Ep
T/
PB
Anwer, J., and, Pyle, D.L. (1974). 'Gas motion around bubbles in fluidized beds. La
Fluidization et ses Applications, Soc. Chim. Ind .. Paris. pp. 240-253.
Avedesian, M.M. (1974). 'Roasting zinc concentrate in fluidized beds - practice and
principles', 24th CSChE Meeting, Ottawa.
Avedesian, M.M., and Davidson, J.F. (1973). 'Combustion of carbon particles in a
fluidized bed', Trans. lnstn Chem. Engrs, .51, 121-131.
Avidan, A. (1982). 'Turbulent fluid bed reactors using fine powder catalyst,
AIChE-CIESC Mtd., Beijing, Sept.
Bamstone, L.A., and Harriott, P., (1967), Frequency response of gas mixing in a
fluidized bed reactor, AIChE J. 13,465-475.
Baron, R.E., Hodges, J.L., and Sarofim, AF. (1978). Mathematical model for
predicting efficiency of fluidized bed steam generators', AI.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 74
(176), 120-125.
Basu, P., Broughton, J., and Elliott, D.E. (1975). 'Combustion of single coal particles
in fluidized beds', inst. Fuel Symp. Ser., A3 (1), 1-10.
Bauer, E., and Werther, J. (1981). 'Scale-up of fluid bed reactors with respect to size
and gas distributor design - measurements and model calculations', Proc. 2nd
World Congress of Chem. Engng. 3,69-72.
Becker, H.A., Beer, J.M., and Gibbs, B.M. (1975). 'A model for fluidized bed
combustion of coal', Inst. Fuel Symp. Ser., Al(I).
Behie, L.A., Bergougnou, M.A., and Baker, C.G.J. (1976). 'Mass transfer from a
grid jet in a large gas-fluidized bed', in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L.
Keairns), Vol. 1, Hemisphere, Washington, pp. 261-278.
Behie, L.A, and Kehoe, P. (1973). 'The grid region in a fluidized bed reactor',
A.I.Ch.E. J., 19, 1070-1072.
Bieri, T.W. Gajdos, L.J., McIver, A.E., and McGovern, J.J. (1980). DOE Rep. FE2449-11.
Bukur, D., Caram, H.S., and Amundson, N.R. (1977). 'Some model studies of
fluidized bed reactors', in Chemical Reactor Theory: A Review, (Ed. L. Lapidus
and N.R. Admundson), Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs, NJ, pp. 686-757.
Bywater. R.J. (1978). 'Fluidized bed catalytic reactor according to a statistical fluid
mechanic model', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 74 (176),126-133.
Carberry, J.J. (1964). 'Designing laboratory catalytic reactors', Ind. Engng. Chem., S6
(11), 39-46.
Carberry, J.J. (1976). Chemical and Catalytic Reaction Engineering, McGraw-Hill,
New York.
Chang, C.C., Rong, S.X., and Fan, L.T. (1982). 'Modelling of shallow fluidized bed
reactors', Can. J. Chem. Eng., 60, 781-790.
Chavarie, C., and Grace, J.R. (1975). 'Performance analysis of a fluidized bed
reactor' ,Ind. Eng. Chern. Fund., 14,75-91.
Chavarie, c., and Grace, J.R. (1976). 'Interphase mass transfer in a gas-fluidized
bed', Chem. Eng. Sci., 31, 741-749.
Chen, L.H., and Wen, C.Y. (1982). 'Model of solid gas reaction phenomena in the
fluidized bed freeboard'. A.l.Ch.E.J., 28, 1019-1027.
Chen, T.P., and Saxena, S.c. (1977). 'Mathematical modelling of coal combustion in
fluidized beds with sulphur emission control by limestone and dolomite', Fuel, 56,
401-413.
Clift, R., Grace, J.R., and Weber, M.E. (1978). Bubbles, Drops and Particles,
Academic Press, New York.
Cooke, MJ., Harris, W., Highley, J., and Williams, D.F. (1968). 'Kinetics of oxygen
consumption in fluidized bed carbonizers', Inst, Chem. Engrs Symp. Ser., 30,
21-27.
.
Darton, R.c. (1979). 'A bubble growth theory of fluidized bed reactors', Trans. lnstn
Chern. Engrs, 57, 134-138.
Davidson, J.F., and Harrison, D. (1963). Fluidized Particles, Cambridge University
Press, Cambridge.
deLasa, H.I., and Errazu, A. (1980). In Fluidization, Eds. J.R. Grace and J.M.
Matsen, Plenum, New York, pp. 563-570.
deLasa, H.I., and Grace, J.R. (1979). 'The influence of the freeboard region in a
fluidized bed catalytic cracking regenerator', Al.Ch.. J., 25, 984-991.
deMichaele, G., Elia, A., and Massimilla, L. (1976). 'The interaction between jets
and fluidized beds', Ing. Chirn. Ita!., 12, 155-162.
Errazu, A.F., deLasa, H.I., and Sarti, F. (1979). 'A fluidized bed catalytic cracking
regenerator model: grid effects', Can. J. Chern. Eng., 57, 191-197.
Fan, L.T., Fan, L.S., and Miyanami, K. (1977). 'Reactant dynamics of catalytic
fluidized bed reactors characterized by a transient axial dispersion model with
varying physical quantities', Proc. Pachec Conference, pp. 1379-1388.
Fee, D.C., Myles, K.M., Marroquin, G., and Fan L-S., (1982). 'An analytical model
for freeboard and in-bed limestone sulfation in fluidized-bed coal combustors',
Proc. 7th Int. Fluidized Bed Combustion Conference, 1121-1126.
Fontaine, R.W., and Harriott, P. (1972). 'The effect of molecular diffusivityon mixing
in fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 27,2189-2197.
Fryer, C., and Potter, O.E. (1972a). 'Countercurrent backmixing model for fluidized
bed catalytic reactors; applicability of simplified solutions', Ind. Eng. Chem.
Fund., 11,338-344.
Fryer, C., and Potter, O.E. (1972b). 'Bubble size variation in two-phase models of
fluidized bed reactors', Powder Techno!., 6,317-322.
Fryer, C., and Potter, O.E. (1976), 'Experimental investigation of models for
fluidized bed catalytic reactors', A.l.Ch.E. J. 22,38-47.
Fukunda, Y., Monta, T., Asaki, Z., and Kondo, Y. (1976). 'Oxidation of zinc
sulphide in a fluidized bed', Meta!. Trans., 7B, 307-314.
George, S.E., and Grace J.R. (1978). 'Entrainment of particles from aggregative
fluidized beds, A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 74 (176), 67-74.
Gibbs, B.M. (1975). A mechanistic model for predicting the performance of a
fluidized bed coal combustor, Inst.Fuel Symp. Ser., (1) A5.
Gibbs, B.M., Pereira, F.J., and Beer, J.M. (1975). 'Coal combustion and NO
formation in an experimental fluidized bed', Inst. Fuel Syrnp. Ser., (1) D6.
Gordon, A.L., and Amundson, N.R. (1976). 'Modeling of fluidized bed reactors:
combustion of carbon particles', Chern. Eng. Sci., 31, 1163-1178.
Grace, J.R. (1971). 'An evaluation of models for fluidized bed reactors', Al.Ch.E.
Symp. Ser., 67 (116), 159-167.
Grace, J.R. (1984). 'Generalized models for isothermal fluidized bed reactors', in
Recent Advances in the Engineering Analysis of Chernically Reacting Systems (Ed.
L.K. Doraiswamy), Wiley, New Delhi.
Grace, J.R., and deLasa, H.I. (1978). Reaction near the grid in fluidized beds
A.I.Ch.E. J., 24,364-366.
Heimlich, B.N., and Gruet, I.C. (1966). 'Transfer function analysis of fluidized bed
residence time distribution data', Chern. Eng. Prog. Symp. Ser., 62 (67), 28-34.
Horio, M., and Wen, c.Y. (1976). 'Analysis of fluidized-bed combustion of coal with
limestone injection', in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Keaims), Vol. 2,
Hemisphere, Washington, pp. 289-320.
Horio, M., and Wen, C.Y. (1978). 'Simulation of fluidized bed combustors:
Combustion efficiency and temperature profile', A.I. Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 74 (176),
101-11I.
Hovmand, S., and Davidson, J .F. (1971). 'Pilot plant and laboratory scale fluidized
reactors at high gas velocities; the relevance of slug flow', Chapter 5 in Fluidization
(Eds J.F. Davidson and D. Harrison), Academic Press, London, pp. 193-259.
Hovmand, S., Freedman, W., and Davidson, J.F. (1971). 'Chemical reaction in a
pilot-scale fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 49, 149-162.
Jackson, R. (1971). 'Fluid mechanical theory', Chapter 3 in Fluidization (Eds. J.F.
Davidson and D. Harrison, Academic Press, London.
Kato, K., and Wen, C.Y. (1969). 'Bubble assemblage model for fluidized bed catalytic
reactors', Chern. Eng. Sci., 24, 1351-1369.
Kunii, D., and Levenspiel, O. (1969). Fluidization Engineering, Wiley, New York.
Latham, R., Hamilton, c., and Potter, O.E. (1968). 'Backmixing and chemical
reaction in fluidized beds', Brit. Chem. Eng., 13, 66fHJ71.
Levenspiel, O. (1972). ChemicalReaction Engineering, 2nd ed., Wiley, New York.
Lewis, W.K., Gilliland, E.R., and Glass, W. (1959). 'Solid catalysed reaction in a
fluidized bed', A.I.Ch.E. J., 5,419-426.
Lignola. P.G., Donsi, G., and Massimilla, L. (1983). 'Mass spectrometric measurements of gas composition profiles associated with bubbles in a two-dimensional
bed', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 79 (222),19-26.
Mamuro, T., and Hattori, H. (1968). Flow pattern of fluid in spouted beds, J. Chem.
Engng Japan, 1, 1-5.
Mathur, K.B., and Epstein, N. (1974). Spouted Beds, Academic Press, New York.
May, W.G. (1959). 'Fluidized-bed reactor studies', Chem. Engng. Prog., 55 (12),
49-56.
Merry, J.M.D. (1975). 'Penetration of vertical gas jets into fluidized beds', A.I.Ch.E.
J., 21, 507-510.
.Merry, J.M.D. (1976). 'Fluid and particle entrainment into vertical jets in fluidized
beds', AI.Ch.E. J., 22,315-323.
Mireur, J.f., and Bischoff, K.B. (1967). 'Mixing and contacting models for fluidized
beds', A.I.Ch.E.J., 13,839-845.
Miyauchi, T., and Furusaki, S. (1974). 'Relative contribution of variables affecting the
reaction in fluid bed contactors', AI.Ch.E. J., 20, 1087-1096.
Mori, S., and Wen, C.Y. (1976). 'Simulation of fluidized bed reactor performance by
modified bubble assemblage model', in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L.
Keaims), Vol. 1, Hemisphere, Washington, pp. 179-203.
Murray, J.D. (1%5). 'On the mathematics of fluidization', J. Fluid Mech., 21,.
465-493, and 22, 57-80.
Orcutt, J.C., Davidson, J.F., and Pigford, R.L. (1962). 'Reaction time distributions in
fluidized catalytic reactors', Chern. Eng. Prog, Syrnp. Ser., 58 (38),1-15.
Partridge, B.A., and Rowe, P.N. (1966). 'Chemical reaction in a bubbling gas
fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 44, 335-348.
Pereira, LA.F. (1977). Ph.D. Thesis, University of Edinburgh.
Piccinini, N., Grace, J.R., and Mathur, K.B. (1979). 'Vapour-phase chemical reaction
in spouted beds: verification of theory'. Chem. Eng. Sci., 34, 1257-1263.
Pyle, D.L., and Rose, P.L. (1965). 'Chemical reaction in bubbling fluidized beds',
Chem. Eng. Sci., 20,25-31.
Raghuraman, J., and Potter, a.E. (1978), Countercurrent backmixing model for
slugging fluidized bed reactors, A.l. Ch.E. J., 24, 698-704.
Rajan, R., Krishnan, R., and Wen, C.Y. (1978). 'Simultation of fluidized bed
combustors: coal devolatilization and sulphur oxides retention', A. I. Ch.E. Symp.
Ser., 74 (176), 112-119.
Rovero, G., Piccinini, N., Grace, J.R., Epstein, N., and Brereton, C.M.H. (1983).
'Gas phase solid-catalysed chemical reaction in spouted beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 38,
557-566.
Rowe, P.N. (1964). 'Gas-solid reaction in a fluidized bed', Chem. Eng. Prog., 60 (3),
75-80.
Rowe, P.N., MacGillivray, H.J., and Cheesman, D.J. (1979). 'Gas discharge from an
orifice into a gas fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chem. Engrs, 57, 194-199.
Rowe, P.N., Partridge, B.A., and Lyall, E. (1964). 'Cloud formation around bubbles
in fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 19,973-985.
Shaw, I., Hoffman, T.W., and Reilly, P.M. (1974). 'An experimental evaluation of
two-phase models describing catalytic fluidized bed reactors', A.I. Ch.E. Syrnp.
Ser., 70 (141), 41-52.
.
Shen, C.Y., and Johnstone, H.F. (1955). 'Gas-solid contact in fluidized beds',
A.I.Ch.E. J., 1,349-354.
Sit, S.P. (1981). Grid region and coalescence zone gas exchange in fluidized beds',
Ph.D. Dissertation, McGill University.
'Sit, S.P., and Grace, J.R. (1978). 'Interphase mass transfer in an aggregative fluidized
bed', Chem. Eng. Sci., 33, 1115-1122.
Sit, S.P., and Grace, J.R. 1981. 'Effect of bubble interaction on interphase mass
transfer in gas fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 36, 327-335.
Smith, J.M. (1970. Chemical Engineering Kinetics, 2nd ed., McGraw-Hill, New York.
Tajbl, D.G., Simons, J.B., and Carberry, J.J. (1966). 'Heterogeneous catalysis in a
continuous stirred tank reactor', Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., S, 171-175.
Toei, R., Matsuno, R., Nishitani, K., Hayashi, H., and Imamoto, T. (1969). 'Gas
interchange between bubble phase and continuous phase in gas-solid fluidized beds
at coalescence', Kagaku Kogaku, 33, 668-674.
Van Deemter, J.J. (1961). 'Mixing and contacting in gas-solid fluidized beds', Chem.
Eng. Sci., 13, 143-154.
Van Deemter, J.J. (1980). 'Mixing patterns in large-scalefluidized bed, in Fluidization
(Eds LR. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New York, pp. 69-89.
Van Swaaij, W.P.M. (1978). 'The design of gas-solids fluid bed and related reactors',
A.C.S. Symp. Ser (Eds. D. Luss and V.W. Weekman), 72,193-222.
Walker, B.V. (1970). 'Gas-solid contacting in bubbling fluidized bed', Ph.D.
Dissertation, Cambridge University.
Walker, B .V. (1975). 'The effective rate of gas exchange in a bubbling fluidized bed',
Trans. lnstn Chem. Engrs, 53, 225-266.
Wen, C.Y. (1968). 'Noncatalytic heterogeneous solid fluid reaction models', Ind Eng.
Chern., 60,34-54.
W~n, C.Y. (1979). 'Chemical reaction in fluidized beds', in Proc. N.S.F. Workshop on
Fluidization and Fluid-Particle Systems (Ed. H. Littman), Rensselaer Polytechnic
Inst., pp. 317-387.
.
Wen, c.Y., and Fan, L.T. (1975). Models for Flow System~ and Chemical Reactors,
Marcel Dekker, New York.
Werther, J. (1980), 'Mathematical modeling of fluidized bed reactors', Int. Chern.
Eng., 20, 529-541.
Yates, J.G., and Gregoire, J.Y. (1980), 'An experimental test of slugging-bed reactor
models', In Fluidization, eds. J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen, Plenum, New York,
pp. 581-588.
Yates, J.G., and Rowe, P.N. (1977). 'A model for chemical reaction in the freeboard
region above a fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 55, 137-142.
Yerushalmi, J., Cankurt, N.T., Geldart, D., and Liss, R., (1978). 'Flow regimes in
vertical gas-solid contact systems', A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 74 (176),1-13.
Yoshida, K., and Kunii, D. (1968). 'Stimulus and response of gas concentration in
bubbling fluidized beds', J. Chem. Eng. Japan, 1, 11-16.
Yoshida, K., and Wen, c.y. (1970). 'Noncatalytic solid-gas reaction in a fluidized bed
reactor', Chem. Eng. Sci., 25, 1395-1404.
FRICTIONAL
RESISTANCE
PREDOMINATES
SLPERFICIAL VELOCITY, U
Figure 12.1 Phase diagram for dilute phase vertical pneumatic conveying.
> 140
(12.1)
Yang (1976a) extended this concept further and developed the following
criterion for choking:
vf
no choking
choking occurs
This criterion (which is based on the maximum stable bubble size theory of
Davidson and Harrison, 1963) predicts that light and small materials are less
likely to choke, and takes into account the diameter of the line being
employed.
A third criterion for choking was proposed by Smith (1978):
Vt
f!"'-I n (1 - e)
05
(gD) .
>0.41
Leung (1980) considered these three choking criteria and concluded that
Yang's criterion was most useful since it contained the important parameter
of pipe size and was most consistent with the experimental data.
The concept that not all materials will choke is also supported by the work
of Canning and Thompson (1980). They found that large diameter particles
invariably formed slugs in vertical (and horizontal) pneumatic conveying,
while finer solids did not tend to slug.
The 'fast fluidized bed' (see Chapter 7) researched extensively by workers
at the City College of New York (Yerushalmi, Turner, and Squires, 1976)
= IVg
v'lip
(12.4)
v, = IVg
vtl
(12.5)
347
(E-4.7 -
1)
ch
(Vch -
10-3
30
50
40
20
EXPERIMENTAL
Ul
+'
!:>
"c+-
16
U
0
Ib/s-ft2
30 (146.5)
20 (97.7)
Ul
LI NES REPRESENT
CORRELATION
14
U
0
-'
-'
4 W
>
12
C!J
C!J
Z
.....
>t.....
>
",
o 40 (195.3)
>l.....
PTS,
(kg/s-m2)
18
Z
.....
~
10
J:
J:
U
8
2
6
0
= 8.72
20
10
kg/m3
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
p~.77
Vt)
2.5
Ib/H3
3.0
3.5
Gs
-=
Pp
(Vch
VI) (1 -
Ech)
A worked example of how to calculate the choking velocity using the Punwani
correlation is shown below.
Uch
=--
Vch
Ech
To calculate the actual gas velocity at choking, Eqs (12.6) and (12.7) must be
solved simultaneously for Ech and Vch' This correlation predicted the -data
tested within 25 per cent.
Yang (1982) has recently modified his earlier choking velocity correlation
to include the effect of gas density. The modified Yang choking velocity
correlation is also shown below:
. 2gD
1) _
(E~4.7 2
( Vch
VI )
Gs
Pp
6.81 x 10
(Vch
(.!!1..).2.2
Vt) (1 -
Pp
Ech)
Punwani correlation
Calculate the choking velocity for coal particles with an average particle size
of 300 ~m being conveyed at a rate of 1,816 kg/h using nitrogen in a 75 mm
diameter pipe at a system temperature of 20C and a system pressure of 17 bar
gauge.
= 21.6 kg/m3
= 1,200 kglm3
~ = 1.84 X 10-5
Pg
Pp
D
G
=75 mm
114 kg/m2 s
N s/m2
Solving the Punwani correlation for the choking velocity consists of solving
Eqs. (12.6) and (12.7) simultaneously for Vch and Ech'
In order to calculate the choking velocity a value must be obtained for the
terminal velocity VI> the method outlined in Chapter 6, Section 6.3, may be
used; alternatively, since the flow regime is transitional, Eq. (12.11) is
appropriate. Assume that the particle size given in the example is the volume
diameter dv.
0.153go.71d~.14 (pp _ pg)O.71
VI
p~.29
/LO.43
and presented in the Coal Conversion Systems Technical Data Book (Institute
of Gas Technology, 1978). Several of these correlations (Hinkle, 1953; Currin
and Gorin, 1968; Konno and Saito, 1969; Rose and Duckworth, 1969;
Richards and Wiersma, 1973; Knowlton and Bachovchin, 1976; Leung, 1976;
and Yang, 1976) were compared in the Data Book using the low pressure data
of Curran and Gorin (1968) and the high pressure data of Knowlton and
Bachovchin (1976). The correlation of Yang was found to predict the low
pressure data better than the other correlations. However, overall, the
modified Konno and Saito correlation was found to predict the data
somewhat better than the Yang correlation and, although much less
sophisticated than the Yang correlation, is much simpler to use. The modified
Konno and Saito correlation is presented below:
_ U2Pg
6.PT 2
(1)
Gs
Vs
=-
2fgPgU2L
D
(3)
0.057Upg8Lg
v'(gD)
(4)
(6)
(12.12)
0.095 m/s
Vs
Combining
sVs
(2)
Pp
Equations
= 8.72
10-
x (21.6)77
10-4
0.095
= vg
Gs
VI
and 8 =-UPg
pressure
presure
pressure
pressure
pressure
pressure
If the gas and the solids are already accelerated in the lift line, then the first
two terms should be omitted from the calculation of the pressure drop.
A worked example of how to calculate the pressure drop in vertical dilute
phase pneumatic conveying using the Konno and Saito correlation is given
below.
1-Ech
Uch
= 2.51 mls
= Vch Ech =
12.2.3
2.51 x 0.9528
2.39 m/s
Many correlations are also available for use in determining the pressure drop
in vertical pneumatic conveying lines. Twenty such correlations were found
Example 12.2: Pressure drop in vertical dilute phase conveyingKonno and Saito method
Determine the pressure drop in a dilutephase pneumatic conveying line in
which coal of an average particle size of 300 /Lm is being conveyed at a
velocity of 12 mls with nitrogen in a 75 mm diameter conveying line at a rate
of 1,861 kg/h. The temperature of the line is 21C and is at a pressure of 17 bar
guage. The line is 15 m long.
..
:
...
@
".::.:.
Solution
".a
Assume the gas is already accelerated when the particles enter the line. Since
the gas is already accelerated then, from Eg. (12.12):
APT
2fgPgU2L
Gsvs +
D
0.057UpgfJLg
GsLg
V(gD)
+~
+ PgLg
~
z
(12.13)
W
..J
f-
....
Z
= (12 - 0.5)
=
::l
m/s
11.5 m/s
,6p
Q.
Q.
Gs
= --
UPg
114
= ---12 x 21.6
0.075
V(9.81 x 0.075)
= 114 x 11.5+-------+-------------
AP
T
o
~
a
w
::l
en
en
w
~
Q.
114 x 15 x 9.81
11.5
+ 21.6 x 15 x 9.81
DUpg
-fJ--
0.075 x 12 x 21.6
1.84 X 10-5
= 1.06 x 10
and
fg = 0.004
Therefore:
6..PT
1.45 Ib/in2:
APT
1.74lb/in2
curve CDEF for a mass flux G1, and curve GH for a mass flux G2 greater
than G1 At C, the gas velocity in the horizontal line is sufficiently high to
carry solids at a rate G1 through the pipe in a very dilute suspension. If the gas
velocity is reduced while continuing to feed at the constant mass flux G1, the
frictional resistance, and thus the pressure drop in the line, will decrease. The
solids will move more slowly and their concentration in the pipe will increase.
At D, the gas velocity is insufficient to keep the solids in suspension, and they
begin to settle to the bottom of the pipe. The gas velocity at D is termed the
saltation velocity, Usa1t> and is a strong function of solids loading.
If the gas velocity is reduced further to E, the pressure drop will rise rapidly
as the solids continue to deposit on the bottom of the pipe constricting the
space available for gas flow. As the gas velocity is reduced between E and F,
the depth of the particle layer and the pressure gradient both increase. In this
regime, some particles may move slowly in dense phase flow along the bottom
of the pipe, while, simultaneously, others travel in suspension in the gas in the
upper part of the pipe.
The saltation velocity sets a lower limit on velocity for any horizontal
dilute phase pneumatic transfer ~s-tem. It is desirable, however, to operate at as low a velocity and pressure drop as possible and still remain far
enough from saltation to be 'safe' if a system upset should occur. Therefore,
There have been many efforts to correlate the saltation velocity. Two
comparisons of many of the published saltation velocity correlations have
been made (Jones and Leung, 1978;and Arastoopour et al., 1979). The Jones
and Leung comparison was made using eight different correlations (Thomas,
1962; Doig and Roper, 1963; Zenz, 1964; Rose and Duckworth, 1969; Rizk,
1973; Matsumoto etal., 1974a, 1975b; Mewing, 1976). The comparisons were
made using air-solids data only, and at low pressure. Jones and Leung
recommended that the Thomas correlation be used for design.
The Zenz correlation predicts that as particle size is decreased, the saltation
velocity at first decreases, then passes through a minimum, and then increases
again. This latter effect is explained as being due to small particles becoming
'trapped' in the laminar sublayer and needing a higher velocity to dislodge the
particle. However, for small particles (less than about 80 JLm in size), the
Zenz correlation at times predicts unbelievably high values of the saltation
velocity. It is best applied to particles larger than this size.
A worked example of how to calculate the saltation velocity using the Zenz
correlation is shown below.
= /
and
Example 12.3:
of Zem;
Calculate the saltation velocity of -10+ 100 US mesh sand being conveyed at
a rate of 1,362 kg/h through a 150 mm diameter tube with nitrogen at 21C
and 0.34 bar gauge.
3
2644 kg/m
Pg = 1.61 kg/m3
JL = 1.84 X 10-5 N s/m2
D = 150mm
Gs = 21.4 kg/m2 s
dpi (10 mesh particle) = 2,000 /-Lm /.
dpi (100 mesh particle) = 150/-Lm
Pp
Solution
!:J. =
1/3
12/
Substituting values:
w
!:J.
= 0.626 m/s
1.82
10-5 m
18.2 /-Lm
= 109.9
=
s
150 = 8.24
18.2
(Usc!w))
(Uso/w)s
(dplll)l)
(dplll)s
~..
SA
r~
I.
2- =
(109.9)
8.24
3.3
SA
IlPT
S~ =0.29
According to Zenz,if SA is negative or less than 0.05, it should be taken as
0.05. However, it is not in this case and;
w(7)
(Uso)s
w(3.3)
4.38 mls
0.626 x 3.3
2.06 m/s
Notice that (Uso). is larger than (Uso)s' However, (U so)s can som~tiJJle pe
larger than (Uso)I' This can occur because the small particles can be ~in
the laminar boundary layer. Always use the largest Uso to calculate Usa1t,
however.
Figure 12.4 was determined from experiments in a 63.5 mm diameter tube.
The single-particle saltation velocities will now have to be corrected for the
larger sized 150mqt diameter 'tube. U.so !las been shown to be proportional to
DO.4 Therefore:
.
(Uso)150
(Uso)63.5
(150 \0.4
~
63.5)'
[(Uso)sh50
.. = 0.213
Pp
21.4
2,644
(SA)1.5 (Usalt-Uso)
Uso
12.3.2
cJ2Pg
G
svs
2/gpgU2 L
D
where:
= U (1
Vs
(Uso)1
- 0.0638d~3pg.5)
Is = 2-!i
Co
8 Pp
!l.-
(U -
dp
II )2
s
Vs
EX~Plel~
Pg
7f
= 2.83
=
Vs =
}L
=
=
+Gv +
ss
2-1'
U2L
D
'1gPg
kglm3
4.
_ 1.816
4
_
2
Gs - 3,600 '17'(0
..075)2 - 114 kg/m s
Solution
= 0.0056
= -p.- =
fg
2fg(2.83
+ -------
= 0.004
fsvs
0.0056 x 14.5
-=----=
fgU
0.004 x 18
1.13
= 1 in the
Therefore, when applying these correlations, bear in mind that the state of
the art (as applied to pneumatic conveying correlations) still leaves much to
be desired.
Bends complicate the design of pneumatic dilute phase transfer systems, and
when designing a conveying system it is best to use as few bends as possible.
Bends increase the pressure drop in a line, and also are the points of most
serious erosion and particle attrition.
Solids normally in suspension in straight, horizontal, or vertical pipes tend
to salt out at bends due to the centrifugal force encountered while travelling
around the bend. Because of this separation, the particles slow down and are
then reentrained and reaccelerated after they pass through the bend, resulting
in the higher pressure drops associated with bends.
There is a greater tendency for particles to salt out in a horizontal pipe
which is preceded by a downflowing vertical-to horizontal bend than in any
other configuration (Patterson, 1959). If this type of bend is present in a
system, it is possible for solids to remain on the bottom of the pipe for very
long distances following the bend, before they redisperse (Fig. 12.5b). The
particles in a horizontal pipe following an upflowing vertical-to-horizontal
bend are not as likely to salt out since they can easily redisperse into the gas
stream due to gravity (Fig. 12.5a). Therefore, it is recommended that
J.
A
(a)
VERTICAL (Up) TO
HORIZONTAL ELBOW
(a) The correlations were evaluated fot a very limited amount of data.
(b) There is disagreement between studies as to which correlation is 'best'.
Note that the Jones and Leung (1978) analysis resulted in a different
'best' correlation for USal1 than did the Arastoopour et al. (1979) study.
(c) The 'best' correlations can generally be expected to predict parameters
no more accurately than 30 to 40 per cent.
(d) If the correlations are to be applied to high temperature and/or high
pressure systems, their accuracy may be much worse than 30 to 40 per
cent. since nearly all of the correlations were developed from data
obtained at ambient conditions.
..
.
.
....... .
'
_:
C
(e)
well dispersed, the inclined pipe pressure drop was found to be less than the
vertical dilute phase pressure drop. At lower gas velocities the solids formed
nodes on the bottom of the pipe. A further reduction in the conveying
velocity resulted in slugging or choking in the pipe. This choking condition
occurred at a higher velocity than observed in vertical pipes. No useful
correlations exist to predict choking velocities and pressure drops in inclined
pipes.
12.6
COMBINED SYSTEMS
ex:
iJO.4
The only data available on the dilute phase flow of solids through inclined
pipes are due to Zenz (1960). At very high velocities where the solids were
although this dependency was based on work with rather small tubes, 3.2 to
6.4 cm in diameter.
The Yang (1976a), Punwani, Modi, and Tarman (1976), and modified
Yang (1982) correlations for the choking velocity also predict an increase in
Uch with pipe diameter. This dependency is approximately pipe diameter to
the 0.25 power, i.e.:
Uch
DO.25
12.8
Dilute phase conveying is by far the most common type of conveying. It can
also be the most economical. Sandy, Daubert, and Jones (1970) calculated
that the minimum power requirements for dilute phase vertical pneumatic
conveying were approximately an order of magnitude less than the power
requirements for dense phase vertical pneumatic conveying of an air-fused
alumina system. The large power requirements needed for vertical dense
phase transport were a result of the high pressure drops needed to move
solids upwards in dense phase flow.
However, it is not always the case that dilute phase pneumatic conveying
will be less costly than dense phase pneumatic conveying as it depends
strongly on the particular gas-solids system being used. In general, the tradeoff which must be made is between the higher pressure drop per unit length
(I1P/L) associated with dense phase pneumatic conveying versus the higher
gas flows needed for dilute phase pneumatic transport.
In spite of the high pressure drop per unit length needed, dense phase
conveying offers certain advantages over dilute phase conveying which
may tip the scales in its favour for a particular process. Since the solids
velocities are much lower in dense phase conveying than in dilute phase
conveying, solids attrition and pipe erosion are considerably reduced. This
feature is particularly desirable when expensive. or fragile solids are to be
transported, and it is desired to minimize particle breakup and elutriation
losses. Dense phase conveying also decreases the demand on a particle
collection system.
Gas requirements for dense phase pneumatic conveying (as noted above)
are much lower than for dilute phase pneumatic conveying. Sandy, Daubert,
and Jones (1970) found that vertical dilute phase gas requirements for their
air/fused alumina system were over 20 times those for vertical dense phase
conveying. In instances where the conveying gas is extremely expensive, or
In vertical dense phase packed bed conveying, the solids are transported
through a tube by forcing transporting gas upwards through the interstices of
the particles. When the frictional forces between the gas and the particles are
sufficient to overcome the weight of the particles plus the frictional forces of
the solids sliding on the tube walls, the solids will start to move upwards. This
occurs at a pressure drop per unit length, I1P/L, approximately equal to that
at minimum fluidization for that particular material. This I1P/L value is also
approximately equal to the bulk density of the solids.
In order to prevent fluidization of the particles in the pipe or tube the outlet
of the conduit must be restricted in some manner. This can be accomplished
by placing a valve, orifice, or an expanded section of a non-fluidized bed of
solids at the outlet of the pipe. This effectively prevents the solids from
expanding and becoming fluidized.
Because of the restriction at the outlet of the pipe, the relative velocity
between gas and solids may now be greater than the minimum fluidization
velocity, and the solids will move upwards as a packed bed. This operating
mode is shown as lines GH and 1] in the phase diagram of Fig. 12.6, where the
mass flux G1 is less than G2 The familiar fluidization and dilute phase vertical
conveying I1P/L versus velocity curves (ODE and ABC, respectively) are
also shown in this figure for reference. Curve OD is the packed bed I1P/L
versus velocity curve. At D the I1P/L is sufficient to cause the bed to expand
and normally become fluidized. However, if the bed is restricted (e.g. by a
screen small enough to let only gas pass through it) the I1P/L continues to
increase with velocity at zero solids flow. Thus, ODF is the I1P/L versus
velocity curve for G = 0 in vertical dense phase transport.
Berg (1954a, 1954b, 1954c, 1954d) received several patents relating to the
vertical transport of solids in a dense phase packed bed regime in order to
reduce particle attrition and loss of expensive catalyst material. Because of
bubble formation at high solids flowrates and excessive pressure drops in the
transport line, both due to gas expansion, Berg had to taper or increase the
diameter of the transport line every few feet. Alternatively, he also found that
removing some of the gas would also prevent excessive pressure drops in the
the gas to support the solids. The Leung, Sandy et al. and Wen and Galli
correlations are extremely sensitive to voidage and particle size. Their
accuracy is strongly dependent
upon the correct prediction of these
properties. The Wen and Galli correlation is shown below:
150(1 -
ef /L(Ule - vs)
(I/Jdvf~
(1)
1.75(1-e)Pg(Ule
- vs)z
!/Jdve
(2)
(l-e)(pp
- Pg)
2pgU
D
fg
where:
(1) and (2) are the pressure drop due to gas-solids friction,
(3) is the pressure drop for the gas to support the solids,
(4) is the gas-wall friction loss.
SUPERFICIAL VELOCITY, U
line. Sandy, Daubert, and Jones (1970) were also forced to use increasingly
large flow areas to keep 6.PIL from becoming excessively high in their dense
phase vertical transport line.
Extreme care must be exercised in placing an expanded section of pipe at
the exit of the line in dense phase vertical transport (Knowlton and Hirsan,
1980) so that its area is not too large. A large diameter section requires a gas
velocity large enough to produce a 6.PIL equal to the bulk density of the
material before solids will flow. This amount of gas also has to pass through
the smaller diameter section of pipe preceding the expanded section. If the
ratio of the large diameter pipe to the small diameter pipe is too large, the
6.PIL in the smaller diameter section can become exorbitantly high.
Several correlations have been developed to predict the pressure drop in
dense phase vertical packed bed transport (Berg, 1954a, 1954b, 1954c, 1954d;
Sandy, Daubert, and Jones, 1970; Leung, Wiles and Nicklin, 1971b; and Wen
and Galli, 1971). The Berg correlation is relatively complex. The Leung
correlation is the simplest and is merely the Ergun equation applied to a
moving packed bed. The Sandy and the Wen and Galli correlations a~so
employ the Ergun equation to predict the pressure drop due to gas-sohds
friction, but also include other terms, primarily the pressure drop needed for
12.8.2
If the solids in a dense phase vertical transport line are not restricted as in
dense phase packed bed flow, they can be transported in dense phase in
fluidized bed flow. However, because of gas expansion, this flow generally
reverts to bubbling or slug flow unless the transport line is tapered.
This type of flow is characterized by lines LM and NP on the phase diagram
of Fig. 12.6, where NP represents a solids mass flux, Gz, greater than Gr.
Although these curves are informative, they are not as useful as they are in
dilute phase conveying. In dilute phase conveying, the gas velocity can be
reduced while maintaining a constant mass flux. The solids are simply
transferred at the same flow rate, but in a denser state. This is usually not the
case in dense phase vertical transport with fluidized (or packed bed) flow.
This is because the transport gas rate also generally determines the solids flow
rate. When the superficial transport gas velocity is changed, the solids
flowrate also changes. Thus, a knowledge of how the solids flowrate varies
with gas velocity is also needed for the design of dense phase pneumatic
conveying systems. A typical solids flowrate versus velocity curve for an
unrestricted vertical dense phase transfer line operating in slug flow is shown
in Fig. 12.7, along with a curve showing the variation in pressure drop in the
transport line as a function of solids flowrate (Fig. 12.8). The curves were
obtained in conjunction with a non-mechanical J-valve study by Knowlton
and Hirsan (1980).
GAS FLUIDIZATION
364
TECHNOLOGY
1.0
0.5
2.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
12.8.3
m3/h
4.0
...c.
32
"-.Jl
0
0
0
J-VALVE
DIAM:
J-VALVE
(61 em)
LENGTH:
28
MATERIAL:
24
-<
>I
')
14
24
"-.:i.
SIDERITE
12
SYST. PRESS.'
(55 kPo)
AERATION GAS'
NITROGEN
psig
W
>
..J
-<
>I
to
')
I
C!l
20
I
C!l
:J
a
a::
:J
a
a::
..c.
01
In.
(300 fLm)
,
W
>
..J
I-
16
W
I-
I-
-<
a::
3:
..J
lI..
I-
...:
12
IX
3:
a
..J
en
0
...
U-
...J
rn
a
,.,.
..J
en
0
rn
0.4
0.8
1.2
1.6
2.0
2.4
o
w~
~':J~ ~
WE
~o
1.3
1.2
.0..
lJ..<I
....
..J
...,
:J'(1)0
,
o..~
t.4
o LOWER DENSE-PHASE
LIFT
LIFT
A UPPER DENSE-PHASE
1. 1
~~
0.. ,
..J
...
'lJ..0..
:J<I
WE
(1)0
WO
(1)0
~~
o..w
"':lJ.. 1.0
iE~
IW
~~
10..
W
0.13
----;;--
WO
15
~Ic:.
a 8
A
I
~~
00
5
10
11
drop in dense
1980).
phase
vertical
fluidized
12
13
Ib/h
flow versus
solids
ln
dense
phase
and dune formation occurred (Fig. 12.9b). Decreasing the gas velocity even
more (or, equivalently, increasing the solids/gas loading) caused more solids
to settle to the bottom of the pipe and the solids were observed to travel in
small dunes or ripples across the top of a thick, relatively stationary, salted
layer (Fig. 12.9c). A further increase in solids loading eventually caused a
complete blockage of the pipe.
In some cases, Wen and Simons observed that intermittent slug flow of
solids (Fig. 12.9d) occurred instead of dune formation (Fig. 12.9b). This was
accompanied by unstable, wildly fluctuating pressure drops across the line.
Because of the uncertainties associated with horizontal dense phase
conveying (HDPC) and the high probability of plugging the pipe, most
designers have shied away from horizontal dense phase conveying. They have
opted instead to use the dilute phase conveying for its known reliability. In
fact, HDPC has long been considered somewhat of a 'black art' by many
people. This attitude has grown because there has been no systematic
procedure with which to predict what system to use with a particular material.
Some materials could be conveyed relatively easily in the HDPC mode, while
others would plug the line and the system would fail.
A paper by Canning and Thompson (1980) appears to offer the first
systematic procedure which can be used to determine what horizontal dense
phase system to use with a particular type of material. This work, along with
the earlier work of Flatt (1976), has helped to significantly advance the state
of the art of HDPC.
There are three basic types of HDPC systems (Fig. 12.10). The simplest is
the blow tank, or simple-pipe system., depicted in Fig. 12.1O(a). With this
system, pressurizing and motive air is usually supplied to the top of a tank and
the solids and secondary motive air are added to the conveying line through a
valve below the tank.
The second type of system is a pulsed phase system in which gas is added to
the conveying line in pulses (Fig. 12.10b). This type of system is used to
artificially form solid plugs of selected length for those solids which do not
naturally form slugs.
The third type of system is the by-pass type (Fig. 12.lOc). With this system,
some of the conveying air is by passed around the solids so that the plug
length can be limited and plugging will not occur.
Canning and Thompson found that the system which was best for a
particular solid depended on whether or not the particles to be conveyed
formed slugs, and, if they did what type of slugs were produced. They
also found that a particular solid behaved similarly in both horizontal and
vertical flow. They therefore analysed slug formation using choking-velocity
theory.
Yang (1976a) argued that when the velocity of a gas slug in vertical
conveying was greater than the terminal velocity of the particles, then no
SIMPLE-PIPE
MOTIVE AIR
PULSED SYSTEM
MOTIVE AIR
(PULSED-FLOW
AIR KNIFE
BYPASS SYSTEM
MOTIVE AIR
stable slugs were possible. In this case the particles could be fast fluidized
without slugging or choking. Therefore, for unstable or asymmetric slugs, the
terminal velocity must be less than the slug rise velocity, or:
Vt
< 0.35(gD)o.5
> 0.35(gD)o.5
(pp - pg)d~g
= -----
18p.
for Ret
< 0.2
for
Vt
should be used.
< 0.35(gD)o.5
Canning and Thompson reported that with the aid of the fluidization
diagram it was possible to choose a suitable HDPC system for a particular
powder based only on the fluidization classifiaction of the powder. The
system best suited for a particular powder type is described below.
Group C Solids
Thus, we now have a relationship between dy and (pp - pg) for various pipe
diameters. This relationship may now be plotted on a Geldart (1973)
fluidization diagram, as shown in Fig. 12.11, to distinguish between the
various slugging regions.
D
STRONG, STABLE
AXISYMMETRIC
SLUGS
UNSTABLE
ASYMMETRIC
SLUGS (Dunes)
NO
~
SLUGGING
~-:.
..~
.........
......
...
""
""
Group A Solids
These materials are the best candidates for HDPC. They retain air and
remain fluidized, and can be generally conveyed at low velocities and at high
loadings with little risk of pipe blockages. All three types of systems shown in
Fig. 12.10 can be used with these materials. For long (greater than 200 m
distances) it may be advisable to use a by-pass system.
Group B Solids
These materals are the worst type to use in HDPC. At high loadings they tend
to cause pipe vibrations and blockage. The by-pass system can be used to
convey these materials at higher loadings and at lower velocities than a dilute
phase system.
...
"
These are materials which are generally very difficult to convey in HDPC
because of their cohesiveness.
'1"
Group D Solids
100
1,000
These materials can be conveyed easily if they have a narrow particle size
distribution. All three system types may be used to convey these particles.
Figure 12.11 The Geldart fluidization diagram applied to dense phase pneumatic
conveying (Canning and Thompson, 1980).
12.8.4
Extrusion Flow
Zenz and Rowe (1976) studied a group of materials which can be made
to flow through pipes in extrusion-type flow. In this type of flow, the
solids occupy the entire pipe cross-section and flow much like plastic
being extruded through a round die. Zenz and Rowe found that only
certain solids would flow in this manner. These solids were generally of
low bulk density and very small particle size. The solids also had to exhibit
a property called 'bulk deform ability' , characterized in this study by a test
wherein a steel rod was placed on top of the solids. If the rod fell through
the solids without aerating them, the solids could be conveyed in extrusion
flow.
12.8.5
Another type of system which can transfonn solids in HDPC is the airassisted gravity conveyor. With air-assisted gravity conveying, the solids are
fluidized with air distributed along the length of the conveying pipe or
channel (Woodcock and Mason, 1976). The solids then flow by gravity along
the bottom of the channel. This type of conveying uses a very small amount of
energy. Although solids can be made to move against gravity with this type of
conveying, it is generally used only with 'downhill' conveying.
The standpipe has been in use for over 40 years. It was 'invented' by a
research team from Jersey Standard in the 1940s (Campbell, Martin, and
Tyson, 1948) working on feeding cracking catalyst into fluidized beds during
the Second World War.
The purpose of a standpipe is to transfer solids from a region of low
pressure to a region of higher pressure. This is indicated in Fig. 12.12 where
solids are being transferred from a fluidized bed at pressure PI to another
fluidized bed operating at pressure P., which is higher than Pl.
CASE I
GAS FLOWING
UPWARD RELATIVE
TO PIPE WALL
CASE II
GAS FLOWING
DOWNWARD RELATIVE
TO PIPE WALL
I
I
I
I
Vg I
I
I
Vi
9I
I
I
UPPER
FLUIDIZED
BED
+
DIRECTION
OF
PRESSURE DROP
Figure 12.13 Schematic representation of gas flow down
and gas flow up relative to the standpipe wall.
LOWER
This can be shown with the aid of Fig. 12.13 and the definition
relative velocity. Mathematically:
FLUIDIZED
Vr
BED
= Ivs
vgl
where:
Vr
Vs
= solid
velocity
VSlip)
of the
Vs
(-Vg)
Vs
+ vg
(12.27)
For case II, solids are flowing down the standpipe and gas is also flowing
down the standpipe relative to the standpipe wall, but at a velocity less than
that of the solids. For this case, the relative velocity is also directed upward
and is equal to the difference between the solids velocity and the gas velocity,
i.e.:
For this case, if one were riding down the standpipe with the solids, the gas
would appear to be moving upwards.
Gas flowing upwards relative to the solids causes a frictional pressure drop
to be generated. The relationship between pressure drop per unit length
(I1PIL) and relative velocity is determined by the fluidization curve,
schematically shown in Fig. 12.14. This curve is usually generated in a
fluidization column when the solids are not flowing. However, the relationship also applies for moving solids in standpipe flow.
As the relative velocity through the bed of solids is increased from zero,
I1PIL increases linearly with Vp This is the packed bed region. At some Vn
the I1P generated is equal to the weight of the solids per unit area and the
particles become fluidized. The relative velocity at this point is called the
interstitial minimum fluidized velocity, IJrnf, or Urnr!Ernf' The I1PI L at IJrnf is
designated as I1PIL)rnf and is often referred to as the fluidized bed 'density'
since I1PIL has the units of density.
Increases in Vr above Vrnf do not lead to further increases in I1PIL. For
Geldart group B materials, any increase in gas flow in excess of that required
at Vrnf goes into the formation of bubbles. Therefore, as Vr increase, API L
stays relatively constant and then begins to drop as the bubble volume in the
REGION
f-
(Bubbling)
C!l
~
--J
~(~:L---------a:
w
Q.
~
a:
a
w
a:
::>
UJ
UJ
a:
Q.
RELATIVE VELOCITY, Vr
Figure 12.14 Typical-fluidization curve for Geldart group B solids.
bed increases. The I1PIL versus Vr curve shown in Fig. 12.14 is for group B
solids.
The fluidization curve for Geldart fro up A materials is slightly different
from that for group B solids. As Vr is increased above Vrnffor these materials,
the solids expand without bubbles forming for a certain velocity range, and
I1PIL drops over this velocity range. The velocity where bubbles begin to
form is called the minimum bubbling velocity, Vrnb, to differentiate it from
Vrnf' A typical fluidization curve for group A solids is shown in Fig. 12.15.
Standpipes generally operate in one of three basic flow regimes - packed
bed flow and fluidized bed flow, and streaming flow:
1. Packed bed flow. In packed bed flow, Vr is less than Vmf i.e. (Urnf/Ernf) and
the void age in the standpipe is essentially constant. As Vr is increased,
I1PIL increases in packed bed flow. Often when a standpipe is operating
in the moving packed bed flow regime a flow condition is reached which
causes the standpipe to vibrate and a loud 'chattering' of the solids occurs.
This flow mode is not present at low solid velocities and also decreases in
severity as the relative gas/velocity approaches Vrnf' This flow regime
should be avoided but, unfortunately, no method exists to predict when it
will occur. Little work has been conducted on this problem, and this is also
an area which needs much work.
PACKEDBED
REGION
FLUIDIZED
BUBBLING
REGION
FLUIDIZED
NON-BUBBLING
REGION
I-
C!l
Z
W
...J
(a) All gas in excess of Vrnf travels through the bed in the form of bubbles.
(b) Gas travels through the emulsion at an interstitial velocity equal to
Vrnf
!::
(l>p)
Z ::>
These four types of bubbling fluidized bed flow are discussed individually
below. In the discussion, it is assumed that the two-phase theory of
fluidization holds (see Chapter 4). this theory holds that:
L mf
Type 1 flow. For this type of bubbling fluidized bed flow, both the gas
flowing through the emulsion and the bubbles flow upwards relative to the
standpipe wall, as indicated in Fig. 12.16(a). This type of bubbling
fluidized flow occurs in a standpipe when Vs is less than Vrnf. For fluidized
bed bubbling type 1 flow:
Vs < Vrnf
(12.29)
----------
0::
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I Vmb
I
I
a.
a.
o
0::
o
W
0::
::>
(J)
(J)
0::
a.
TYPE 2
!cb
o
o
o
2. Fluidized bed flow. In fluidized bed solids flow,
1.
2.
3.
4.
Emulsion
Emulsion
Emulsion
Emulsion
;~
0
0
0
TYPE 3
ieb
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TYPE 4
EMULSION GAS UP
BUBBLE GAS UP
BUBBlE GAS UP
BUBBLE GAS UP
NET GAS UP
NET GAS UP
(a)
(b)
(el
(d)
Figure 12.16 Schematic representation of four types of bubbling fluidized bed standpipe
flow.
throughout the entire standpipe length is not desired because the full dense
phase 'head' of the solids is not developed.
Type 3 flow.
This type of bubbling fluidized bed flow is similar to type 2
flow in that Vs is greater than Vmf but less than lb, as shown in Fig.
12.16(c). However, for this type of flow, Qb is less than Qd, resulting in a
net gas flow downwards. Therefore, for type 3 bubbling fluidized bed flow:
Type 4 flow.
In this case (Fig. 12.16d), the solids velocity is so great that
it exceeds lb' The bubbles cannot rise in the standpipe and are carried
down the standpipe relative to the standpipe wall at a velocity equal to
Vs-lb' The net gas flow is obviously downward and so for type 4 bubbling
fluidized bed flow:
Other subclassifications of these basic flow regimes have been noted and
mathematically defined by Leung and coworkers (Leung, Wiles, and Nicklin,
1971a, 1971b; Leung and Wilson, 1973; Leung, 1976; Leung and Wiles,
1976; Leung and Jones, 1978a, 1978b, 1978c; Leung, 1980), who have studied
standpipe flow extensively over the past ten years. Their efforts have
significantly advanced the understanding of solids flow in standpipes. Their
detailed analyses of standpipe operation have demonstrated that multiple
steady state standpipe solids flow regime combinations are possible. More
recently, Jones, Teo, and Leung (1980) have analysed the stability of
standpipe operation. Any serious, in-depth study of standpipe operation
should include a review of their work.
Basically, the three flow regimes described above are the ones most
frequently existing in a standpipe. Various combinations of these flow
regimes can also exist. Fluidized bed flow can exist above packed bed flow
and streaming flow is extremely common above fluidized bed flow and even
packed bed flow.
12.9.1
There are two types of standpipe configurations which can be employed the overflow standpipe (Fig. 12.17a) and the underflow standpipe (Fig.
12.17b). The overflow standpipe is so named because solids overflow from
the top of the fluidized bed into the standpipe. In the underflow standpipe,
the solids are introduced into the standpipe from the underside, or bottom, of
the bed or hopper.
In any gas-solids flow system a pressure drop 'loop' can be defined such
that the sum of the pressure drops around the loop will be zero. In any such
loop in which a standpipe is a component, the standpipe is usually the
dependent part of the loop. This means that the pressure drop across the
standpipe will automatically adjust to balance the pressure drop produced by
the other pressure drop components in the loop. How the standpipe pressure
drop adjustment is made is different for overflow compared to underflow
standpipes.
Consider the overflow standpipe system shown in Fig. 12.18(a). Solids are
being transferred from the upper fluidized bed to the lower fluidized bed
against the pressure differential P 2 - P l' This pressure differential is composed of the pressure drop in the lower fluidized bed from the standpipe exit
to the top of the bed (6.PLB), the pressure drop across the grid of the upper
fluidized bed (6.Pgrid), and the pressure drop across the upper fluidized bed
(6.PUB), i.e.:
PRESSURE PROFILE
IN COLUMN
PRESSURE PROFILE
IN STANDPIPE
li~./..
.,.
..
:::.:
..:. :.:.:.:-T
.
.: : : APLB
......
.... . ...' .l..
.'.~'
,"
\"t)~';llf~~t,i
::':P2'::
II
',_
l>Psp
PRESSURE
( a) OVERFLOW
STANDPIPE
Figure 12.17 Overflow and underflow standpipe configurations.
This pressure drop must be balanced by the pressure drop in the overflow
standpipe. If the standpipe is operating in the fluidized bed mode at a I1PIL
equal to (I1PI L)mf, the solids height in the standpipe Hsp will adjust so that
the standpipe pressure drop I1Psp will equal the product of (I1PIL)mf and
Hsp, i.e.:
I1Psp = Pz-PI
= ( ~:-
)mf Hsp
t.Psp
(12.36)
The pressure diagram for this system is also shown in Fig. 12.18(a).
If the gas flowrate through the two beds is increased, I1Pgrid will increase
while the pressure drops across the two beds will remain essentially constant,
so that P2-PI increases to P2-PI. The pressure drop across the standpipe
will then also adjust to P2- Pl' This occurs because the height of solids in the
standpipe will increase from Hsp to H~p so that:
I1Psp = P2-PI
(~:
)mfH~p
(12.37)
------<"""
PRESSURE
a value greater than the standpipe height available, the standpipe will not
operate.
In Fig. 12.19(a), solids are being transferred through an underflow
standpipe from the upper fluidized bed to the lower fluidized bed against the
differential pressure, PZ-P1.The differential pressure, PZ-PI, consists of the
pressure drop across the grid of the upper fluidized bed ~Pgrid' However,
there is also a pressure drop across the solids flow control valve ~Pv for this
standpipe configuration. Therefore, the standpipe pressure drop ~Psp must
equal the sum of I1Pv and I1Pgrid, i.e.:
PRESSURE
-
PRESS~E
----
PRESSURE PROFILE
PROFILE IN COLUMN
IN STANDPIPE
(b)
AP)
L II
-------
AP)
L
---
I
I
IIV),.I
II
I
I
I
I
I V ,.) II
I
Overflow Standpipes
(a) It is necessary to immerse the exit end of an overflow standpipe in a
fluidized bed. If not immersed, the standpipe will empty of solids, a
pressure seal will not form, and solids will not flow through the
standpipe.
(b) The overflow standpipe operates 'automatically'. This means that the
solids which enter the top of the overflow standpipe are discharged at the
same rate into the fluidized bed without the need of a valve, i.e.
'automatically' .
Thus, for this underflow standpipe case, the standpipe must generate a
pressure drop greater than PZ-P1. This is shown as case I in the pressure
diagram of Fig. 12.19(b).
If the gas flowrate through the fluidized beds is increased, t:..Pgrid will
increase. If it is assumed that t:..Pv remains constant, then t:..Psp must increase
to balance the pressure drop loop. This is shown as case II in the pressure
diagram of Fig. 12.19(b). Unlike the previous case discussed for the overflow
standpipe, the solids level cannot rise to increase the pressure drop in the
(c) The overflow standpipe usually operates with solids in the fluidized
regime. However, it is not necessary that it do so. The overflow
standpipe can also operate in the packed bed mode.
(d) The overflow standpipe generally operates only partially full of solids.
This is because an overflow standpipe is designed so that it will have a
height 25 to 30 per cent. greater than needed to develop the design
pressure drop.
(e) Since the solids enter the overflow standpipe from the top of the bed,
large solids, or agglomerates, may collect at the bottom of the feed
fluidized bed since they cannot be discharged.
Underflow Standpipes
(a) Solids enter the underflow standpipe from the bottom of a fluidized or
packed bed. Therefore, it is necessary to have a valve at the exit of the
underflow standpipe to maintain solids in the bed. This valve must
control the solids flowrate and the standpipe usually does not operate
'automatically' .
(b) The underflow standpipe operates completely full of solids.
(c) The underflow standpipe usually operates in the packed bed mode with
group B solids. With group A solids, either the fluidized bed or the
packed bed mode can be used.
(d) The underflow standpipe does not need to be buried in a fluidized bed to
operate. The valve at the bottom of the standpipe enables the overflow
standpipe to also discharge the solids above the bed, if desired.
(e) The underflow standpipe will discharge agglomerates which collect near
the bottom of the bed if they are not larger than the standpipe diameter.
AERATION
TO STANDPIPE
AERATION
TO STANDPIPE
the stan?pipe wall. The cracking catalyst friction loss in an 8 in. (20 em)
diameter standpipe, as reported by Matsen (1976), is shown in Fig. 12.21. In
this figure, the standpipe friction loss is presented as a function of the true
density of the catalyst-gas mixture in the standpipe (usually measured with
radiation in commercial standpipes). When the true density of the mixture in
the standpipe increases above that at minimum fluidization, the friction loss
due to solids sliding on the standpipe wall increases sharply.
.'
if"
.~
DILUTE-PHASE
CONVEYI NG LINE "
DILUTE-PHASE
CONVEYING LINE
Figure 12.20 Typical solids flow loop in a catalytic cracker with underflow standpipe.
300
C')
"-OJ
.:t
, 200
00
t-
OO
0
-I
Z
0
....
:r:
<.?
W
:r:
100
tO
.....
~
lJ...
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
kg/m3
Fig,ure 12.22 Standpipe pressure profiles as a function of height in an underflow standpipe in
which VOIdage decreases wIth height.
(b) To prevent
standpipes.
defluidization
m overflow
If the standpipe is fluidized over its entire length and if the fluidized density
is constant throughout the entire length of the standpipe, then the standpipe
pressure profile will take the form shown in Fig. 12.22(a).
As noted above, since e decreases as the gas density increases down the
standpipe, the solids flow regime can be in fluidized bed flow at the top of the
standpipe and then revert to packed bed flow at the bottom of the standpipe.
The effect that decreasing e has on Vr can be seen by expressing the relative
velocity equation:
v
r
Gs
Pp (1-e)A
--
Gg
Pg A
(12.40)
BUBBLING
FLUIDIZED-BED
FLOW TYPES
L
2, AND3
BUBBLING
FLUIDIZED-BED
FLOW TYPE
4
For type 4 bubbling fluidized bed solids flow where Vs < Ub, bubbles added
to the standpipe by aeration are carried down the standpipe with the solids,
and the effect of the aeration is produced below the aeration injection point
(fig. 12.23b).
It must be emphasized here that the minimum amount of aeration
necessary to maintain fluidization in the standpipe is the optimum amount of
aeration to use. Too much aeration gas added to the standpipe will cause
large bubbles to form which will hinder and decrease the flow of solids down
the standpipe.
Defluidization
Sauer, Chan, and Knowlton (1984) have recently shown that overflow
standpipes operating in a bubbling fluidized bed mode can defluidize if the
solids flowrate is increased above a limiting value. Defluidization in this case
is not caused by solids/wall friction but is thought to occur because of the
force produced by the dilute phase streaming solids falling on the top of the
dense phase solids in the standpipe. This force may 'compress' the fluidized
column of solids, decrease E, and cause defluidization. Sauer, Chan and
Knowlton (1984) showed that adding aeration to the bottom of the standpipe
at a single location could prevent defluidization. This is because the solids
velocities in the standpipes they were operating were always less than the
bubble rise velocity (bubbling fluidized bed flow types 1, 2, and 3). If Vs had
exceeded Ub in their standpipes (bubbling fluidized bed flow type 4), aeration
would have had to be added at the top of the standpipe.
12.9.4
Angled Standpipes
Angled (or inclined) standpipes are used in many cases in industry to transfer
solids between two points which are separated horizontally, as well as
vertically. Angled standpipes would seem to be a very convenient way to
transfer solids on paper; operationally, angled standpipes are not recommended.
Sauer, Chan, and Knowlton (1984) studied angled standpipes and a hybrid
combination of an angled standpipe and a straight standpipe operating in
fluidized bed bubbling flow. They used transparent lines to observe the flow
of solids in the angled sections in these standpipes. Invariably, they found that
the gas and solids separated, the gas channelling via bubbles along the upper
half of the pipe while the solids flowed along the bottom portion of the
standpipe. This is illustrated in Fig. 12.24.
Sauer, Chan and Knowlton (1984) also found that the pressure buildup in
angled standpipes was much lower than in straight standpipes due to
gas-solids separation. Because of this separation, the gas does not completely
OF kg/h
5
I
0.10
W
0..
t-<
0..
I(f)
0.05
~
-.J
"'0..
<J
-60
ANGLED ST ANDP I PE
-----STRAIGHT
STANDPIPE
D:
2.5
in.
MATERIAL:
o
~CREASING
VOIDAGE AND
GAS VELOCITY
(6.4
em)
10
12
OF
Ib/h
fluidize the solids and produce the full hydrostatic head of solids. This is
illustrated in Fig. 12.25, which compares the aPIL produced by a straight
overflow standpipe and an angled overflow standpipe as a function of the
solids flowrate through them. As can be seen, the straight or vertical
standpipe produces a much higher standpipe density.
If at all possible, underflow standpipes to be operated in the fluidized
bubbling bed mode should be designed to be straight. The section of overflow
standpipes operating in dense phase flow should also be designed to be
straight. The section of an overflow standpipe operating in dilute phase
streaming flow can be angled with no adverse effects, however. This is
indicated in Fig. 12.26.
12.9.5 Stripping in Standpipes
During the transfer of solids from one fluidized bed to another via a
standpipe, a substantial amount of gas can be transferred with the solids in the
NO
YES
CASEI
GAS TRAVELLING
DOWNWARD
II
GAS TRAVELLING
UPWARD
.t
I I
I I
I I
I
I
I
p: ,
I
I I
I I I
I
I I
I
I
I I
I I
II
I
I
I
I
'012345
'012~45
STRIPPING
GAS
INJECTION
(N2)
STRIPPING
GAS (N2)
I
I
I
:
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I I
I
I
, t
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
If the solids being transferred are porous, then a substantial amount of gas
may be trapped in the pores and transferred along with the interstitial gas.
During the process of stripping, the gas trapped in the pores may also diffuse
into the bulk of the interstitial gas and increase the stripping requirements
significantly relative to non-porous solids stripping requirements.
Stripping gas can be added to standpipes operating in both the moving
packed bed and fluidized bed modes.
, t I
: t
I
I I I :
v.
:
012345
V.
I
I
012345
Figure 12.28 Relative gas-solid velocities in a stripping standpipe: (a) gas flowing downwards
and (b) gas flowing upwards.
downwards relative to the standpipe wall. The dotted arrows designated '0'
for case I in Fig. 12.28(a) indicate the magnitude and direction of the gas
above and below the stripping gas injection point (SGIP) when no stripping
gas is being added to the standpipe. When the stripping gas is added to the
standpipe, the pressure drop in the standpipe above the SGIP rises, whereas
the pressure drop in the standpipe below the SGIP falls, as shown in Fig.
12.29. However, the total standpipe pressure drop (Fig. 12.29) remains
constant.
This trend continues until no gas is carried down the standpipe with the solids
(point '3' in Fig. 12.28a). At this point, vg = 0 above the SGIP. If more
stripping gas is added, stripping gas will now flow up the standpipe above the
SGIP, as well as down the standpipe section below the SGIP. At this point,
the gas from the upper fluidized bed is completely stripped; i.e. it cannot
travel down the standpipe.
Gas Flow Up
q,
:r
'080
E
u
a:060
a:
c
IJJ
a:
5len
IJJ
a:
a.
40
...o
--0
.!:
a:
o
is 20 !i=~
i:5
0.2
0.4
0.6
NITROGENSTRIPPING GAS FLOW RATE, actual m3/min x 10-2
In Fig. 12.28(b), the gas in the standpipe is initially moving upwards. When
stripping gas is added to this standpipe, the standpipe pressure drop above the
SGIP rises and the pressure drop across the standpipe below the SGIP falls.
Thus, the Vr in the standpipe above the SGIP rises and the Vr in the standpipe
below the SGIP decreases. Therefore, all the stripping gas that is initially
added goes up the standpipe above the SGIP, diluting the gas already moving
upwards.
In the standpipe section below the SGIP the pressure drop falls; therefore,
the amount of gas moving up the pipe in this section has to decrease. As more
stripping gas is added, this trend continues until no gas moves up the pipe
(point '3' in Fig. 12.28b) and the standpipe is effectively stripped.
Thus, in a packed bed of non-porous particles, the interstitial gas can be
stripped with another gas regardless of whether the interstitial gas was
initially moving upwards or downwards. The actual stripping section is below
the SGIP in the former case and above it in the latter.
Stripping Gas Injection Point Location
Changing the location of the SGIP in a standpipe affects the amount of gas
needed to strip. It does so because the pressure drop distribution in the
standpipe changes.
Moving the SGIP can, therefore, reduce the amount of gas needed to strip
in a standpipe. For gas travelling down the standpipe, moving the SGIP closer
to the top of the standpipe reduces the amount of stripping gas needed.
For gas travelling up the standpipe, moving the SGIP towards the bottom
of the standpipe reduces the stripping gas requirement.
In actual practice, stripping efficiency may fall off if the SGIP is located too
close to the ends of the standpipe. This is because there may be a minimum
standpipe length necessary for complete stripping because of mixing,
diffusion, or other factors.
Stripping in Fluidized Standpipes
If Vs in a standpipe is greater than Vmf then the interstitial gas in the standpipe
cannot be stripped before the solids fluidize. Knowlton et al. (1981) described
Gas Down
A non-mechanical
valve is a device which uses only aeration gas in
conjunction with its geometrical shape to control the flowrate of particulate
solids through it. Non-mechanical
valves offer several advantages over
traditional mechanical valves:
(a) They have no moving mechanical parts which are subject to wear and/or
seizure.
(b) Constructed
sive.
of ordinary
Gas Up
When the standpipe section above the SGIP becomes fluidized for gas flowing
in Type 1 bubbling fluidized flow, complete stripping cannot be achieved. If
more stripping gas is added to the fluidized standpipe for this case, the
standpipe gas will be diluted by the bubbles of stripping gas. However, no
matter how much stripping gas is added, the initial interstitial standpipe gas
flowing upwards below the SGIP will continue to flow up the standpipe and
complete stripping will not occur. Thus, for the case of gas flowing initially up
the standpipe operating in the fluidized bed mode, the interstitial gas cannot
be stripped, only diluted.
Stripping Section Design
The minimum amount of stripping gas needed to strip interstitial gas in a
moving packed bed standpipe would be when vg = a initially in the standpipe.
inexpen-
(c) They can be fabricated 'inchouse', which avoids the long delivery times
often associated with the purchase or replacement of mechanical valves.
(d) They can be used to control or feed solids into either a dense phase or
dilute phase environment,
such as a fluidized bed or a pneumatic
conveying line (Fig. 12.30).
The three most commonly used types of non-mechanical valves are the Lvalve, J-valve, and the reverse seal. These three devices are shown
schematically in Fig. 12.31. The only difference between these devices are
their shape, the direction in which they discharge solids, and the distance
between the control aeration injection point and the solids discharge point.
All three devices operate on the same principle.
The most common of the non-mechanical valves is the L-valve (so named
because it is shaped like the letter 'L') because its shape is easiest to construct
and it is slightly more efficient than either the J-valve or the reverse seal.
Since the principle of operation is the same for all non-mechanical valves,
non-mechanical
valve operation will be presented primarily through a
discussion of the characteristics of the L-valve.
12.10.1
W
I-
<
0::
:3
o
-.J
i.l..
(f)
>~
d
(f)
THRESHOLD
AERATION
AERATION RATE,
m3/min
force on the particles in the direction of flow. When this drag force exceeds
the force needed to overcome the resistance to solids flow in the constricting
bend, the solids begin to flow through the valve.
The solids flow profile through a non-mechanical valve changes with the
solids flowrate through the valve. This is illustrated in Fig. 12.33 for the case
of the L-valve.
~I)I
LOW
t
\)
MEDIUM
J}
t
J\
)\
HIGH
~
STAGNANT
SOLIDS REGION
At low solids flowrates, the solids flow in a narrow zone near the inside of
the constricting elbow. Most of the solids in the elbow are stagnant. Similarly,
only a shallow upper layer of solids is moving in the horizontal section and the
solids appear to be moving in 'ripples' near the top of the pipe.
At the medium solids flowrate shown in Fig. 12.33, the stagnant region of
solids is much reduced. Also, a larger portion of the solids are now moving in
the horizontal section of the L-valve.
At high so Ids flowrates the entire mass of solids in the horizontal section of
the L-valve is in motion.
Non-mechanical
valves work best with Geldart B materials. These
are granular materials in the area shown on the Geldart fluidization diagram
of Fig. 3.4. Group C materials (cohesive materials such as flour) do not work
well in L-valves. In general, group C materials do not flow well in any type of
pipe and are even difficult to fluidize.
Group A materials (materials which have a substantial deaeration time)
also generally do not work well in L-valves. These materials retain air in their
interstices and remain fluidized for a significant period of time and thus often
flow uncontrollably through the L-valve like water.
Group D solids are very large solids with particle diameters generally 1/4 in
(6,350 Mm) or greater. These materials can be made to flow through an Lvalve, but the L-valve has to have a large diameter and much aeration has to
be used. The large Group D solids also work best in an L-valve if they are
mixed in with smaller material. The smaller particles fill up the void spaces
between the larger particles and decrease the voidage. This increases the drag
on the entire mass of solids when aeration is added and makes the solids
easier to move through the constricting bend.
From the above discussion it is seen that L-valves are best utilized with
granular material in the size range between 100 and about 8,000 Mm.
Knowlton and Hirsan (1978) and Knowlton, Hirsan, and Leung (1978)
have shown that the operation of a non-mechanical valve is dependent upon
system pressure drop and geometry. In general, a non-mechanical valve wilf
operate with an underflow standpipe operating in moving packed bed flow
above it. The standpipe in turn is usually attached to a hopper.
Consider the L-valve solids feed system shown in Fig. 12.34 with its
associated pressure drops. The aeration injection location is the high pressure
point in the system; the low pressure common point is at the top of the feed
hopper. The pressure drop balance is such that the sum of the L-valve,
fluidized bed, and piping pressure drops must equal the standpipe and hopper
pressure drops, Le.:
~Pstandpipe
~Phopper
= ~PL.valve
~Pbed
~Ppiping
(12.44)
The hopper pressure drop is usually negligible so that Eq. (12.41) may be
written as:
The standpipe is the dependent part of the pressure drop loop in that its
pressure drop will adjust to exactly balance the pressure drop produced by the
sum of the components on the independent side of the loop. However, there
.!s_~_Il1aximumpressure dr?!, p~r uni~ length (~P{ L) !pat ~h.e movIng'pac~~
('
. bed staIl.<!p.ip~.c~nde~~.19p. ThIS m~xImum value ISthe flUIdIzed bed pressure ~
drop'per unit length, (~P/L)mf,'Jor ~~@il?,
The independent pressure drop can be increased by increasing the bed
pressure drop (increasing the bed height), the piping pressure drop
The minimum
L . = .:lPindependent
mln
(.:lPIL)mf
The actual length of standpipe selected for the L-valve design should be
greater than Lmin to allow for the possibility of future increases in the solids
flow requirements and to act as a safety factor. Typical standpipe lengths
might be 1.5 to 2 times Lmin.
Knowlton and Hirsan (1978, 1980) and Knowlton (1979) have also shown
that the total aeration QT, which causes solids to flow through a non
mechanical valve, is not just the external aeration added to the valve. It is the
sum of the external aeration gas QA and the standpipe gas Qdc which
determines the solids flowrate through the valve. Thus, for gas travelling
down the standpipe with the solids:
~PBED
QT = QA
~
6PL-VALVE
~PSTANDPIPE
Qdc
QT = QA - Qdc
in Fig. 12.35.
Que
(increasing the gas flowrate), and the L-valve pressure drop (increasing the
solids flowrate). For a constant gas velocity and bed height, as the solids
flowrate into the bed is increased, the independent half of the pressure drop
loop increases. The standpipe pressure drop adjusts to balance this increase.
If the solids flowrate continues to increases, the standpipe pressure drop will
also keep increasing to balance the pressure drop on the independent side of
the loop. This will occur until the .:lPIL in the downcomer reaches (.:lPIL)mf'
Because of its lesser capacity to absorb pressure drop, a short standpipe will
reach its maximum .:lPIL at a lower solids flowrate than a longer standpipe.
Thus, the maximum solids flowrate through an L-valve depends on the length
of the standpipe above it.
The pressure drop in a standpipe is generated by the relative velocity Vr
between the gas and solids in the standpipe. When Vr reaches the value
necessary for minimum fluidization of the solids, a transition from a packed
bed flow to fluidized bed flow occurs. Any further increase in Vr results in the
formation of bubbles in the standpipe. These bubbles hinder the flow of solids
through the standpipe and thus decrease the solids flowrate.
(To
determine the minimum standpipe length necessary for an L-valve
V\\
\feeding into a fluidized bed, it is:necessary to know the pressure drop on the
~)
Ooc
t
OA
QA
~or
Or;
OA + QDe
~Qr
Or ; QA - QDe
Figure 12.35 Effective aeration flows in an L- valve for gas flowing up and gas flowing down
the standpipe.
value near 0.15 mls is generally selected to allow for substantial increases or
decreases in the solids flowrate, if necessary.
Unfortunately, at this time there are no published correlations to predict Lvalve pressure drop and aeration requirements. The best way to determine
these parameters is to estimate them from basic data from a small L-valve test
unit or to extrapolate them from the data given by Knowlton and Hirsan
(1978).
"-
0,..;
~
c
The minImum standpipe length and the L-valve diameter for an L-valve
feeding limestone into a fluidized bed from a hopper at a rate of 56,820 kg/h is
to be determined. The configuration for this feed system is the same as that
shown in Fig. 12.34 and:
v
ci
'"
z
(,J
q2
-
!i
a:
z
~
a:
ILl
~
In 'Ot
'"
<DO
oj::
~
a:
"-ILl
c;j~
ILl
>
..
c:
W
0
..
>
.2 ffiO
=.-
(!)~
In
on ci
U(Qvrt)
<D
<co
"'I'"
1-%
'ci" '"0
%
1>0<1
'Ot
i'!
c;j
W= Ph v,;A
0
0
0
'"
Q
4/ql
to
Ul
'Ot
SOIlOS
OJ
OJ
:>(;j
~
<Il
::l
I
..J
"-
OJ
0;
"-
0;::
I",
.~
d
.g
"eo...
III
II.
"
E
o~
1
v
ci
<Il
c:
.2
<Il
c;j
c:
ti
Ul..J
....
!!i
Ow"
% ":r'"
ct VI
VI ct
ffi ~
tt::O<C
ffi
To determine the L-valve diameter, first select a linear limestone velocity, vs,
in the standpipe. Choose Vs = 0.15 mls. Then:
- 0'
~ ~~.s ~ ~ ~
:.J %
~ 2
= 1,520 x 0.15A
0a:
<!l
56,820
3600
,
"!~
Ijw
ci
CD CI::.--
429 cm
.9
w c:e
00
--
-:JfI'
a ci0'"
~
~
(ilP/L)mf
c:
:'j
E
"
0
OJ
ILl
Lmin
,9
ilPindependent
~
c:
Q,
'E
,.,..
Given:
,9
<;;i
u
.2
<Il
"0
:.::l
0
CI'l
'Q
'"
M
..
~
=lOll
~
1rD2
A = -4-
56,820
3,600 x 1520 x 0.15
= 0.069
4
D2 = (0. ;69) - = 0.088
1r
0.296 m
0.97 ft
30 cm
12.10.2
V
L=-tan ex:
For design purposes the minimum horizontal length should actually be about
1.5L.
If the L-valve is designed properly, solids flow through it in micro pulses at a
relatively high frequency, and for all practical purposes the solids flow is
steady. For very long L-valve horizontal lengths, the solids flow becomes
intermittent (surging, stopping, then surging again). In these 'long' L-valves,
a dune builds up to such a size that it blocks the pipe and flow stops. Gas
pressure builds up behind the dune and finally becomes so great that the dune
collapses and the solids surge through the L-valve. Another dune then builds
up after the gas pressure is released. This pattern then repeats itself. This
cycle does not occur if the L-valve horizontal section length is kept below that
equal to an LID of about 12.
QA
1.\\\
W3
W2 >W\
< WI
H2
12.10.4
Automatic L-Valve
QA
L:
\\\\
~'1\
Ie)
(b)
in the standpipe above the L-valve will fall, decreasing the resistance to gas
flow, and a larger fraction of the constant aeration flow QA will pass up the
standpipe. The reduced flow of gas through the L-valve will result in a lower
solids flowrate. Balance is reached where solids are flowing through the Lvalve at rate W3 and the solids in the standpipe are at equilibrium height, H3
Very little work has been done with this type of L-valve system. Findlay
(1981) has shown that this type of L-valve operation is possible, but much
work will have to be done before the solids flowrate range and aeration
limitation over which the L-valve will operate automatically can be estimated
accurately.
12.11
SOLIDS FLOWRATE
ENHANCEMENT
FROM HOPPERS
PRESSURE,
em
H20
o
f-
0.2
(!J
W
..J
PIPE LENGTH,
z
<
60
f-
..0
50
a 523 fLm
.r.L
.....
173 fLm
0'
0 40
0
lD
o 87 fLm
20
PIPE DIAMETER,
....J
lL
-<:
0::
en
....
0
Cl
W
0.6
(em)
....
..J
N
47 (119)
<
6 135 (343)
L:
~
0
0.8
0 168 (427)
274 (696)
-80
-60
....
d
en
-40
PRESSURE,
0
10 ....J
lL
20
en
Cl
....J
in
X
W
f-
30
-<:
~
~
0
a0
1.5 in.
(3.8 em)
X
W
f-
CI)
PIPE LENGTH,
SAND SIZE
.r.L
.....
W
a..
a..
0.4
Figure 12.40
pipe system.
-20
20
40
in
stand-
Cl
10
en
0
30
60
80
120
PIPE LENGTH,
Figure 12.39
unconstrained
from a hopper
in
as a function of standpipe
length in an
For unrestricted standpipe flow, the solids flow through the pipe at a rate
faster than their discharge from the hopper, and a dilute phase streaming flow
results. The resulting profile in the hopper-standpipe
system with an
unconstrained standipe is shown in Fig. 12.40, for the case where the top of
the hopper and the bottom of the standpipe are both at atmospheric pressure.
When the standpipe is operating in dilute phase flow, a constant pressure
gradient over most of the standpipe length is developed. This produces a low
pressure region at the top of the standpipe immediately below the hopper
outlet. The longer the standpipe, the lower the pressure at the top of the
standpipe.
The decrease in pressure at the top of the standpipe causes the pressure
drop across the hopper outlet to increase. The gas flow through the particles
in the hopper then has to increase, which increases the solids f10wrate through
the hopper outlet.
Chen, Rangachari, and Jackson (1984), Judd and Dixon (1978), and Judd
and Rowe (1978) have also reported similar profiles in unrestricted
standpipes. Chen, Rangachari, and Jackson (1984) have also predicted the
flow profile and the increase in solids flowrate using their one-dimensional
mathematical model.
area
particle size
volumetric particle diameter
tube or pipe diameter
gas-wall friction factor
410
is
Fr
g
Og
Os
Hsp
L
P
ti.P
ti.PT
ti.PIL
(ti.PIL)mf
QT
Re
Rep
Sa
Ub
U
Uch
Usalt
Uso
Vch
Vg
Vmb
9.81 m/s2
kglm2 s
kglm2s
m
m
m
F!'
pressure
pressure drop
total pressure drop
pressure drop per unit length
pressure drop per unit length at minimum
fluidization
amount of aeration gas added to a non
mechanical valve
amount of gas flowing in the bl.lbble phase
amount of gas flowing in the dense phase
amount of gas flowing down or up a standpipe
relative to the sandpipe wall
amount of gas flowing around the L-valve bend
pipe Reynolds number, pgDUIp.
particle Reynolds number, pgdpUl p.
exponent indicative of the 'powderiness' of a solid
bubble rise velocity
superficial gas velocity
choking velocity, superficial
superficial saltation velocity
single particle saltation velocity
interstitial choking velocity, Uch/E
interstitial gas velocity, UIE
interstitial minimum bubbling velocity, Umbl E
N/m2
N/m2
N/m2
N/m3
rnIs
rnIs
rnIs
m/s
m/s
m/s
m/s
rnIs
m/s
Vr
Vs
solids velocity
m/s
Vmf
rnIs
m/s
m/s
kgls
N s/m2
kg/m3
kg/m3
kg/m3
m/s
Arastoopour, H., Modi, M.V., Punwani, D.V., and Talwalkar, A.T. (1979). Paper
presented at International Powder and Bulk Solids Conference/Exhibition,
Chicago.
Batholomew, R.N., and Casagrande, R.M. (1957). Ind. Eng. Chem., 49, 428--431.
Berg, C.H.O. (assigned to Union Oil Company of California) (1954a).
Berg, C.H.O. (assigned to Union Oil Company of California) (1954b). US Patent
2,684,870.
Berg, C.H.O. (assigned to Union Oil Company of California) (1954c) U.S. Patent
2,684,872.
Berg, C.H.O. (assigned to Union Oil Company of California) (1954d). US Patent
2,684,873.
Bodner, S. (1982). Proceedings of Pneumatech I, International Conference on
Pneumatic Conveying Technology, Powder Advisory Centre, London.
Campbell, D.L., Martin, H.Z., and Tyson, C.W. (1948). US Patent 2,451,803.
Canning, D.A., and Thompson, A.I. (1980). Paper presented at the Annual Meeting
of the American Institute of Mechanical Engineers, San Francisco.
Capes, C.E., and Nakamura, L. (1973). Can. J. Chem. Eng., 51, 31-38.
Chen, Y.M., Rangachari, S., and Jackson, R. (1984). To be presented in Ind. Eng.
Chem. Fund.
Culgan, J.M. (1962). Ph. D. Thesis, Georgia Institute of Technology.
Curran, G.P., and Gorin, E. (1968). Prepared for Office of Coal Research, Contract
No. 14-01-0001-415, Interim Report No.3, Book 6, Washington, DC.
Davidson, J.F., and Harrison, D. (1963). Fluidized Particles, Cambridge University
Press.
Institute of Gas Technology (1978). Coal Conversion Systems Technical Data Book,
Prepared for the US Department of Energy by the Institute of Gas Technology
under Contract No. EX-76-C-Q1-2286.
Doig, 1.D., and Roper, G.H. (1963). Australian Chern. Eng., 1, 9-19.
Dries, H.W.A. (1980). In Fluidization Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen, Plenum
Press, New York.
Eleftheriades, C.M., and Judd, M.R. (1978). Powder Technol., 21,217227.
Engineering Equipment Users' Association (1963). EEUA Handbook, No. 15,
Constable, London.
Findlay, J. (1981). Personal communication.
.
Flatt, W. (1976). Paper 43, Proceedings of Pneurnotransport 3, BHRA FlUid
Engineering, Bath.
.
Gajdos, L.J., and Bierl, T.W. (1978). Topical report prepared by CarnegIe-Mellon
University.
Geldart, D., (1973). Powder Technol, 7,285.
Ginestra, J.e., Rangachari, 1., and Jackson, R. (1980). Powder Technol., 27, 69.
Grace, J.R., and Tuot, J. (1979). Trans. Instn. Chern. Engrs., 57, 47.
Hinkle, B.L. (1953). Ph.D. Thesis, Georgia Institute of Technology.
Jones, P.L, and Leung, L.S. (1978). Ind. Eng. Chern. Proc. Des. & Dev., 17, 4.
Jones, P.L, Teo, C.S., and Leung, L.S. (1980). In Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and
J.M. Matsen), p. 469.
Judd, M.R., and Dixon, P.D. (1978). A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 74 (176), 38.
Judd, M.R., and Rowe, P.N. (1978). In Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L.
Keairns), Cambridge .University Press, p.110.
Jung, R. (1958) Forschung Ing. Wes., 24 (2), 50.
.
Knowlton, T.M. (1977). Institute of Gas Technology Project IU-4-8 Annual Report
for 1977, Sponsored by American Gas Association.
Knowlton, T.M. (1979). Proceedings of Powder and Bulk Solids Conference/
Exhibition, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.
Knowlton, T.M. (1980). Proceedings of the 6th International Conference on FluidizedBed Combustion, Atlanta, Georgia.
Knowlton, T.M., Aquino, C., Hirsan, 1., and Sishtla, C. (1981). A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp.
Ser., 77 (205), 189.
Knowlton, T.M., and Bachovchin, D.M. (1976). In Fluidization Technology (Ed.
D.L. Keairns), Hemisphere Publications Corporation.
Knowlton, T.M., and Hirsan, 1. (1978). Hydrocarbon Processing, 57,149-156.
Knowlton, T.M., and Hirsan, 1. (1980). Paper E3, Proceedings of Pneurnotransport 5,
BHRA Fluid Engineering, London, p. 257.
Knowlton, T.M., Hirsan, 1., and Leung, L.S. (1978). In Fluidization (Eds J.F.
Davidson, D.L Keairns), Cambridge University Press.
Kojabashian, C. (1958). Ph.D. Thesis, Massachusetts Institute of Technology,
Cambridge, Massachusetts.
Konno, H., and Saito, S.J. (1969). Chern. Eng. Japan, 2,211-17.
.
Leung, L.S., and Jones, P.J. (1976). In Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Kemrns),
Vol. II, Hemisphere Publishing Corporation, Washington, De..
.
.
Leung, L.S. (1980). Proceedings of Pneurnotransport, 5, BHRA FlUIdEngmeenng,
London.
Leung, L.S., and Jones, P.J. (1978a). Paper Dl, Proceedings of Pneurnotransport 4
Conference, BHRA Fluid Engineering.
Leung, L.S., and Jones, P.J. (1978b). Powder Tech., 20,145--160.
Leung, L.S., and Jones, P.J. (1978c). In Fluidization (Eds. J.F. Davidson and D.L.
Keairns), Cambridge University Press.
Leung, L.S. and Wiles, R.J. (1976). Paper C4-47-58 , Presented at Pneumotransport
3 Conference, University of Bath.
Leung, L.S., Wiles, R.J., and Nicklin, D.J. (1971a). Ind. Eng. Chern. Proc. Des. &
Dev., 2, (10), 183-189.
Leung, L.S., Wiles, R.J., and Nicklin, D.J. (1971b). Paper presented at Pneumotransport 1 Conference, Churchill College, Cambridge.
Leung, L.S., and Wilson, L.A. (1973). Powder Techno!., 7, 343.
Marcus, R.D., Hilbert, J.D., Jr., and Klinzing, G.E. (1984). Pipelines, 4, 103-112.
Matsen, J.M., (1973). Powder Technol., 7, 93.
Matsen, J.M. (1976). In Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Keairns), Vol II,
Hemisphere Publishing Corporation, Washington, DC, p. 135.
Matsen, J.M. (1981). Proceedings of the 73rd Annual AIChE Meeting, New Orleans.
Matsumoto, S., Hara, M., Saito. S., and Maeda, S. (1974a). J. Chern. Eng. Japan. 7
(6), 425-30,
Matsumoto, S., Harada, S., Saito, S., and Maeda, S. (1974b). 1. Chern. Eng. Japan. 8,
331.
Mewing, S.F. (1976). B.Eng. Thesis, University of Queensland.
Morikawa, Y., Tsuji, Y., Matsuik, J., and Hani, Y. (1978). Int. J. Multiphase Flow, 4,
575.
Patterson, R.e. (1959). ASME J. Engineering for Power, 1959, 43-54.
Punwani, D.V., Modi, M.V., and Tarman, P.B. (1976). Paper presented at the
International Powder Bulk Solids Handling and Processing Conference, Chicago.
Richards, P.C., and Wiersma, S. (1973). Paper A1-1-15, Presented at Pneumotransport 2 Conference, Guildford.
Rizk, f. (1973). Doktor-Ingenieurs Dissertation, Technische Hochschule Karlsruhe.
Rose, H.E., and Duckworth, R.A. (1969). Engineer, 227,392-396,430-433,478-483.
Sandy, e.W., Daubert, T.E., and Jones, J.H. (1970). Chern. Eng. Prog. Syrnp. Ser.,
66, 105, 133-142.
Sauer, R.A., Chan, 1.H., and Knowlton, T.M. (1984). A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 80
(234), 1-23.
Saxton, A.L., and Worley, A.C. (1970). Oil and Gas. J .. 1971,92-99.
Schuchart, P. (1968). 1. Chern. E. V.D.1.N.Y.G. Symposium on the Engineering of
Gas-Solids Reaction, Brighton.
Scott, A.M., Richard, P.D., and Mooij, A. (1976). Paper DI0, presented at
Pneumotransport 3 Conference, Bath.
Smith, T.N. (1978). Chemical Eng. Sci., 33, 745.
Thomas, D.G. (1962). A. U. Ch.E.J., 8 (3), 363-378.
Tsuji, Y. (1980). Paper H2, Proceedings of the 5th International Conference on the
Pneumatic Transport of Solids in Pipes, BHRA Fluid Engineering, Cranfield,
Bedford, pp. 363-388.
Van Zoonen, D. (1961). Proceedings of the Symposium on the Interaction between
Fluids and Particles, Inst. Chemical Engineers, London, p.64.
Weidner, G. (1955). Forschung Ing. Wes., 21 (5), 145.
Wen, C.Y., and Galli, A.F. (1971). In Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.
Harrison), Academic Press, London.
Wen, e.Y. and Simons, H.P. (1959). A.I.Ch.E.J., 5 (2), 263-267.
Woebcke, H.N., and Cofield, W.W. (1978). Coal Processing Technol., 3, 79.
Woodcock, e.R., and Mason, J.S. (1976). Paper El, Pneumotransport 3 Conference,
Bath.
Yang, W.C. (1975). A.I.Ch.E.J.,
21, 1013-1015.
Yang, W.e. (1976a). Paper presented at Pneumotransport 3 Conference, Bath.
Yang, w.e. (1976b). Paper presented at the International Powder and Bulk Solids
Handling and Processing Conference/Exhibition, Chicago.
Yang, W.e. (1982). Paper presented at the 74th A.I.Ch.E. Annual Meeting, Los
Angeles, California.
Yerushalmi, J., Turner, D.H., and Squires, A.M. (1976). Ind. Eng. Chern. Proc. Dev.
& Dec., 15, 47-53.
Yousfi, Y., and Gau, G. (1974). Chern. Eng. Sci., 29, 1939-1946.
Zenz, F.A. (1964). Ind. Chern. Fund., 3, 65-75.
Zenz, F.A. (1984). Paper presented at Katalistiks Symposium, Vienna, Austria.
Zenz, F.A., and Othmer, D.F. (1960). Fluidization and Fluid-Particle Systems,
Reinhold, New York.
Zenz, F.A., and Rowe, P.N. (1976). In Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Keairns),
Vol. II, Hemisphere Publishing Corporation, Washington, DC, p.151.
Instrumentation and
Experimental Techniques
In order to design a fluid bed system, the engineer should be fully familiar
with the characteristics of the powder to be handled. As a first step, one
should check the Geldart classification of the powder (see Chapter 3). As a
minimum requirement,
hydrodynamic
equivalence between laboratory
powders and process materials requires that they be in the same classification.
The extrapolation of results for material in one powder group to another is
not advised.
Particle size and density are, however, not the only important parameters.
415
Powder parameter
Agglomeration or cohesive
properties
13.2.1 Components
The components of the gas supply system are shown schematically in Fig.
13.1. The blower or compressor must be capable of supplyingsufficientgas to
the column to give a superficial velocity of at least 1 to 2 mls and preferably 3
m/s. For studies of circulating beds and fast fluidization, velocities of 5 to 12
mls should be attainable. In the latter case, the air should be split into a
primary and secondary stream whose relative flows are in the range of
.1
.1
..
1
1
1
1
approximately 5:1 to 1:3, and minor amounts of air will also be required for
aeration of recirculating solids. The primary pressure losses in the system are
those across the bed of particles, the distributor, and any valves. Allowance
should be made for losses across cyclones, filters, and flow measuring devices
as well as pipes, fittings, and noise-abatement devices.
Pressure pulsations arising from the blower can alter fluidization behaviour. For many purposes, elements giving pressure drops upstream of the
bed provide sufficient damping of these pulsations. A reservoir may be used
to provide further damping, as shown in Fig. 13.1. A filter should be installed
to remove oil and water droplets. A surge tank and filter are not required if
the blower or compressor is replaced by one or more pressurized gas
cylinders. However, these gas bottles are only practical for small columns and
limited running times.
Shown next on Fig. 13.1 is a loop which permits the incoming gas to be
humidified or dehumidified to a desired level. In cases where humidity
control is not necessary (e.g. for large dry particles), it may be possible to do
without part or all of this loop. The pressure regulator shown in the diagram
is set at the calibration pressure of the rotameters. To minimize fluctuations
in float level due to pressure oscillations in the fluidized bed, the calibration
level should be as high as possible, consistent with the capability of the blower
or compressor. The rotameter valves should be downstream as shown in Fig.
13.1, so that the rotameter calibration can be used directly without having to
correct for pressure.
13.2.2
Leak testing
There are two ways to evaluate gas leaking under pilot plant conditions. The
pressure drop method involves completely sealing the unit which is then
pressurized. After turning off the gas, the decrease in pressure is noted as a
function of time. Alternatively, in the pressure hold-up method, the rate of
gas addition to maintain the unit at the required pressure is recorded.
To locate points of leakage, the soap bubble method is usually employed.
Special gas tracers can also be used and localized with special detectors. To
test equipment components for leakage of process gases, other methods are
available such as the use of special emission detectors.
Aside from the fluidization column, process valves account for most
leakage; safety relief valves and sample points should be carefully checked.
Leakage from piping and flanges is generally minor. The remaining sources of
leakage are the blower or compressor, dedusting equipment, etc. Leak
tightness becomes more critical as the size and density of the powder
decrease, since a small leak has a much greater proportional effect for
powders of low Umf
characteristics
of
While two-dimensional columns are useful for qualitative purposes, there are
important quantitative
differences between two- and three-dimensional
fluidized beds. These arise from quantitative differences in rise velocities of
..,.
'C
""
~:O~~og
(""",
x -
B("I"'l
ON
CN"""
~"'(/)~~~tr)~ _8
\(")("'I~~lr}
'"
_z~8
x
C"'!V"l
XV1XV")V1X
OO-X
xZZXXXXX~X
-N:x:("'-i:r""l
XXI"'"!
"1"XXI.Q("")V')("')("'jX_
q.-;XX~""';lI!~
"":NV'"lO"':"";"';""':_-n
("Itn-
..r.X"':XX.o
XXNNX("'.lXX
....
X--
Xv: XIJ"lV: X
X X X X X LI1X
~t.r.OO~
..c(""">""'J'"M("""';OC
Alr)~~~g~~
(a) Materials of construction. The front and rear faces should be transparent
and are generally of plastic or armour glass. Plastic materials are cheaper
and easier to work with, but are more subject to scratching, discoloration, and electrostatic effects. The spacers separating the front and rear
plates may be of any material, but it is best that the entire inside surface
of the column be of uniform roughness and electrical properties. Special
construction techniques are required to make two-dimensional columns
suitable for studying fluidization at elevated pressures (Subzwari, Clift,
and Pyle, 1978; Varadi and Grace, 1978; Kawabata et al., 1981).
(b) Distributor and windbox. The column should be supported in such a way
that the windbox-distributor
assembly can be removed in order to
replace the distributor, repair leaks, or make other modifications. The
most popular types of distributor are perforated plates, porous plates,
and supported filter paper or cloth. The pressure drop across the
distributor should be designed to be approximately 10 to 50 per cent. of
that across the bed of particles. In order to improve the uniformity of gas
flow across the distributor, the wind box maybe partitioned, with the flow
to each section of the distributor measured and controlled separately. It
is essential to provide an effective seal around the outside of the
distributor plate to prevent gas from short-circuiting up the walls. A
pressure relief valve may be installed in the windbox to prevent the
pressure from exceeding its design maximum. Alternatively, a V-tube
manometer can be used for this purpose, with the manometer fluid
discharged if the pressure in the windbox is excessive.
(c) Alignment.
(d) Reinforcement. The front and rear faces tend to bulge, due to hydrostatic
pressure forces inside the fluidized bed. Consequently, it is usually
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
of semi-
full cylindrical column. In this case, front illumination is required for bubble
viewing and photography, since bubbles generally do not span the entire bed
thickness. *
While this geometry is very popular and generally reliable in spouted bed
studies (Mathur and Epstein, 1974; Whiting and Geldart, 1980; Geldart et
al., 1981), its use for fluidized beds has been restricted. Hatate, King, Migita,
and Ikari (1985) describe its use for bubble visualization. Gabor (1972)
employed this geometry in some heat transfer work. Levy et al. (1983) studied
particle ejection mechanisms at the bed surface in a half-column. Yang et al.
(1984) have studied jet penetration and bubble properties in a large (3 m
diameter) semicircular vessel with a conical grid. However, Rowe, MacGillivray, and Cheesman (1979) found that flat surfaces alter the behaviour of
grid jets as compared with the case where the jet is centred in a fully
cylindrical vessel. Hence, there is some doubt about how accurately
semicylindrical columns represent the behaviour in fully cylindrical vessels.
13.3.3
Most laboratory and pilot scale fluidized beds are cylindrical. Square and
rectangular cross-sections are also quite common, especially when horizontal
'Bubbles sometimes move away from the face, thus negating the purpose of the unit. It is
therefore useful to slightly tilt the unit so that bubbles 'run up' the face.
tubes are required. The full cylindrical column has the virtues of simplicity
and structural strength. Standard steel, glass, and perspex tubes are readily
suited to construction of small-scale columns.
Although early work in the field of fluidization was often performed in
smaller diameter columns, it now seems to be generally accepted that there is
a minimum diameter of about 0.10 m below which results tend to be
misleading. Smaller columns almost always give rise to slugging, while
bridging and electrostatic effects may also be severe. In no case should the
column diameter be less than 100 times the mean particle diameter. The
upper extreme of laboratory column diameter is about 0.6 m. This is also a
useful size for pilot plant units, large enough to allow useful data to be
obtained and to aIlow a man to work inside, and yet small enough to avoid
excessive fabrication, materials handling, and blower costs. The influence of
bed diameter on bubble size and the onset of slug flow are treated in
Chapter 4.
The usual scale-up or scale-down procedure for fluidized beds is to keep the
height fixed while varying the diameter (and hence the aspect ratio) (Grace,
1974). The distributor of the smaller column should be identical (i.e. a
portion of that from the full-scale unit rather than a scaled-down replica).
Transparent
sections or windows should be included if possible. The
windbox-distributor
assembly should be removable, and safety valves should
be provided in case of excessive pressures. A port should be provided just
above the distributor for emptying the solids, and pressure taps should be
installed at 0.1 to 0.2 m intervals. The height of fluidization columns varies
widely, from approximately 1 m for the smallest laboratory units to 20 m or
more for pilot plants and full-scale vessels. Entrainment may be reduced by
providing a tapered, expanding freeboard. The angle of taper must be greater
than the angle of repose so that solids do not lodge on the sloping section.
Space restrictions and the need for accessibility usually dictate that cyclones
in small-scale units be external rather than internal. The superficial velocity
range over which the cyclone operates effectively can be extended by
installing a hinged flapper at the inlet to the cyclone to vary the inlet width
and gas velocity. SmaIl diameter multiclones are available commercially.
Collected solids should be returned to the bed just above the distributor, with
the standpipe to be not less than 50 mm in diameter. Circulating bed columns
should be at least 6 m tall, with the solids returned to the main column by a
solids seal, e.g. by an L-valve, J-valve, or (slow) fluidization section.
13.3.4
Wall Roughness
particles can slide or roll freely along smooth walls. As a result, roughened
walls can promote arching or bridging of particles.
Since wall effects are unlikely to be significant in large columns, laboratoryscale columns should be smooth walled. Offsets, protruding tubes, recesses,
etc., which could act as wall roughness elements, should be minimized.
13.3.5
13.3.7
The following conclusions can be drawn from the literature (Loeb, 1958;
Harper; Richardson and McLeman, 1960; Soo, Ihring, and El Kouh, 1960;
Torobin and Ga.uvin, 1961; Boland and Geldart, 1971/72):
(a) Particulate systems exhibit charging as a result of particle-particle
and
particle-wall rubbing. The latter becomes more important for units of
large wall area (e.g. two-dimensional beds) and fine particles. Both
positive and negative charged particles are present and there is some
evidence that the air stream may hold a balance of charge.
(b) During fluidization, strong electrostatic forces are likely to be set up in
beds of dielectric particles (see Lewis, Gilliland, and Bauer, 1949; Miller
and Logwinuk, 1951; Davies and Robinson, 1960; Ciborowski and
Wlodarski, 1962; and Katz and Sears, 1969). The charges may alter the
fluidization characteristics leading to increased pressure drops, decreased
bed expansion, and a general trend towards aggregative behaviour or
even channelling conditions.
To eliminate static electrification
effects, differenttechniques
can be used:
(a) The use of humid air (60 to 70 per cent. relative humidity) has been
shown to increase the conductivities of insulators. Generated charges in
the fluidized bed are thus neutralized or conducted to earth.
(b) Insulating surfaces can be treated
Gabor, 1967) or with a layer of
dimensional columns. Electrically
metallic coatings are now available
At one time it was common practice to use porous plates (e.g. sintered
bronze, sintered plastic, or woven stainless steel) as distributors in laboratoryscale fluidized beds. This practice has declined for the following reasons:
. VA
CdnorAor
j2t.P
--
Pg
where Cd is a discharge coefficient which can usually be assigned the value of
0.6 (Kunii and Levenspiel, 1969). The ratio of t.po to the pressure drop
across the bed should be in the range of 0.1 to 0.5, with the higher value
advisable for materials which are difficult to fluidize, shallow beds
(HID < 0.5), and applications which are sensitive to bubble size such as
certain chemical reactions. For most' purposes, a value of 0.3 is quite
sufficient. An equation for calculating the ratio of distributorlbed pressure
drop has been proposed by Sathiyamoorthy and Rao (1981). The holes should
be uniformly distributed across the plate. The size of hole is governed by a
compromise between competing factors:
(a) Small orifices, especially those smaller than about 1 mm in diameter, are
difficult and expensive to drill or punch.
(b) Better performance is usually given by a large number of small holes than
a small number of large holes having the same free cross-sectional area.
The usual hole diameter adopted in experimental fluidized beds is in the
range 1 to 6 mm.
Fakhimi and Harrison (1970) proposed a criterion for keeping all grid holes
unblocked and in operation. In small-scale units, hole blockage and backflow
of solids can be prevented by stretching a piece of cloth or wire mesh over the
perforated plate. The cloth or screen is sometimes put on the underside of the
plate. This prevents backflow of solids, but is not as effective in preventing
hole blockage.
Other types of distributor which may be useful in the laboratoy include:
(a) Filterpaper, cloth, or screens sandwiched between commercially available punched plates, the plates typically having a free cross-sectional area
of about 30 per cent.
(b) A shallow packed bed of heavy particles (e.g. lead shot) supported on a
screen or on a plate of high free cross-sectional area. For the advantages
of this type of distributor, see Hengl, Hiquily, and Couderc (1977).
Use of a low pressure, drop screen as the sole gas distributor is not
recommended. Similarly, single-orifice plates should not be used except for
spouted beds.
When a small-scale pilot-scale unit is to be the basis for scale-up, the
distributor should be a full-size portion of that in a larger unit, not a scaleddown version. For design of grids for large-scale fluidized beds, see Chapter 4
and the recent paper by Geldart and Baeyens (1985).
13.5.1
Photographic Techniques
Cine photography has been one of the chief techniques which has been used to
investigate bubble behaviour and particle motion in fluidized beds. Four
different set-ups have been employed:
(a) Two-dimensional columns, generally viewed with the aid of back lighting
as shown in Fig. 13.2
(b) X-ray or y-ray photography of three-dimensional
and Carpenter, 1971; Rowe, 1971)
(c) Three-dimensional columns photographed from the side through the wall
or semi-cylindrical columns (see Section 13.3.32) photographed using
front lighting
(d) Three-dimensional columns photographed from above with the aid of top
lighting
Each of these has its limitations. Two-dimensional
fluidized beds give
quantitative differences from three-dimensional beds, as discussed in Section
13.3.1. For X-ray photography, the maximum bed thickness is of order 0.2 m,
and gas flowrates must be modest to allow identification of individual
bubbles. Normal photography of three-dimensional beds only yields information about the behaviour at the wall, which is generally not representative
of behaviour in the interior. Photography from above requires low gas
flow rates in order that the bed surface should not be obscured by particles
ejected into the freeboard. Despite these limitations, each of these methods
has yielded some useful data within the constraints mentioned (Lyall, 1969).
For bubbling fluidized beds, bubble and maximum particle velocities are of
order 1 m/s. To obtain resolution within 1 mm therefore requires a shutter
speed of about 10-3 s or better: Most cine photography of bubbling fluidized
beds has been at speeds of 24 to 80 frames/s, with frame exposure times
ranging from 0.02 to 0.002 s. Hence, there is some inherent ambiguity in
defining the position of individual particles or bubble boundaries. Sharper
resolution can be obtained with high speed photography.
High speed
photography is also required to view high velocity beds where superficial
velocities exceed 3 m/s.
.J'>.
VJ
Table 13.4
Reference
Gerald
Example
Type
Piezoelectric
(1951)
crystal
Hot wire
Capacitance
Capacitance
Light transmission
Dotson
Capacitance
Lanneau
Fukuda,
Capacitance
(1960)
Asaki, and Kondo (1967)
Capacitance
Capacitance
Light transmission
Electroresistivity
Pitot tube
Cranfield
Inductance
(1972)
Capacitance
Piezoelectric
Calderbank,
(1976)
Resistivity
Pereira,
and Burgess
in fluidization
research
Details
Osberg (1951)
(1959)
of probes
Capacitance
"--------
Property
measured
Particle impacts
Bed level
Uniformity of fluidization
Local void fraction
Bubble properties
(J)
'T1
Uniformity
of bed density
S
0
N
Local voidage fluctuations
Bed uniformity, bubble
properties
Bubble frequency
Bubble properties
Bubble frequency, volume
fraction, pierced length
Jet momentum
-l
0:z
-l
m
()
:r:
:z
0
r
-<
Bubble properties
Bubble properties
Particle collision frequency
and amplitude
Bubble properties
Bubble properties,
transfer
mass
._---~---
Light transmission
Capacitance and
suction
Optical
Ishida, Hishiwaki,
Light reflectance
transmission
Mayhofcr
Capacitance
Light reflectance
Thermocouples
Vines (1977)
Masson and Jottrand
Okhi, Ishida,
Thermistor
Light transmission
(1978)
and Lindqvist
Fibre optic
Impact
Flemmer
Pneumatic: jet
impingement
UV light absorption
(1984)
(1982)
(1984)
and McAndrews
(1985)
Thermistor
Z
(J)
Bubble properties
Velocity and direction of
particle flow; diameter
and velocity of bubbles
Gives image showing jets and
bubbles
Detluidization of
agglomerating solids
Local instantaneous oxygen
concentration
Local particle velocities
-l
:>J
c:
I:::
m
:z
-l
::J
:z
:z
tJ
tl1
."
m
;>:I
:
tl1
Bubble properties
Velocities and concentrations
of particles in jet region
Void detection, bubble
properties
Concentration
of tracer gas
Downward
velocity of particles
:z
-l
-l
tl1
()
:r:
:z
0
c:
tl1
(J)
Because fluidized beds are opaque and behaviour near the walls is often not
representative
of that in the interior, many workers have inserted probes to
obtain local property measurements. A partial listing of these probes appears
in Table 13.4, and some sketches showing probe geometries are given in
Figure 13.3. For earlier reviews of probes in fluidized beds see Dutta and
Wen (1979) and Fitzgerald (1979).
The following characteristics are required of immersed probes (Werther
and Molerus, 1973):
(a) Minimal disturbance of the bed
(b) Measurement
of local properties
strength
i.e. it should be possible to relocate the probe
Compatibility
Almost all of the probes employed in fluidized studies have been unique
'homemade'
devices, rather than items which can be purchased from
suppliers. Many of the probes have distinguished between times when a small
measuring volume is devoid of particles and when particles are present. The
physical property used to discriminate between dense phase and dilute phase
.~
QJ
L :;
0'0
:.:
III
00.
-:;::
_"5
-,E
;~
.-
nQ
II
II
L.!..,
""
probe than large ones. Probes near the wall of the column, horizontal
supports, and multi-prong probes were shown to cause severe interference.
These observations can be used as a guide to designing probes for fluidized
beds. Generally speaking, vertical supports are preferable to horizontal
supports. The probe itself should be as small and have as few elements as
possible. The supporting tube should be suspended from above where
possible and at least 30 particle diameters in from the wall of the column. The
support should be sufficiently rigid to withstand the buffetting action of the
bed with minimal vibration. Geldart and Kelsey (1972) showed the
importance of support geometry with respect to whether or not bubble
splitting is induced. Their photographs showed that capacitance detector
plates, mounted directly on the bottom of an 8 mm diameter suport tube at
right angles to the tube, caused bubble splitting and some adherence to the
tube. Considerably less interference occurred if the plates were offset from
the tube by means of a short, smaller diameter tube inclined at an angle of 45
to the horizontal, as shown in Fig. 13.5(c). Conversely, Rowe and Masson
(1981) found a disturbing lack of agreement when comparing bubble heights
and velocities measured by X-rays and measured by a light probe. On the
other hand, Lord et al. (1982) checked their optical probe data against video
records of a two-dimensional bed and found that the probe could be used to
provide accurate data. Gunn and AI-Doori (1985) found that proper signal
processing and noise discrimination were of critical importance in obtaining
accurate data from probes. Caution is clearly required in the use of probe
data.
When a probe consists of two parts separated by a gap, e.g. a light source
and photodetector or two plates forming a capacitor, the gap width should be
sufficient to allow particles to circulate freely through the gap. For rounded
particles of narrow size distribution, this requires a gap width of at least 20 to
30 mean particle diameters. Somewhat larger gap widths are required for
angular particles or for powders having broad size distributions.
13.5.3
transversely,
bubbles can be formed along its entire length (Rowe and
Everett, 1972). X-ray photographs (Rowe and Masson, 1980, 1981) have
shown that probes can cause bubbles to elongate, to accelerate along the
support, to deflect sideways, to flatten prior to reaching the probe, and to
split. Small bubbles were found to be more subject to disturbance by the
13.5.4
as discus-
Quantity
Method/principle
measured
Solids circulation
and velocity
X-ray photography
Drag force or impact of
particles upon piezoelectric
crystal
Rotation of small impeller
Segregation
(1980)
Local velocity
Local velocity
Tracking of radioactive
particles
Guinn (1956)
Kondukov (1964)
Littman (1964)
Van Velzen el ai. (1974)
Masson, Jottrand and Dang Tran
(1978)
Lin, Chen, and Chao (1985)
Tracking of radiopill
tracer
Thermistor probe
Response curves using
magnetic tracer
Schulz-Walz (1974)
Okhi, Walawender, and Fan (1977)
Okhi etai. (1980)
Patrose and Caram (1982)
Glicksman and McAndrews (1985)
Woollard and Potter (1968)
Kamiya (1955)
Yagi and Kunii (1961)
Radioactive
tracer
Fluorescent
tracer
Guinn (1956)
Qin and Liu (1982)
Morooka, Kayo, and Kato
Ferromagnetic tracer
and inductance
patterns
Avidan (1980)
Local velocity
Local velocity
RTD C(I) curve
(e) The rate of collapse of the bed surface after interrupting the gas flow to
the bed can be used to estimate the voidage of the dense phase (Rietema,
1967; Geldart and Abrahamsen, 1980; and Chapter 2).
(f) Sound emission from the column may allow an experienced operator to
identify slugging conditions or stick-slip flow.
(g) Heat flux probes or temperature-sensitive
hot spots and refractory damage.
13.6.1
Typical references
Stimulus-response
Diffusion-type
(dispersion)
Overall Approaches
Technique
Two-phase or
two-region
models
Ernst, Loughnane, and Bertrand (1979) describe a simple device for sampling
in-bed solids during operation of the Exxon coal combustion 'miniplant'. A
closed stainless steel pipe was made to slide within an open-ended close
tolerance pipe by means of pneumatic pistons. Particles enter when the inner
pipe is slid outwards exposing a small hole near the closed end. These
particles are pushed into a storage vessel outside the combustor by the
13.7.1
Overall Approaches
The flow pattern of gas in a fluidized bed has been studied both by steady!
unsteady state tracer techniques and by calculations based on reactor
performances using reactor models. Results have been expressed by means of
13.8
Experimental fluidized bed reactors range from simple tubes fitted with a
porous distributor to highly sophisticated pieces of equipment requiring
specialized design. Key requirements in planning a reactor are: (a) to make
sufficient provision for instrumentation that useful data can be obtained; (b)
to foresee possible problems and modifications and make the reactor flexible
enough to allow these to be solved or accommodated. It is always more
difficult, for example, to add sampling ports after a reactor is operating than
to incorporate additional ports at the design stage, especially for pressurized
reactors which are subject to special safety codes and inspections. Table 13.7
lists some common problems that arise in fluidized bed reactors and suggests
what can be done at the design stage or during operation to solve these
problems.
Since their hydrodynamics are not well understood (see Chapter 11),
fluidized beds are usually not in themselves suitable for obtaining kinetic
information. If heats of reaction are sufficiently small that reaction under
isothermal conditions can be achieved, packed beds can be used to generate
the required kinetic data. For larger heats of reaction, spinning basket
reactors are often useful. The kinetic data obtained must cover not only the
full range of temperature to be encountered in the fluidized bed reactor but .
also the full range of concentrations. Because conversion in the dense phase
tends to be much higher than that in the bubble phase, this means obtaining
kinetic data under high conversion conditions if reactor models are to be
tested.
Methods for measuring gas and solids concentrations by sampling and by
in-bed probes are outlined in earlier sections of this chapter. Many reactions
carried out in fluidized beds are highly exothermic or involve substances
which are potentially explosive. Monitors and alarms are commonly required
for in-bed temperature, pressure, flowrates, and concentrations of key
components to keep the reactor within safe limits. The integrity of refractory
should be checked at regular intervals, and the reactor shell should be
investigated for hot spots during operation. Pressure relief valves or rupture
discs should be provided and checked regularly. The refractory should be
designed to withstand sudden reactor depressurization.
13.9
Table 13.7
Problem
Increase gas velocity; ensure uniform distributor; avoid
closely spaced internals; return solids from cyclone near grid
Install screens over holes; ensure high velocity gas entry;
provide for removable or accessible grid
Design removable grid; ensure high distributor pressure
drop; install screens to avoid hole blockage
Provide vibration pads; install surge tank between blower and
bed; vary gas flowrate; introduce baffles to break up slugs;
furnish viewing ports to observe bed
Avoid jet impingement; consider antiabrasion pads; decrease
gas velocity
Avoid jet impingement; decrease gas velocity
Attrition
Humidify incoming gas; use antistatic agents; connect entire
Electrostatic charges
column to ground
Alter temperature; dry incoming gas; increase gas velocity;
avoid dead regions; improve atomization of liquid feed (if
any); stir bed contents or add ultrasonic vibration; add inert
solids
Avoid horizontal and shallow surfaces; dry incoming gases;
alter temperature and/or gas velocity
Prevent dead regions near grids; ensure that adjacent internal
Hot spots, overheating,
surfaces are at least 30 particle diameters apart; increase gas
danger of explosion
velocity; increase or provide more uniform cooling
Change total transfer surface area or driving force; preheat
Extinguishing of
feed gas or solids
reaction
Change operating conditions (e.g. temperature, pressure,
Low conversion or
unwanted side reactions feed composition, gas velocity); use improved catalyst;
provide more uniform distributor; introduce baffles;
introduce quenching in freeboard
Add cyclone in parallel or series; reduce attrition (as
detailed); lower gas velocity or pressure; introduce baffles
just above or below bed surface; furnish viewing ports;
provide expanding freeboard
Test for leaks; operate under negative pressure; enclose
Escape of noxious
column
fumes or dust
Increase dipleg diameter; heat trace dipleg; avoid bends and
Blockage of dipleg
inclined portions containing dense phase flow
Avoid erosion and vibration (as detailed); choose tube
materials with corrosion and erosion in mind, taking account
of local concentration fluctuations; allow for thermal
expansion; increase tube support
Avoid bends; increase inlet size: dilute feed with inert
particles; aerate feed; consider alternate feed method
(e.g. screw feeding, pneumatic feeding)
Avoid attrition, solid deposits, and hot spots (as detailed);
Failure to reach
preheat feed; improve heat transfer and insulation; provide
steady state
more reliable feed system for solids and liquid (if any)
Solids segregation
single cyclone over a period of time. These particles were then weighed and
sieved. This technique has a number of disadvantages:
(a) It assumes perfect collection in the cyclone.
(b) Since fines are not returned to the bed during the period of collection,
bed properties change with time.
(c) No information is given on the hold-up of solids in the freeboard.
Merrick and Highley (1972)accounted for essentially all of the particles carried
over by adding a second cyclone and sampling the stack gases. Blyakher and
Pavlov (1966) allowed entrained particles to be carried over and used the
weight change to determine the total entrainment. Changes in bed composition
with time may be minimized by ensuring that the mass of solids collected is
much less than the total mass of solids in the bed or that the time of sampling
is less than the particle cycle time.
Techniques used to determine the hold-up of solids in the freeboard include
static pressure profiles (e.g. Nazemi, Bergougnou, and Baker, 1974),
attenuation of a laser beam (Horio et ai., 1980), and butterfly or disc valves
which trap the suspended solids (e.g. Geldart and Pope, 1978). The static
pressure method has the disadvantage that frictional losses and particle
deceleration, in addition to the hold-up of solids and gas, contribute to the
measured pressure drop, making it difficult to determine the hold-up
accurately by this method. The trapping valves are only useful if they can be
closed very quickly and if they do not disturb the flow in the freeboard when
not in service. Static pressure drops are also commonly used to measure
suspension densities in circulating beds. A single porous butterfly valve in.the
return vessel has been used by a number of investigators beginning with
Yerushalmi, Turner, and Squires (1976) to determine solids circulation rates
in circulating bed systems.
To determine the transport disengaging height experimentally, the flux of
solids should be measured. Since the flux tends to vary with radial position as
well as with height, both radial and axial profiles are required. Fournol,
Bergougnou, and Baker (1873) employed an isokinetic suction probe, where
the suction velocity was set equal to the superficial gas velocity to obtain local
flux measurements. A difficulty with isokinetic sampling is that bubble arrival
at the bed surface is irregular, causing particle ejection in bursts, rather than
in a uniform manner. Bubble eruption also causes the gas flow to be highly
turbulent, especially in the lower part of the freeboard (Levy and Lockwood,
1980, 1983). Because bubble bursts cause release of both solids and gas,
isokinetic sampling requires suction velocities in excess of the superficial gas
velocity (Pemberton, 1982). George and Grace (1978) designed a special
trapping device to capture the particles ejected by individual bubbles.
Soroko, Mikhalev, and Mukhlenov (1969) used photography to determine
the transport disengaging height.
Time-averaged pressure measurements are useful in determining the minimum fluidization velocity and expanded bed level and in estimating the holdup of. solids in the unit. Pressure taps should be positioned at regular
intervals, typically 0.1 to 0.2 m, up the side of the vessel. One tap is usually
installed in the windbox below the grid. There should always be a tap just
above the grid (Sutherland, 1964). Although the pressure drop across the grid
is an indicator of the gas flowrate, it is advisable to measure the gas flowrate
by another method (e.g. rotameter or upstream 'orifice plate) since the
distributor holes may become partially blocked. The pressure drop across the
distributor plate can be used to indicate whether hole blockage or changes in
grid performance have occurred. Whitehead and Dent (1978) have shown
that pressure profiles along the distributor plate can be used to deduce
information regarding solids circulation patterns there.
For fully fluidized materials, the pressure drop between two taps is very
nearly equal to the weight of solids (and gas) held up between the two levels
divided by the bed cross-sectional area. Lower measured pressure drops
usually indicate chanelling or partial defluidization, some of the weight of the
solids being supported by interparticle contact. When absolute pressure i~
plotted against height, there is a sharp break in slope at the surface of the
expanded bed at low gas velocities, and this gives a convenient means of
estimating bed depth. Some deviation from a linear profile for the dense bed
may occur at the lowest pressure tap, and this has been a~cribed (Rowe and
Partridge, 1965) to radial gas flow associated with bubble formation. Changes
in slope may also indicate solids segregation in the bed (Chiba, Chiba,
Nienow and Kobagoshi, 1979).
The pressure measurements described above are generally obtained with
simple manometers or Bourdon-type pressure gauges. A gauze or fine screen
should be installed flush with the wall of the vessel to prevent particles from
entering the pressure taps. For sticky solids, it may be necessary to purge the
manometer lines continuously in order to prevent build-up of a deposit over
the pressure taps. The linear velocity in the purge line should be 1 to 2 m/s. In
some cases, it is more convenient to use a thin tube covered by a screen
lowered from the top of the column to measure the pressure at different
levels, instead of taps on the wall. For time-mean pressure measurements, it
is often useful to damp out pressure fluctuations by having the pressure lines
expanded to a tube of larger bore containing fixed particles (e.g. sand), in
effect providing a capacitance.
Aside from the information which can be derived from time mean pressure
drops, further information may be obtained from pressure fluctuations if one
or more taps are connected to a rapid response (e.g. diaphragm type)
pressure transducer and high speed recorder. To minimize damping of the
signal, the transducer and connecting tubes should have small volumes.
Absence of pressure fluctuations may indicate channelling or defluidization.
Pressure fluctuations of irregular amplitude and frequency usually indicate
normal bubbling, with the mean amplitude becoming larger with increasing
bubble size. Large amplitude oscillations of a fairly regular nature normally
denote slugging. High frequency, low amplitude fluctuations tend to be
associated with the turbulent regime of fluidization (Yerushalmi et ai., 1978).
Hence, the output from a pressure transducer can be useful as an indicator of
the regime of fluidization and of any shifts in bed behaviour or regime
(Broadhurst and Becker, 1976; Ho et ai., 1983; Svoboda et ai. 1984). Within
the bubbling and slugging regimes, statistical analysis and correlation of
pressure fluctuations have been used to infer bubble and slug properties
(Sitnai, 1982; Zhang, Walsh and Beer, 1982; Fan, Ho, -and Walawender,
1983). Probes can also be prepared which measure local pressure fluctuations,
but interpretation of the signals is difficult (Lord et al., 1982).
,13.11.1
In both steady and unsteady state experiments, the gas-to-solids heat transfer
coefficient is deduced from a heat balance over a differential section of height
dl:
._ (hea~ out of )
sectIOnby gas
= (heat tr~nsferred)
to particles
(13.2)
Solving this differential equation with specific boundary conditions yields the
heat transfer coefficient hgp: It is generally assumed that the solids
has been used including horizontal and vertical tubes, finned and flattened
tubes, vertical surfaces, and spheres. Some investigators have measured
spatially and time-average heat transfer coefficients, while others have
measured time-average local values and still others have devised means of
Q
hbw
S(Tw-Tb)
Figure 13.6 Typical experimental set-up for studying bed-to-surface heat transfer:
1 compressor,2 valve and water trap, 3 pressure gauge, 4 rotameters, 5 thermometer,
6 distributor, 7 fluidization column, 8 expanded freeboard, 9 filters, 10 manometer,
11 constant head tank, 12 water rotameter, 13, 14 thermometers, 15 thermocouples,
16 multi-chaneI recorder, 17 heater, 18 cooling jacket, 19 supports for heater, 20
voltage regulators.
used to measure
References
Transfer surface
Details
Aspects studied
Fitzgerald, Catipovic,
and Jovanovic
(1981)
51 mm diameter tube
with five platinum
film heating
elements around
periphery
Resistance heating of
elements with
simultaneous
capacitance and
local pressure
measurement
Instantaneous local
heat transfer coefficients. pressure.
and capacitance for
horizontal tube
25 mm o.d. horizontal
tubes in arrays
Bed electrically
heated; tube cooled
by silicone oil
Freeboard transfer,
different configurations. and tube
spacing
Local, average
convective and
radiative coefficients measured
Temperature profiles
and fluctuations
Radiometer probe of
diameter 73 mm
Surface mounted
vertically in beds at
temperatures to
800C
Piepers, Wiewiorski,
and Rietema (1984)
65 mm vertical tube
bundle
References
Transfer surface
Details
Aspects studied
Vertical 12 mm
diameter calrod
heater; Externally
heated bed also
0.13 mm diameter
horizontal wire
45 mmlong
Vertical 6.4 mm tube,
610mm long
Electrical heating,
bridge circuit
Influence of height,
gas velocity, bubble
frequency
10 mm diameter
vertical central
heater
Seven horizontal bare
or finned tubes
10 mm square vertical
platinum film
Guard heater;
Wheatstone bridge
Local instantaneous
coefficients in twodimensional column
Andeen, Glicksman,
and Bowman (1978)
Flattened horizontal
tubes of height
32 mm and width
13 mm
Effect of superficial
velocity bed depth,
and tube shape
Canada and
McLaughlin (1978)
Hoebink and Rietema
(1978)
32 mm o.d. horizontal
tubes
30 copper blocks,
each 20 x 30 mm
arranged in 3 x 10
vertical array
Vertical cylinder of
diameter 18 mm
and length 100 mm
Effects of pressure
and particle size
Blocks separated by
insulation and kept
at same temperature
Wooden rod wrapped
with copper wire
40x20x1Omm
copper block
Electrically heated
Effect of pressure
30 mm diameter,
277 mm long horizonta! tube,
isolated longitudinalS mm wide strip
9.5 mm diameter
sphericalorimetric
probe
Borodulya, Ganzha,
and Podberezsky
(1980)
Xavier et al. (1980)
Abubakar
et ai. (1980)
Botterill, Teoman,
and Yuregir (1981)
obtaining instantaneous local values. The listing in Table 13.8 is far from
complete. Entries have been chosen to illustrate the wide variety of
experimental equipment and to give references where detailed information is provided. Experimental attempts to measure radiation heat transfer in
fluidized beds have been reviewed by Ozkaynak, Chen, and Frankenfield
(1984).
The methods available for measuring surface temperature and their errors
and difficulties are discussed by Baker, Ryder, and Baker (1961) and Walker
and Rapier (1965). Thermocouples mounted onto a surface should not
perturb the bed or alter the surface roughness. Errors for brazed thermocouples are discussed by Walker and Tapier (1965).
Care should be taken if a direct electrical current is passed through the heat
transfer element since pick-up voltages can be of the same magnitude as the
thermocouple output. To minimize this effect, electrically insulating cements
with high thermal conductivity should be used, e.g. cements based on copper
oxide. Care should also be taken to minimize and estimate heat losses in
. order to obtain accurate surface-to-bed heat transfer coefficients.
Table 13.9
Property
Gas flowrate
Solids feedrate
Solids efflux
Upstream
Inlet
Outlet
Bed depth
Bed surface
Pressure profile
Bed
Pressure drop
Grid
Pressure fluctuations
Temperature
Temperature
Bed
Temperature
Freeboard
Gas composition
Upstream
Gas composition
Gas composition
Gas composition
Bed
.Freeboard
Outlet
Upstream
Bed
Solids composition
Solids composition
Bed
Inlet, outlet
Heat flux
Tubes, jacket
Provision or comments
Rotameters, orifice plate
Weigh belt, load cells on hopper
Lock hopper, load cells, filter on
cyclone gas outlet
Sight glass, pressure profile, sensor
lowered from above, y-rays
Taps at regular intervals connected
to manometers
Taps just above and below distributor
plate
Tap above distributor connected to
transducer and high speed recorder
Thermocouple in feed line or windbox
Thermocouple in dense bed region
(one usually sufficient)
Series of thermocouples at regular
intervals
Sampling from feed stream or windbox to
gas chromatograph or other analysers
Sampling tubes
Sampling tubes
Sampling well above bed, e.g. near
cycloneinlet
Grab sampler or exit port(s)
Procedure for collecting representative
samples
Thermocouples at inlet and outlet
The most common instrumentation needs for fluidized beds are summarized
in Table 13.9. Additional instrumentation may be required for particular
applications.
t:J.PD
Pg
Abubakar, M.Y., Bergougnou, M.A., Tarasuk, J.D., and Sullivan, J.L. (1980).'Local
heat transfer coefficients around a horizontal tube in a shallow fluidized bed', J.
Powder & Bulk Solids Technol., 4, 11-18.
Almstedt, A.E., and Olsson, E. (1982). 'Measurements of bubble behaviour in a
pressurized fluidized bed burning coal using capacitance probes', Proc. 7th Intern.
Fluidized Bed Combustion Conf., pp. 89-98.
Andeen, B.R., Glicksman, L.R., and Bowman, R. (1978). 'Heat transfer from
flattened horizontal tubes', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns),
Cambridge University Press, pp. 345-350.
Angelino, H., Charzat, c., and Williams, R. (1964). 'Evolution of gas bubbles in
liquid and fluidized systems', Chem. Eng. Sci., 19,289-304.
Anwer, J., and Pyle, D.L. (1973). 'Gas motion around bubbles in fluidized beds', in
La Fluidisation et ses Applications, Cepadues Editions, Toulouse, France, pp.
240-253.
Atimtay, A., and Cakaloz, T. (1978). 'An investigation of gas mixing in a fluidized
bed', Powder Technol., 20,1-7.
Avidan, A.A. (1980). 'Bed expansion and solid mixing in high velocity fluidized beds',
Ph.D. Thesis, City University of New York.
Avidan, A.A., and Yerushalmi, J. (1982). 'Bed expansion in high velocity
fluidization', Powder Technol., 32, 223-232.
Baerns, M., Fetting, F., and Schugerl, K. (1963). 'Radiale und axiale Gasvermischung
in Wirbelschicten', Chem lng. Tech., 35, 609.
Baeyens, J., and Geldart, D. (1973). 'Particle mixing in a gas fluidized bed', in La
Fluidisation et ses Applications, Cepadues Editions, Toulouse, France, pp.
182-195.
Baeyens, I., and Goossens, W.R.A. (1973). 'Some aspects of heat transfer between a
vertical wall and a gas fluidized bed', Powder Techno/., 8, 91-96.
Baker, H.D., Ryder, E.A., and Baker, N.H. (1961). Temperature Measurements in
Engineering, 2nd ed., Wiley, New York.
. .
,
Bakker, P.J., and Heertjes, P.M. (1958). 'Porosity measurements in a flUidizedbed,
Brit. Chem. Eng., 3, 240-246.
Barker, J.J. (1967). 'Microelectronic device for measuring heat transfer coefficients in
fluidized beds', Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., 6, 139-142.
.
Bartel, W.J., and Genetti, W.E. (1973). 'Heat transfer from a hOrIzontal bundle of
bare and finned tubes in an air fluidized bed', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 29, (128),
85-93.
Bartholomew, R.N., and Cassagrande, R.M. (1957). 'Measuring solids concentration
in fluidized systems by gamma-ray absorption', Ind. Eng. Shem., 49. 428-431.
Baumgarten, P.K., and Pigford, R.L. (1960). 'Density fluctuations in fluidized beds',
A.I. Ch.E.J., 6, 115-123.
Behie, L.A., Bergougnou, M.A., Baker, C.G.J., and Bulani, W. (1970). 'Jet
momentum dissipation at a grid of a large gas fluidized bed', Can. J. Chem. Eng.,
48, 158-161.
Bieri, T.W., Gajdos, L.J., McIver, A.E., and McGover~, J.J. (1980). 'Studies in
support of recirculating bed reactors for the processmg of coal', DOE Rept ..
FE-2449-11.
Blyakher, I.G., and Pavlov, V.M. (1966). 'Reducing dust ~nt,rainment from conical
fluidized bed equipment through the use of support gnds , Int. Chem. Eng., 6,
47-50.
Boland, D., and Geldart, D. (1971/72). 'Electrostatic charging in gas fluidized beds',
Powder Technol., 5,289-297.
Borodulya, V.A., Ganzha, V.G., and Podberezsky, A.I. (1980). 'Heat transfer in a
fluidized bed at high pressure' in Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen),
Plenum Press, New York, pp. 201-207.
Botterill, J.S.M., and Bessant, D.J. (1976). 'The flow prope~es of fluidized solids',
Powder Technol., 14, 131-137.
Botterill, J.S.M., and Desai, M. (1972). 'Limiting factor in gas fluidized bed heat
transfer', Powder Technol., 6, 231-238.
Botterill. J.S.M., Teoman, Y., and Yuregir, K.R (1981). 'Temperature effects on the
heat transfer behaviour of gas fluidized beds', A.I. Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 77 (208),
330-340.
Broadhurst, T.E., and Becker, H.A. (1976). 'Measurement and spectral analysis of
pressure fluctuations ~n slugging be~s', in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L.
Keairns), Vol. I, Hemisphere, Wasdhmgton, DC, pp. 6~5.
.
Calderbank, P.H., Pereira, J., and Burgess, J.M. (1976). The phySIcal and mass
transfer properties of bubbles in fluidized ~eds of electrically ~onducting par:ticles',
in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Kealrns), Vol. I, HemIsphere, Washmgton,
DC, pp. 115-167.
.
.,.
Canada, G.S., and McLaughlin, M.H. (1978). 'Large particle flUIdizatIOnand heat
transfer at high pressures', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 7~ .(179)2!-37.
.
..
Cankurt, N.T., and Yerushalrni, J. (1978). 'Gas backmIxlOgm hIgh velocity flUIdIzed
beds', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keaims), Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, pp. 387-393.
Chan I.H. and Knowlton, T.M. (1984). 'The effect of pressure on entrainment from
bubbling gas-fluidized beds', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunii and R. Toei),
Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 283-290.
Chandran, R, and Chen, J.e. (1982). 'Bed-surface contact dynamics for horizontal
tubes in fluidized beds', A.I.Ch.E.J., 28,907-914.
Chang, T.M., and Wen, e.y. (1966). 'Fluid-to-particle heat transfer in air-fluidized
beds', Chem. Eng. Prog. Symp. Ser., 62, (67),111-117.
Chavarie, e., and Grace, J.R. (1975). 'Performance analysis of a fluidized bed
reactor', Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., 14,75-91.
Chiba, S., Chiba, T., Nienow, A.W., and Kobayashi, H. (1979) 'The minimum
fluidization velocity, bed expansion and pressure-drop profile of binary particle
mixtures', Powder Technol., 22,255-269.
Chitester, D.C., Kornosky, RM., Fan, L-S., and Danko, J.P. (1984). Characteristics
of fluidization at high pressure', Chem. Eng. Sci., 39, 253-261.
Ciborowski, J., and Wlodarski, A. (1962). 'On electrostatic effects in fluidized beds',
Chem. Eng. Sci., 17,23-32.
Cloete, F.L.D. (1967). Discussion, Proceedings of International Symposium on
Fluidization (Eds A.A.H. Drinkenburg), Netherlands University Press, Amster
dam, pp. 305-307.
Cranfield, R.R. (1972). 'A probe for bubble detection and measurement in large
particle fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 27,239-245.
Crowther, M.E., and Whitehead, J.e. (1978) 'Fluidization of fine particles at elevated
pressures', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns), Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, pp. 65-70.
Davies, G., and Robinson, D.B. (1960). 'A study of aggregative fluidization', Can. J.
Chem. Eng., 38,175-183.
de Carvalho, J.F.RG. (1976). 'Fluidization under pressure', Ph.D. Thesis, Cambridge
University.
de Carvalho, J.R.F.G., King, D.F., and Harrison, D. (1978). 'Fluidization of fine
powders under pressure', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns),
Cambridge University Press, pp. 59-64.
Donsi, G., and Massimilla, L. (1972). 'Bubble-free expansion of gas fluidized beds of
fine particles', A.I. Ch.E.J., 19, 1104-1110.
Dotson. J.M. (1959). 'Factors affecting density transients in a fluidized bed',
A.I.Ch.E.J., 5, 169-174.
Dutta, S., and Wen, C.Y., (1979). 'Simple probe for fluidized bed measurements',
Can. J. Chem. Eng., 57,115-119.
Eastlund, B.J., Jellison, G., and Granatstein, V. (1982). 'Microwave diagnostics of
bubbles in fluidized bed combustors', Proc. 7th Intern. Fluidized Bed Combustion
Conf., Vol. 1, pp. 99-110.
Ellis, J.E., Partridge, B.A., and Lloyd, D.I. (1968). 'Comparison of predicted with
experimental butadiene yields for the oxydehydrogenation of butenes in a gas
fluidized bed', Instn. Chem. Engrs. Symp. Ser., 30, 43-52.
Ernst, M., Loughnane, M.D., and Bertrand, R.R. (1979). 'Instrument methods in
fluid bed pilot plant, coal processing technology', A.I.Ch.E., 5, 166-170.
Fakhimi, S., and Harrison, D. (1970). 'Multi-orifice distributors in fluidized beds: a
guide to design', in Chemeca Proceedings, Butterworths, Australia, pp. 29-46.
Fakhimi, S., and Harrison, D. (1980). 'The void fraction near a horizontal tube in a
fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chem. Engrs, 58, 125-131.
Fan, L.T., Ho, T-C., and Walawender, W.P. (1983). 'Measurements of the rise
velocity of bubbles, slugs and pressure waves in a gas-solid fluidized bed using
pressure fluctuation signals', A.I.Ch.E.J., 29,33-39.
.Fitzgerald, T.J. (1979). 'Review of instrumentation for fluidized beds' , in Proc. N. S.F.
Workshop, Rensselaer Polytechnic Inst., pp. 292-309.
Glicksman, L.R., and McAndrews, G., (1985). 'The effect of bed width on the
hydrodynamics of large particle fluidized beds', Powder Technol., 42, 159-167.
Godard, K., and Richardson, J.F. (1968). 'The behaviour of bubble-free fluidized
beds', Instn Chem. Engrs Symp. Ser., 30, 126-135.
Golan, L.P., Lalonde, G.V., and Weiner, S.e. (1982). 'High temperature heat
transfer studies in a tube filled bed', Proc. 6th Intern. Fluidized Bed Combustion
Conf., 3, 1173-1184.
Grace, J.R. (1974). 'Fluidization and its application to coal treatment and allied
processes', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 70 (141), 21-26.
Grace, I.R., and Clift, R. (1974). 'On the two-phase theory of fluidization', Chem.
Eng. Sci., 29,327-334.
Grace, J.R., and Harrison, D. (1968). 'The effect of internal baffles in fluidized beds'
a guide to design', lnstn Chem. Engrs Symp. Ser., 27. 93-100.
.
Grace, J.R., and Harrison, D. (1969). 'The behaviour of freely bubbling fluidized
beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 24, 497-500.
Grace, J.R., Lim, e.J., and Evans, R.L. (1983). 'Preparatory Report of pressurized
fluidized bed combustion', Report to Government of Canada under Contract
ISU82--Q0251.
Guinn, V.P. (1956). Nucleonics., 14 (May), 69.
Gunn, D.J. and AI-Doori, H.H. (1985). 'The measurement of bubble flows in
fluidized beds by electrical probe', Int. J. Multiphase Flow, 11, 535-551.
Hager, W.R., and Thomson, W.J. (1973). 'Bubble behaviour around immersed tubes
in a fluidized bed', A.I. Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 69 (128), 68-77.
Handley, M.F., and Perry, M.G. (1965). Rheol. Acta, 4,225.
Harper, W.R. (1960). Soc. Chem. Ind. Monograph, 14, 115.
Harrison, D., and Leung, L.S. (1962). 'The coalescence of bubbles in fluidized beds'
in Proc. Symp. Interactions Fluids Particles, Instn Chern. Engrs, London, pp:
127-134.
Hatate, Y., King, D.F., Migita, M., and Ikari, A. (1985). 'Behaviour of bubble in a
semi-cylindrical gas-solid fluidized bed', J. Chem. Eng. Japan., 18,99-104.
Heertjes, P.M., Verloop, J., and Willems, R. (1970/71). 'The measurment of local
mass flow rates and particle velocities in fluid-solids flow, Powder Technol., 4,
38-40.
Hengl, G., Hiquily, N., and Couderc, J.P. (1977). 'A new distributor for gas
fluidization', Powder Technol., 18,277-278.
Henry, P.S.H. (1953). 'Electrostatic eliminators in the textile industry', Brit. J. Appl.
Phys., 4, Supp!. 2, S78-83.
Hiraki, I., Yoshida, K., and Kunii, D. (1966). 'Behaviour of bubbles in a twodimensional fluidized bed', Chem. Eng. Japan, 4, 139-146.
Ho T-e., Yutani, N., Fan, L.T., and Walawender, W.P. (1983). 'The onset of
slugging in gas-solid fluidized beds with large particles', A. I. Ch. E.J. , 35, 249-257.
Hoebink, J.H.B.J., and Rietema, K. (1978). 'Wall-to-bed heat transfer in a fluidized
bed', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns), Cambridge University
Press, pp. 327-332.
Horio, M., Taki, A., Hsieh, Y.S., and Muchi, I. (1980). 'Elutriation and particle
transport through the freeboard of a gas-solid fluidized bed', in Fluidization (Eds
J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New York, pp. 509-518.
HorsIer, A.G., and Thompson, B.H. (1968). 'Fluidization in the development of
gas-making processes', Instn Chem. Engrs Symp. Ser., 30, 58-66.
Hosny, N., and Grace, J.R. (1984). 'Forces 011 a tube immersed within a fluidized
bed', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunii and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New
York, pp. 111-120.
Ishida, M., and Hatano, H. (1984). 'The behaviour of gas and solid particles in a
gas-solid fluidized bed detected by optica: fiber probes', in Fluidization (Eds D.
Kunii and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New York.
Ishida, M., Nishiwaki, A., and Shirai, T. (1980). 'Movement of solid particles around
bubbles in a three-dimensional fluidized bed at high temperature', in Fluidization
(Eds J .R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New York, pp. 357-364.
Jacob, A., and Osberg, G.L. (1957). 'Effect of gas thermal conductivity on local heat
transfer in a fluidized bed', Can. J. Chem. Eng., 35, 5-9.
Jin, Y., 'Yu, L.LZ., and Wang, Z. (1980). 'A study of particle movement in a gas
fluidized bed', in Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press,
New 'York, pp. 365-372.
Karniya, Y. (1955). Chem. Eng. Japan, 19, 412.
Katosonov, LV., Menshov, V.N., Zuev, A.A., and Anokhin, V.N. (1974). 'Density
of fluidized beds of fine grained materials and its variation under pressure', Zh.
. Prikl. Khim., 47, 1861-1866.
Katz, H.H., and Sears, J.T. (1969). 'Electric field phenomena in fluidized and fixed
beds', Can. J. Chem. Eng., 47,50-53.
Kavlick, V.J., and Lee, R.S. (1970). 'High pressure electrothermal fluidized bed
gasification of coal char', Chem. Eng. Prog. Symp. Ser., 66 (105), 145-151.
Kawabata, J., Yumiyama, M., Tazaki, Y., Honma, S., Chiba, T., Sumiya, T., and
Endo, K. (1981). 'Characteristics of gas fluidized beds under pressure', J. Chem.
Eng. Japan, 14,85-89.
Kawanishi, K., and Yamazaki, M. (1984). 'Structure of emulsion phase in fluidized
bed', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunll and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New
York, pp. 37-44.
..
King, D.F., and Harrison, D. (1980). 'The bubble phase in high-pressure fluidized
beds', in Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New
York, pp. 101-108.
Knowlton, T.M. (1977). 'High pressure fluidization characteristics of several
particulate solids, primarily coal and coal-derived materials', A.I.Ch.E. Symp.
Ser., 73 (161), 22-28.
Knowlton, T.M., and Hirsan, J. (1980). 'The effect of pressure on jet penetration in
semi-cylindrical gas fluidized beds', in Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M.
Matsen), Plenum Press, New York, pp. 315-324.
Kobayashi, H., and Arai, F. (1964). 4th Syrup. Chern. React. Eng., Soc. Chern.
Engrs, Osaka.
Kondukov, N.B., Kornilaev, A.N., Skachko, LM., Akhromenkov, A.A., and
Kruglov, A.S. (1964). 'An investigation of the parameters of moving particles in a
fluidized bed by a radioisotopic method'. Int. Chem. Eng., 4,43-47.
Kunll, D., and Levenspiel, O. (1969). Fluidization Engineering, Wiley, New York.
Kunll,- D., Yoshida, K., and Hiraki, J. (1967). 'The behaviour of freely bubbling
fluidized beds', In Proc. Intern. Symp. on Fluidization (Ed. A.A.H. Drinkenburg),
Netherlands University Press, Amsterdam, pp. 243--254.
Kwauk, M., Wang. N., Li, Y., Chen, B., and Shen, Z. (1986) 'Fast Fluidization at
ICM' , In Circulating Fluidized Bed Technology (Ed. P. Basu), Pergamon Press,
Toronto, pp. 33--62.
Lanneau, K.P. (1960). 'Gas-solid contacting in fluidized beds', Trans. Instn Chem.
Engrs, 38, 125-137.
Lau, LT., and Whalley, R.J.P. (1981). 'A differential thermal probe for anticipation
of defluidization of caking coals', Fuel Proc. Technol., 4, 101-115.
Lee, B.S., Pyrcioch, E.J., and Schora, F.e. (1970). 'Hydrogasification of coal in highpressure fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Prog. Symp. Ser., 66 (105), 152-156.
Levy, E.K., Caram, H.S., Dille, J.e., and Edelstein, S. (1983). 'Mechanisms for
solids ejection from gas fluidized beds', A.I.Ch.E.J., 29, 383-388.
Levy, Y., and Lockwood, F.e. (1980). 'Two phase flow measurements in the
freeboard of a fluidized bed using laser Doppler anemometry', Israel J. Technol.,
18, 146--151.
Levy, Y., and Lockwood, F.e. (1983). 'Laser Doppler measurements of flow in
freeboard of a fluidized bed', A.I. Ch. E.J., 29, 889-895.
Lewis, W.K., Gilliland, E.R. and Bauer, W.e. (1949). 'Characteristics of fluidized
particles', Ind. Eng. Chem., 41, 1104-1117.
Lignola, R.G., Donsi, G., and Massimilla, L. (1983). 'Mass spectrometric measurements of gas composition profiles associated with bubbles in a two-dimensional
bed', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 79 (222),19-26.
Lim, e.J., Ko, G.H., and Grace, J.R. (1986) 'Oxygen probe measurements and their
accuracy in coal combustors'. To be published.
Lin, J.S., Chen, M.M., and Chao, B.T. (1985). 'A novel radioactive tracking facility
for measurement of solids motion in gas fluidized beds', A.I. Ch. E.J., 31, 465-473.
Littman, H. (1964). 'Solids mixing in straight and tapered fluidized beds'.
A./.Ch.E.J.,
10,924-929.
Littman, H., and Homolka, G.A.J. (1973). 'The pressure field around a twodimensional gas bubble in a fluidized bed', Chem. En~. Sci., 28,2231-2243.
Ljungstrom, E., and Lindqvist, O. (1982). 'Measurements of in-bed gas and solids
compositions in a combustor operating at pressures up to 20 bar' , Proc. 7th Intern.
Fluidized Bed Combustion Conf., 1,465-472.
Lockett, M.J., and Harrison, D. (1967). 'The distribution of voidage fraction near
bubbles rising in gas-fluidized beds', Proceedings of International Symposium on
Fluidization
(Ed. A.A.H. Drinkenburg), Netherlands University Press,
Amsterdam, 257-267.
Lockwood, D.N. (1977). 'Effects of heat exchanger tube spacing and arrangement on
the quality of fluidization', Proc. Pachec Conf., Denver, pp. 1177-1181.
Loeb, L.B. (1958). Static Electrification, Springverlag, Berlin.
Loew, 0., Schmutter, B., and Resnick, W. (1979) 'Particle and bubble behaviour and
velocities in a large-particle fluidized bed with immersed obstacles',' Powder
Technol., 22,45-57.
Lord, W.K., McAndrews, G., Sakagami, M., Valenzuela,I.A., and Glicksman, L.R.
(1982). 'Measurement of bubble properties in fluidized beds', Proc. 7th Intern.
Fluidized Bed Combustion Conf., 1,76-88.
Lyall, E. (1969). 'The photography of bubbling fluidized beds', Brit. Chem. Eng., 14,
501~506.
Marsheck, R.M., and Gomezplata, A. (1965). 'Particle flow pattern in a fluidized
bed', A.I.Ch.E.J.,
11,167-173.
Masson, H., and Jottrand, R. (1978). 'Measurement of local bubble properties in a
fluidized bed', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns), Cambridge
University Press, pp. 1~.
Masson, H., Jottrand, R., and Dang Tran, K. (1978). Intern. Congo on Mixing in the
Chemical Industries, Mons.
Mathur, K.B., and Epstein, N. (1974). Spouted Beds, Academic Press, New York.
May, W.G. (1959). 'Fluidized bed reactor studies', Chem. Eng. Prog., 55 (12), 49-56.
May, W.G., and Russell, F.D. (1954). 'High pressure fluidization', Paper given at
North New Jersey A.e.S. meeting.
Mayhofer, R., and Neuzil, L. (1977). 'Influence of grid on fluidized bed inhomogeneity', Chem. Eng. J., 14, 167-173.
Merrick, D., and Highley, 1. (1972). 'Particle size reduction and elutriatiQn in a
fluidized bed processes', A.l.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 70 (137), 36?,-378..
.
Merry, J.M.D., and Davidson, J.F. (1973). 'Gulf stream CIrculatIOnm shallow
fluidized beds' Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 51, 361-368.
Mickley, H.S., F~irbanks, D.F., and Hawthorn,. R.D: (19~1~.'The relation betwee~
the transfer coefficient and thermal fluctuations m flUIdized bed heat transfer,
Chern. Eng. Prog. Syrnp. Ser., 57,51--60.
. .
. .
Mickley, H.S. and Trilling, C.A. (1949). 'Heat transfer charactenstIcs of flUidized
beds' Ind. Eng. Chern., 41,1135-1147.
.
.
Miller, e.O., and Logwinuk, A.K. (1951). 'Fluidization studies of solid particles, Ind.
Eng. Chern., 43,1220-1226.
.
Mogan, J.P., Taylor, R.W., and Booth, F.L. ~1971):'!he va.lueof the exponent m th,e
Richardson and Zaki equation for fine solids flUIdizedWIthgases under pressure ,
Powder Techno!., 4, 286-289.
.
.
.
Morooka, S., Kago, T., and Kato, Y. (1984). 'Flow pattern of..solid particles .m
freeboard of fluidized bed', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunll and R. Toe1),
Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 291-298.
Morse, R.D., and Ballou, C.O. (1951). 'The uniformity of fluidization, its
measurement and use' Chern. Eng. Prog., 47, 199-211.
Nazemi, A., Bergougnou: M.A., and Baker, C.G.J. (1974). 'Dilute phase holdup in a
large gas fluidized bed', A.l.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 70 (14), 98-107.
Nguyen, T.H., and Grace, J.R. (1978). "Forces on objects immersed in fluidized
beds', Powder Technol., 19,255-264.
."
.
Nguyen, X.T., and Leung, L.S. (~972). 'A note on bubble formatIOnat an onfice m a
fluidized bed', Chern. Eng. Scz., 27, 1748-1750.
'
..
Nienow, A.W., and Cheesman, D.J. (1980). 'The effect of shape on t~e ml~lt.Ig~nd
segregation of large particles in a gas-fluidized bed of small ones, m FlUldlzatlon
(Eds J.R. Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, ~ew Yo:k, pp. 373-~80.
Ohki, K., Ishida, M., and Shirai, !. (19~0). 'Th~ ?ehaVlO~r?f Jets.a~d ~artlcles near
the distributor grid in a three-dImenslOnal flUIdizedbed, m FlUidizatIOn (Eds J.R.
Grace and J.M. Matsen), Plenum Press, New York, ~~. 421-42~. .
..,
Ohki, K., and Shirai, T. (1976). 'Particle velo~ity in flUldIZ~dbeds, m FLUIdizatIOn
Technology (Ed. D.L. Keairns), Vol. I, HemIsphere, W~shmgton, DC, pp. 95-110.
Okhi, K., Walawender, W.P., and Fan, L.T. (1977). 'The measurement of local
velocity of solid particles', Powder Techno!., 18,171-178.
..
Orcutt, J.C., and Carpenter, B.H. (1971). 'Bubble coalescence and the slmulat~onof
mass transport and chemical reaction in gas fluidized beds', Chern. Eng. SCI., 26,
1046-1064.
.
Ormiston, R.M., Mitchell, F.R.G., and Davidson, J.F. (1965). 'The velOCityof slugs
in fluidized beds' Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 43, 209-216.
Osberg, G.L. (1951). 'Locating fluidized solids bed level in a reactor', Ind. Eng.
Chern., 43, 1871-1873.
Overcashier, R.D., Todd, D.B., and Olney, R.B. (1959). 'Some effects of baffles on a
fluidized system', A.I.Ch.E.J., 5,54-60.
.
.
Ozkaynak, T.F., and Chen, J.e. (1978). 'Averag.e res~d~ncetIm:s of emulslOn and
void phases at the surface of heat transfer tubes m flUidizedbeds, A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp.
Ser., 74 (174), 334-343.
,
.
Ozkaynak, T.F., Chen, J.e., and Fran~~nfield, T.R .. (1984~.~n expenme~tal
investigation of radiation (Eds D. Kunu and R. ToeI), Engmeenng Foundation,
New York, pp. 371-378.
Park, W.H., Kang, W.L., Capes, C.E., and Osberg, G.L. (1969). 'The properties of
bubbles in fluidized beds of conducting particles as measured by an electroresistivity probe', Chern. Eng. Sci., 24,851-865.
Park, W.H., Lee, N.G., and Capes, C.E. (1974). 'Wall effects in point probe
measurements of radial bubble distributions', Chern. Eng. Sci., 29, 339-344.
Partridge, B.A., Lyall, E., and Crooks, H.E. (1969). 'Particle slip surfaces in bubbling
gas fluidized beds', Powder Technol., 2, 301-305.
Patrose, B., and Caram, H.S. (1982). 'Optical fiber probe transit anemometer for
particle velocity measurements in fluidized beds', A.I.Ch.E.J., 28, 604-609.
Patureaux, T., Vergnes, F., and Mihe, J.P. (1973). 'Construction of piezoelectric
transducer for statistical study on impact of particles in fluidized beds', Powder
Technol., 8, 101-105.
Pemberton, S.T. (1982). 'Entrainment from fluidized beds', Ph.D. Thesis, Cambridge
University.
Piepers, H.W., Wiewiorski, P., and Rietema, K. (1984). 'Heat transfer on a vertical
tube bundle immersed in a 0.70 m fluidized bed', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunii and
R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 339-346.
Pyle, D.L., and Harrison, D. (1967). 'The rising velocity of bubbles in twodimensiorial fluidized beds', Chern. Eng. Sci., 22, 531-535.
Qin, S., and Liu, G. (1982). 'Application of optical fibres to measurement and display
of fluidized systems', in Fluidization Science and Technology (Eds M. Kwauk and
D. Kunii), Science Press, Beijing, pp. 258-266.
Rao, V.L., and Venkateswarku, D. (1973). 'Determination of velocities and flow
patterns of particles in mass flow hoppers', Powder Techno!., 7, 263-265.
Raso, G., Tirabasso, G., and Donsi, G. (1983). 'An impact probe for local analysis of
gas-solid flows', Powder Technol., 34, 151-159.
Richardson, J.F., and McLeman, M. (1960). 'Pneumatic conveying: solids velocities
and pressure gradients in a one-inch horizontal pipe', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs,
38, 257-266.
Rietema, K. (1967). 'Application of mechanical stress theory of fluidization', in
Proceedings of International Syrnposium on Fluidization (Ed. A.A.H. Drinkenburg), Netherlands University Press, Amsterdam, pp. 154-166.
Rietema, K., and Hoebink, J. (1976). 'Mass transfer from single rising bubbles to the
dense phase in three-dimensional fluidized beds', in Fluidization Technology (Ed.
D.L. Keairns) Vol. I, Hemisphere, Washington, DC, pp. 279-288.
Rowe, P.N. (1971). 'Experimental properties of bubbles', Chapter 4 in Fluidization
(Eds J.F. Davidson and D. Harrison), Academic Press, London, pp. 121-191.
Rowe, P.N., and Everett, D.J. (1972). 'Fluidized bed bubbles viewed by X-rays',
Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 50,42--60.
Rowe, P.N., Foscolo, P.U., Hoffman, A.C., and Yates, J.G. (1984). 'X-ray
observation of gas fluidized beds under pressure', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunii and
R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 53-60.
Rowe, P.N., MacGillivray, H.J., and Cheesman, D.J. (1979). 'Gas discharge from an
orifice into a gas fluidized bed', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs., 57,194-199.
Rowe, P.N., and Masson, H. (1980). 'Fluidized bed bubbles observed simultaneously
by probe and X-rays', Chern. Eng. Sci., 35, 1443-1447.
Rowe, P.N., and Masson, H. (1981). 'Interactions of bubbles with probes in gas
fluidized beds', Trans. Instn Chern. Engrs, 59, 177-185.
Rowe, P.N., and Partridge, B.A. (1962). 'Particle movement caused by bubbles in a
fluidized bed', in Proc. Syrnp. Interactions Fluids Particles, Instn Chern. Engrs,
London, pp. 135-142.
Rowe, P.N. and Partridge, B.A. (1965). 'Aggregative fluidization', Chern. Eng. Sci.,
I
20,985.
Rowe, P.N., Partridge, B.A., Cheney, A.G., Henwood, G.A., and Lyall E. (1965).
The mechamsms of solids mixing in fluidized beds', Trans. lnstn. Chem Engrs 43
271-286.
' ,
Rowe, P.N., Partridge, B.A. and Lyall, G. (1964). 'Cloud formation around bubbles
in fluidized beds', Chem. Eng. Sci., 19,973-985.
Sathiyamoorthy, D., and Rao, C.S. (1981). 'The choice of distributor to bed pressure
drop in gas fluidized beds'. Powder Technol., 30, 139-143.
Saxton, A.L., and Worley, A.C. (1970). 'Modern catalytic cracking design', Oil &
Gas J., 68 (20). 82-99.
Schugerl, K. (1967). 'Experimental comparison of mixingprocesses in two- and threephase fluidized beds' in Proceedings of International Symposium on Fluidization
Netherlands University Press, Amsterdam, pp. 782-794.
'
Schulz-Walz, A. (1974). 'Messing von Schuttgutgeschwindigkeiten am Beispiel der
Schwingsiebzentrifuge, Chem. Ing. Techn., 46, 259.
Schuurmans, H.J.A. (1980). 'Measurements in a commercial catalytic cracking unit'.
Ind. Eng. Chem. proc. Des & Dev., 19, 267-27l.
Sit, S.P., and Grace, J.R. (1978). 'Interphase mass transfer in an aggregative fluidized
bed', Chem. Eng. Sci., 33, 1115-1122.
Sitnai, D .. (19~2). 'Utilization of the pressure differential records from gas fluidized
beds with mternals for bubble parameters determination' Chem. Eng. Sci 37
1059-1066.
.
,.,
,
Soko!o.' V.E., .Mikhalev, M.F., and Mukhlenov, I.P. (1969). 'Calculation of the
mimmum height of the space above the bed in fluidized bed contact equipment' .
Int. Chem. Eng., 9, 280-281.
'
Soo, S:L:, Ihring, H:K., and El Kouh, A.G. (1960). 'Experimental determination of
statistical properties of two-phase turbulent motion', Trans. ASME J. Basic Eng.
82, 609-621.
'
,
Staub, F ..W., and Canada, G.S ..(197~): 'Effect of tube bank and gas density on flow
behaViour and heat transfer m flUidiZedbeds'. In Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson
and J:?L. Keairn~), Cambridge Univerisity Press, Cambridge, pp. 339-344.
Subzwan, M.P., Chft, R., and Pyle, D.L. (1978). 'Bubbling behaviour of fluidized
beds at. elevate~ pre.ssures', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keairns),
Cambndge Umverslty Press, Cambridge, pp. 50-54.
Sutherland, J.P. (1964). 'The measurement of pressure drop across a gas fluidized
bed', Chern. Eng. Sci., 19,839-841.
SV~boda, K., Cerm.ak, ~., Hartman, M., Drahos, J., and Selucky, K. (1984).
Influence of particle Size on the pressure fluctuations and slugging in a fluidized
bed', A.I.Ch.E.J., 30,513-517.
Tanimoto, ~., S:hiba, S., .C~iba, T., and Kobayashi, H. (1980). 'Mechanism of solid
segregatIon m gas flUidiZed beds', in Fluidization (Eds J.R. Grace and J.M.
Matsen), Plenum, New York, pp. 381-388.
Torobin, L.B., and Gauvin. W.H. (1961). 'Fundamental aspects of solids-gas flow'
Can. J. Chern. Eng., 39, 113-120.
'
Tuot, J., and Clift, R. (1973). 'Heat transfer around single bubbles in a twodimensional fluidized bed', A.I.Ch.E. Symp. Ser., 69, (128),78-84.
Vale~z.uel~, J.A., and Gli~ksman, L.R. (1984a). 'An experimental study of solids
mlXlng m a freely bubblmg two-dimensional fluidized bed' Powder Technol 38
63-72.
,.,
,
Valenzuela: J.A:, and Gli~k~man, L.R. (1984b). 'Residence time and dispersion of
fine particles m a 2-d flUidizedbed of large particles', in Fluidization (Eds D. Kunii
and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 161-168.
Yates, J.G., Cheesman, D.J., Mashingaidze, T.A., Howe,.C., and Jefferis, G. (1984).
'The effect of vertical rods on bubbles in gas fluidized beds', in Fluidization (Eds D.
Kunii and R. Toei), Engineering Foundation, New York, pp. 103-110.
Yates, J.G., and Walker, P.R. (1978). 'Particle temperatures in a fluidized bed
combustor', in Fluidization (Eds J.F. Davidson and D.L. Keaims), Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, pp. 241-245.
Yerushalmi, 1., Cankurt, N.T., Geldart, D., and Liss, B. (1978). 'Flow regimes in
vertical gas-solid contact systems', A.I.Ch.E. Syrnp. Ser., 74 (176),1-13.
Yerushalmi, J., Turner, D.H., and Squires, A.M. (1976). 'The fast fluidized bed', Ind.
Eng. Chern. Proc. Des. & Dev., 15, 47-53.
Yoshida, K., and Kunii, D. (1968). 'Stimulus and response of gas concentration in
bubbling fluidized beds', J. Chern. Eng. Japan, 1,11-16.
Yoshida, K., Fujii, S., and Kunii, D. (1976). 'Characteristics of fluidized beds at high
temperatures',
in Fluidization Technology (Ed. D.L. Keairns), Vol. 1, Hemisphere, Washington, DC, pp. 43-48.
Zabrodsky, S.S., Antonishin, N.V., and Pamas, A.L. (1976). 'On fluidized bed-tosurface heat transfer', Can. J. Chern. Eng., 54,52-58.
Zenz, F.A., and Weil, N.A. (1958). 'A theoretical-empirical
approach to the
mechanisms of particle entrainment from fluidized beds', A.!. Ch.E.J., 4, 472--479.
Zhang, M.C., Walsh, P.M., and Beer, J.M. (1982). 'Determination of bubble size
distributions from pressure fluctuations in a fluidized bed combustor', 7th Intern.
Fluidized Bed Combustion Conf., 1, 75-75J.
Index
perforated plate, 65
pipe grid, 67
porous plate, 65, 82, 91, 427
pressure drop across, 67-73
tuyere type, 66,69,70,72,73,75,77,
78
weeping/dumping, 65-66
Drift, see Bubble, drift fraction
Dryers; fluid bed,S, 119, 259-283
batch, 260
continuous plug flow, 262
continuous well-mixed, 26(}-261
process design of, 273-278
vibrated, 263
Drying,
constant rate, 268
falling rate, 269
Electrostatic precipitators, 198, 215
Electrostatics, 34, 198, 422, 424, 427
Elutriation, see Entrainment
Elutriation rate constant, 135-144
correlations for, 142
effect of baffles, 141
effect of bed diameter, 141
effect of gas velocity, 141
effect of pressure, 141
effect of size of particles, 138
Emissivity of particles, 240, 241, 242, 243
Emulsion, see Dense phase
Energy balance, 299,319, 330
Entrainment, (see also Elutriation rate
constant), 1,37, 123-150
measurement of, 441, 443-444
mechanisms, 134
Ergun equation, 13, 20, 362
Erosion, 1, 74, 77, 244, 246, 250, 358
Euler Number, 199,205,206
Excess gas velocity, 45,81,107
Expansion,
ofbed,27,32,36,37,4O,41,83-86,
105,227,244
of dense phase, 26, 28, 36
of sluggingbed, 90-92, 167-168
of turbulent bed, 167-168, 249
Extrusion flow, 369
Fast fluidization, 3, 37, 155-195,344-345
applications of, 192-195,331-332
heat transfer in, 223
FCC, see Catalysts
Filte~, 215, 216, 447
bag, 216
Fines fraction, 28, 42
effect on conversion in freeboard, 327
effect on entrainment, 138, 139
effect on heat transfer, 228, 237
Finned tubes, see Tubes, finned
Fischer-Tropsch synthesis,S, 193, 194,
285
Fixed beds, (see also Packed beds) 11,
18-21
Fluid bed dryer, see Dryer
Fluidization velocities, see Velocities
Fluidized bed combusto~, see
Combustor
Freeboard, 126,445
reaction in, 326-330
Gas adsorption, 25, 42, 288, 292
Gas bypassing, 38, 45-46, 81, 287,
289-292
Gas cleaning, 197-217
Gas interchange/exchange, 38, 53,
292-300
Gas sampling, 440, 441
Galileo number, see Archimedes number
Gas-solid contacting, 97, 289, 331
Gas-solid reactions, 285, 316-326
Gasification, 4, 8, 285, 316
Gas metering, 416-418
Gas mixing, 186-191, 310
Gas supply, 416-418
Geldart fluidization diagram, 3, 33-51,
368
Grade efficiency, 199, 202, 204
Granulators/granulation, 2, 267, 266
Grid, see Distributor
Hardness of particles, 34, 42, 43
Hausner ratio, 43
Heat sensitive powders, 263, 265
Heat storage in fluid bed, 252
Heat transfer, 1, 34, 53, 96, 220
bed-to-surface,223-234
effect of pressure on, 230, 237
maximum coefficient, 238, 239
measurement of, 446-449
Heat transfer correlations
bed-to-tube, 229-250
interphase gas convective component
223, 224-235
particle-to-gas,22(}-222
radiative component, 223, 229,
24{}-:243
turbulent fluidized bed, 249
Holdup
measurement of 36,441,443-444
Hoppers, 35,37,212,407-409
Humidity, 34, 35, 418, 427, 442
Hydrodynamics
of bubbles,S, 53-92, 302, 429
Incipient fluidization velocity, see
Velocity, minimum fluidization
Inclined pipes,
in pneumatic conveying, 358-359
Instrumentation, 415-462
Interparticle forces, 36, 43, 48, 227
Interphase mass transfer, see Mass
transfer
Interstitial gas velocity, see Velocity,
inte~titial gas
Jets/jetting, 73, 74, 76, 77, 313, 314
Kinetics of drying, 267-272
see also Reaction kinetics /
Lateral mixing, see Solids mixing (radial)
Leaks, 418
Liquid fluidization, 26, 34, 46-47
Mass transfer,
interphase 74, 292-294, 296, 304, 306,
311,316
Mechanical stirring, 34
Methanol-to-gasoline process, 6, 194
Minimum bubbling velocity, see
Velocity, minimum bubbling
Minimum fluidization velocity, see
Velocity, minimum fluidization
Mixing, see Gas mixing, Solids mixing
Moving beds, 4, 20, 391
see also Standpipes
Multi-stage beds, 264, 326
Non-bubbling fluidization, see Quiescent
fluidization
Non-catalytic gas-phase reactions, 285
Non-mechanical valves, L- and J-valves,
363,395-407
aeration in, 396-398, 400
61
effect on entraiment, 141
effect on fast fluidization, 177
effect on heat transfer, 230, 237
effect on turbulent fluidization, 157
gradient, 19,21
Pressure drop,
in compressible flow, 20
in conveying, 342-344, 348-351,
354-356
in fluidized bed, 1,22
42
11, 25, 26, 33, 34,
40
Quiescent bed, 25, 238
Reaction kinetics, 287
effect of particle size, 317-319
gas/solid reactions, 31~326
Reactor models,
single phase, 295, 332
two phase, 295, 297, 298, 324
three phase, 295, 297, 298
Reactors,
fluidized bed, 53, 74, 285-335
Reaction,
in the freeboard, 32~330
in the grid region, 313-316
Regimes,
bubbling, 33, 34
of fluidization, 4, 33-51, 183-185
non-bubbling, 33, 34
Relative velocity between gas and
particles, 371-376, 391-395
Residence time, 108
of particles, 146,233,276,277
Residence time distribution, 98, 109,
260-261,278-280,295,438
Roasting,
of sulphide ores, 5, 194
of zinc ore, 63, 84, 139,322
Saltation velocity, 351-354, 365
Sampling, see Gas sampling, and Solids
sampling
Saturation carrying capacity, 126, 170,
171, 180, 181
Scale-up, 1,5,6,48,80,210,423,424
of reactors, 287, 309
Scrubber, see Aero-mechanicaI
separators
Segregation, 26, 38, 97,110-114
by density difference, 113
by size difference, 113,
p4
269
Vibration, 33, 34, 43, 422, 442
Viscosity
effect on fluidization, 24, 42
of fluidized beds, 56, 58, 60, 103
Visible bubble flow rate, 103
Voidage
definition, 17
in fluidized beds, 26-27
of dense phase, 27
prediction of, 18